Home
        KYOCERA FS FS-3040MFP+
         Contents
1.                        Add        Remove    Pemissions for james smith Allow Deny  Full control e E  Modify o jl  Read  amp  execute A    List folder contents E  Read el x             Leam about access control and permissions                         Checking the  Path        8 Click the Security tab and then click the Edit button     In Windows XP  click the Security tab and then click the  Add button        9 Proceed in the same way as in step 5 to add a user to  Group or user names     10 Select the added user  select the Modify and Read  amp   execute permissions  and then click the OK button     Check the share name of the shared folder that will be the destination for the document        2 35    Preparation before Use       1 Enter    pc4050  in  Program and File Search  in the  p   pc4050 scannerdata Start menu     The Search Results screen opens     In Windows XP  click Search in the Start menu  select All  files and folders  and search for the destination  computer to which the file will be sent     In Search Companion  click Computers or people and  then A computer on the network     In the  Computer name   text box  enter the name of the  computer that you checked  pc4050  and then click  Search     j  See more results        pc4050 x   W Shut down    gt             2 Click    pc4050 scannerdata  that appears in the search  results     In Windows XP  double click the computer   pc4050    that appears in the search results        r 3 Check the folder that appears   K
2.                        Dotted Positioning  Mark       The procedure for using Combine mode copying is explained below   1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original                                3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  pata OK    Collate Oo  Duplex o    Exit    4 Press the A or V key to select  Combine    Press the OK key  Combine appears   Combine  Sma OK    off  2 in 1  4 in 1  6 Press the A or V key to select  2 in1  or  4 in 1    7 Press  Detail   the Right Select key    A 8 Press the A or V key to select the desired layout and  2 in 1 Layout  Said OK then press the OK key   EIR to L                Copying Functions             Border Line  paid OK      Solid Line  i Dotted Line                Orig Orientation  0m  fiTop Edge Top    D             10    11    Press the A or V key to select the desired border line  type and then press the OK key     Press the A or V key to select the orientation of the  original and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     Press the Start key  Scanning begins     If the original is placed on the platen  replace the original  and press the Start key     After scanning all originals  press  End Scan   the Right  Select key  to start copying        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 12    Copying Functions       Continuous Scan    When a large number of originals cannot be plac
3.                  8 87    Default Setting  System Menu        Document Box Settings   The following settings are available for Document Box   e Job Box    8 88   e Select Key Set    8 90   Job Box    Job Box settings can be set  Select settings for Quick Copy Jobs and Job Retention Deletion  Quick Copy Jobs sets  the number of files that can be saved using Quick Copy  Job Ret  Deletion sets the period of time a job retention file  can be saved  When a file has been saved for longer than the period  it is automatically deleted     Quick Copy Jobs    The procedure for setting Quick Copy Jobs is explained below        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count      select  Document Box     Send  FAX      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Document Box menu appears   Document Box   gt  0m    Job Box  Select Key Set     Exit                  Press the A or V key to select  Job Box         4 Press the OK key  The Job Box screen appears   Job Box  Ka oK    01  Quick Copy Jobs    JobRet  Deletion                  Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Quick Copy Jobs    6 Press the OK key  The Quick Copy Jobs screen  Quick Copy Jobs       appears    0   50   EE 5 0b  s              7 Enter the number of Quick Copy Jobs that can be saved  with the numeric keys        8 88    Default Setting  System Menu        8 Press the OK key  The screen returns to the Job Box  screen     Job Retention Deletion    The procedure for setting Job Retention Deletion 
4.                  Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Copies    4 Press the OK key  Copies appears   Copies        1   999   MEER copies             5 Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to set the  default number of copies     6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu        8 80    Default Setting  System Menu        Orientation    Set the default orientation  Portrait or Landscape     Portrait       Printer                Landscape       Printer             Use the procedure below to set the default orientation for printing        Sys  Menu Count        Common Settings             Copy  Printer     Exit    Printer    O    01  Emulation Set     EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR                  Exit    Orientation    O  0I   Portrait    Landscape          1    In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Printer      Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Orientation      Press the OK key  Orientation appears     Press the A or V key to select  Portrait  or  Landscape      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Printer menu        8 81    Default Setting  System Menu        FormFeed Timeout    Receiving print data from the computer  the machine may sometimes wait if there is no information signalling that the  last page does not have any more data to be printed  When the preset timeout passes  the machine automatically  prints paper  
5.              8 37    Default Setting  System Menu        e Panel Reset Timer    7 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu     If you select  On  for Auto Panel Reset  set the amount of time to wait before Auto Panel Reset  Options are between  5 and 495 seconds  every five seconds   The default setting is 90 seconds        NOTE  If you select  Off  for Auto Panel Reset  the time display does not appear        Use the procedure below to set the reset time        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account      Exit            Common Settings   gt     Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login            Timer Setting    O  Sleep Timer  PanelReset Timer     Exit               1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      4 The Timer Settings menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Panel Reset Timer         8 38    Default Setting  System Menu           6 Press the OK key  Panel Reset Timer appears   PanelReset Timer      M     5   495   EERE  lt  lt  lt               7 Press the A or V key
6.            7 4 Press the OK key  The address book appears with the  Address Book  V0 user that starts with the entered character string at the  top     amp  Morgan     amp  Sally         Menu            Search in External Address Book       1 In Ext Address Book  press  Menu   the Right Select  Ext Address Book  Wm key   Menu appears      amp  Maury   amp  Morgan      Menu            2 Pressthe A or V key to select  Search  and then press  Menu   lt 0 the OK key  A search screen appears   Select  Detail                3 27    Basic Operation          3 Enter the characters you want to search     Search  Name     0  mai If you press  Menu   the Right Select key  and then the  A OK key  Search by appears where you can specify the  ABC search key and match condition  Select the desired item  for each and then press the OK key     Menu     Text               4 Press the OK key  The address book appears with the    Ext Address Book   gt  user that starts with the entered character string at the  top     amp  Morgan    amp  Sally            Menu            NOTE  If you first open the extended address book  the search screen appears first  Then  operate from step 3        Choosing by One Touch Key  Select the destination using the One touch keys           15       In the basic screen for sending or the destination entry  Cc  C  screen  press the one touch key where the destination is                         registered   18  19   Cc  C  NOTE  Refer to Adding a Destination on One touc
7.            NOTE  If you cannot find a paper jam  try checking inside  the rear of the printer  Refer to Rear Unit on page 5 18        5 Insert the developer unit together with the toner  container  back into the machine     6 Close the top cover and front cover  The machine warms  up and resumes printing        10 16    Troubleshooting       Rear Unit    Follow the steps below to clear paper jams of the rear unit     1 If paper is not completely ejected into the output tray   open the rear cover     2 Open the fuser cover and remove the jammed paper by  pulling it out                                                                 NOTE  If you cannot find a paper jam  try checking inside  the rear of the machine                          CAUTION  The fuser unit inside the machine is hot   Do not touch it with your hands as it may result in  burn injury  Remove jammed paper carefully     3 Close the rear cover  The machine warms up and  resumes printing out                    Document Processor  Follow the steps below to clear paper jams in the document processor     1 Remove all of the originals from the document feed tray           10 17    Troubleshooting       2 Open the left cover of the document processor     3 Remove the jammed original     If the original is caught in the rollers or difficult to remove   proceed to the next step     4 Open the document processor     5 Remove the jammed original     If the original tears  remove every loose scrap from  inside the machine
8.           IMPORTANT  If no destination is registered  Enter  Enter destination  destination is displayed  Refer to Registering Destination on  page 7 15 and register the desired destination             3 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   Accepted  is displayed  and the job log is sent to the registered destination  before the screen returns to the Job Log History menu     Setting E mail Subject  Set the subject automatically entered when sending job log histories by e mail     Use the procedure below to set the subject        R 1 Inthe Job Log History menu  press the A or V key to  Job Log History   lt  gt  select  Subject    Send History    Destination    Subject            Exit      2 Press the OK key  Subject appears   Subject   0  Sprinter  ABC    Text               3 Enter the e mail subject        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        4 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Job Log History menu        7 17    Status   Job Cancel       Pause and Resumption of Jobs    Pause  resume all printing jobs in printing waiting     The procedure for pausing and resuming jobs is explained below        1 Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  Status  pag OK  appears     Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause               2 Press the A or V key to select  Print Job Status         3 Press the OK key  Print Job Status appears   Print Job Status  0m    0009  amp imaury   s data  
9.         6 Close the document processor     Place the originals        10 18    11 Management    This chapter explains the following operations     e User Login Administration                        ceseeeeeeeeeeeeeees 11 2    Job AcCOUMINGseenesc teenie 11 15  e Checking the Countel            ccccecceceseeseeseeseeeesceeceees 11 37       11 1    Management       User Login Administration    User login administration specifies how the user access is administered on this machine  Enter correct login user  name and password for user authentication to log in     Access are in three levels   User  Administrator  and Machine Administrator  The security levels can be modified only  by the machine administrator     First User Login Administration  Follow these steps for the first user login administration   Enable user login administration   page 11 2   v  Add a user  page 11 6   v  Log out  page 11 5   v    The registered user logs in for operations  page 11 5     Enabling Disabling User Login Administration    This enables user login administration  Select one of the following authentication methods     Item Description    Local User authentication based on user properties on  Authentication the local user list stored in the machine        Network User authentication based on Authentication  Authentication Server  Use a user property stored in  Authentication Server to access the network  authentication login page              Management       Use the procedure below to enable use
10.       6 Press the OK key  File Name Entry appears  Enter the  document name  up to 32 characters      7 Press the OK key  Additional Info appears     8 Press the A or V key to select  None    Date    JobNo      JobNo    Date  or  Date   JobNo       9 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu     Set the subject and body automatically entered  default subject and body  when sending the scanned originals by E     mail        NOTE     e Refer to Send as E mail on page 3 19   e Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        Use the procedure below to set the default e mail subject and message body        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account      Exit               Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         8 51    Default Setting  System Menu           4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    01I  Color Selection  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                        Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Subject Body    F 6 Press the OK key  Subject Entry appears  Enter the e   Subject Entry   0 mail subject  up to 60 characters       If you press the Back key  you can return to the Function  j Default menu   ABC  
11.       Legal Information    Copying or other reproduction of all or part of this guide without the prior written consent of Kyocera Mita Corporation  is prohibited     Regarding Trade Names    PRESCRIBE and ECOSYS are trademarks of Kyocera Corporation   KPDL is a trademark of Kyocera Corporation     Microsoft  MS DOS  Windows  Windows NT and Internet Explorer are registered trademarks of Microsoft  Corporation in the U S A  and or other countries     Windows Me  Windows XP and Windows Vista are trademarks of Microsoft Corporation    PCL is a trademark of Hewlett Packard Company    Adobe Acrobat  Adobe Reader and PostScript are trademarks of Adobe Systems  Incorporated   Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation    Novell and NetWare are registered trademarks of Novell  Inc    IBM and IBM PC AT are trademarks of International Business Machines Corporation    Power PC is a trademark of IBM in the U S A  and or other countries     AppleTalk  Bonjour  Macintosh  and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc   registered in the U S  and other  countries     TypeBankG B  TypeBankM M and Typebank OCR are trademarks of TypeBank      All European language fonts installed in this machine are used under licensing agreement with Monotype  Imaging Inc    Helvetica  Palatino and Times are registered trademarks of Linotype Hell AG     ITC Avant Garde Gothic  ITC Bookman  ITC ZapfChancery and ITC ZapfDingbats are registered trademarks of  International Type face Corporation     UFST   
12.       Precautions for Handling the Memory Module    To protect electronic parts  discharge static electricity  Correct Incorrect from your body by touching a water pipe  faucet  or other  large metal object before handling the memory module   Or  wear an antistatic wrist strap  if possible  when you  install the memory module        Installing the Memory Module    1 Tum off the machine and disconnect the power cord and  interface cable     2 Remove the right cover     3 Remove the screws and the memory slot cover as shown in  the figure                       4 Remove the memory module from its package     Aligning the cutouts of the memory module with the  matching keys of the socket  carefully plug the memory  module into the memory socket until it clicks in place   Then  push down the memory module to secure                             CAUTION  Before inserting a memory module in the  machine  make sure that the machine is switched off                          Appendix 3       6 After you finish installing the memory module  secure the  memory slot cover with screws removed in step 3     7 Reinstall the right cover     Removing the Memory Module    To remove a memory module  remove the right cover and the  memory slot cover from the machine  Then  carefully push  out the two socket clamps  Ease the memory module out of  the socket to remove     Verifying the expanded memory    To verify that the memory module is working properly  test it  by printing a status page        Ap
13.      2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account      04a  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings     Exit                     11 28    Management             Login User Name   0    Login Password          Login            User Job Account       User Login Set   Unknown ID Job     Exit            Job Account Set    gt     Each Job Account  Account  List      Exit               Default Setting       Copy Print Count  Counter Limit     Exit                  Counter Limit    O  Print Restrict   ScanRest   Other           A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key         NOTE  The User Job Account menu appears Refer to  Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on  entering characters        The User Job Account menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set       5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  Default Setting      7 Press the OK key  The Default Setting menu appears     8 Press the A or V key to select  Counter Limit      Press the OK key  Counter Limit appears     10 Press the A or V key to select the item for which you  want to set the default restriction on the number of  sheets  and then press the OK key        11 29       Management             11 Use the numeric keys to enter the default restriction on    Copy Restriction      the number of sheets  and then press the
14.      3 Press the OK key  Send Job Status appears  Press the  A or V key to check the send queue     Press the OK key to check detailed information of the  selected job        NOTE  You can also check the job information by pressing   Menu   the Right Select key  and selecting  Detail  in the  menu that appears        Press the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the display to other  information items  The items displayed are as follows     Status  status of job    Accepted Time   Job Name   Job Type   User Name   Original Pages  number of pages of the original   Color B  amp  W  color mode of the original   Destination       7 4    Status   Job Cancel       When complete job name not displayed in detailed information    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Job Name to see the complete job name  Press the OK key to return to the  original screen     When complete destination name not displayed in detailed information    When there is only one destination  press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Destination to see the complete  destination name  Press the OK key to return to the original screen     When there are two or more destinations  press  List   the Right Select key  in Destination to display the destination  list  Press the A or V key to select the desired destination and press the OK key  This displays the complete name  of the destination  Press the OK key to return to the destination list     Pressing  Exit   the Right Select key  while the destination list is displayed
15.      7 19    Status   Job Cancel          If you press  Log   the Right Select key   the Log menu    Log   lt 0 appears  From this screen  you can check or print the  lol  Outgoing FAX Log transmission reception history     Incoming FAX Log  Outgoing FAX Rpt       NOTE  If you are using a user management function  the  menu for printing the transmission reception history appears  only when you have logged in as an administrator                 Handling the Devices  USB Memory   SSS SS 1 Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  Status  Kad OK   appears    02  Paper Status  13  Memory Card    USB Memory      Pause               2 Press the A or V key to select  USB Memory         3 Press the OK key  This displays the status of the USB    USB Memory   0 memory   Capacity  173  512 0MB      Remove               Press the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the display to other  information items  The items displayed are as follows        Capacity  Used Area  Free Space  When you press  Remove   the Left Select key   a  USB memory can be confirmation screen appears and you can remove the  safely removed  USB memory     OK               4 Press the OK key  The screen returns to the Status  menu        7 20    8 Default Setting  System Menu     This chapter explains how to configure various settings of the machine using the menus on the  operation panel     e Common Settings xcs   cunncc RUBS Rene nes 8 2  e CODY SCUINGS ienen cite a e a aa 8 68  s Printer Settings  ee e ea aaen 8 7
16.      Default Gateway    IP address       IPv6 Setting    On Off          Protocol Detail    NetBEUI    On Off       SNMPv3    On Off       FTP  Server     On Off       FTP  Client     On Off  Port number  21       SMB    On Off       SNMP    On Off       SMTP  E mail TX     On Off       POP3  E mail RX     On Off       RAW Port    On Off       LPD    On Off       IPP    On Off  Port number  631       IPP Over SSL    On Off       HTTP    On Off       HTTPS    On Off          LDAP          On Off       2 14    Preparation before Use       NetWare    On Off  Frame Type       AppleTalk    On Off       WSD SCAN    On Off       WSD PRINT    On Off       IPSec    IPSec    On Off       Rule Setting    On Off       Secure  Protocol    SSL    On Off       IPP Security    IPP IPP over SSL  IPPoverSSL only       HTTP Security    HTTP HTTPS  HTTPS only          LDAP Security    Off  LDAPv3 TLS  LDAP over SSL       LAN Interface             Auto  10Base Half  10Base Full  100Base Half  100Base Full          NOTE  After all network related settings have been done  turn the machine OFF and ON again  This is mandatory    to make the settings effective           2 15    Preparation before Use       Installing Software  Ensure the printer is plugged in and connected to the PC before installing the printer driver from the DVD ROM     Installing the Software in Windows    If you are connecting this printer to a Windows PC  follow the next steps to install the printer driver  The example  shows yo
17.      Press the A or V key to select  XPS FitTo Page    Press the OK key  XPS FitTo Page appears    XPS FitTo Page  paid OK     On             Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On    Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen        6 4    Document Box          NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu              6 5    Document Box       Saving Documents to USB Memory  Scan to USB     This function allows you to store scanned image files in USB memory connected to the machine  You can store files  in PDF  TIFF  JPEG or XPS format        NOTE  The maximum number of the storable files is 100        Storing Documents  The procedure for storing documents in removable USB memory is explained below     1 Plug the USB memory into the USB memory slot                     2 Press the Document Box key  The Document Box menu  appears        3 Press the A or V key to select  USB Memory    Document Box  pata OK      Sub Address Box  Polling Box  USB Memor             4 Press the OK key  USB Memory appears     USB Memory  Sma OK      Folder 1  fAFile 1 oO      Menu     Select               5 Press the A or V key to select  Store File         NOTE  To save the data in the folder of USB memory  press  the A or V key to select the folder  and then press  Select    the Right Select key  followed by the OK key  The machine  will display documents in the top 3 folder levels  including  the root folder         
18.      Remove any jammed paper        Printouts are wrinkled  or curled        Is the paper damp        Replace the paper with new paper              10 3    Troubleshooting       Symptom    Cannot print     Checkpoints    Is the machine plugged in     Corrective Actions    Plug the power cord into an AC  outlet     Reference  Page       Is the machine powered on     Turn on the main power switch        Is the printer cable  connected     Connect the correct printer cable  securely        Was the machine powered  on before the printer cable  was connected     Power on the machine after  connecting the printer cable        Is the print job paused     Press  Resume   the Left Select  key  to resume printing        Is the error message  displayed     Follow the corresponding  procedure        Documents are  printed improperly     Are the application software  settings at the PC set  properly     Check that the printing system  driver and application software  settings are set properly        Cannot print with USB  memory     Is the USB host blocked     Select Unblock in the USB host  settings        Check that the USB memory is  securely plugged into the machine        When displaying an  image sent from the  machine on the PC  an  image size is shrunk  vertically or  horizontally     Have you selected  200x100dpi Normal or  200x400dpi Super Fine for  the scan resolution     Select a scan resolution other than  200x100dpi Normal or 200x400dpi  Super Fine when sending an  image    
19.      appears     Use the numeric keys to enter the paper length  Y      Press the OK key  Size Entry X  appears     Use the numeric keys to enter the paper width  X      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Orig  Paper Set  menu           Default Setting  System Menu        Paper Size and Media Type Setup for Cassettes  Select paper size and media type for Cassette 1 and optional paper feeders  Cassette 2 to 4      The available paper sizes and media types are shown in the table below     Item Description    Paper Size Letter  Legal  Statement   Executive  Oficio Il   A4  A5  A6   B5  Folio  16K  ISO B5  Envelope  C5  Custom       Media Type Plain  105 g m  or less   Rough  Recycled   Preprint     Bond    Color  Prepunched      Letterhead     High Quality  Custom 1 8              Cassette 1 only   To change to a media type other than Plain  refer to Paper   Weight on page 8 16    To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead  refer to  Special Paper Action on page 8 21     Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type for each cassette        NOTE  When the paper size dial on a cassette is set to OTHER  a paper size can be set for the cassette        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt  gt     Defa
20.      om             Duplex     2 sided       om    lo   1 sided          1  2    Binding Left Right   Binding Top    Top Edge Top   Top Edge Left          Press the Send key   Place the originals on the document processor     Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Duplex      Press the OK key  Duplex appears     Press the A or V key to select  1 sided  or  2 sided      If you select  2 sided   press  Detail   the Right Select  key   select the binding edge and press the OK key  and  then select the original setting orientation on the next  screen     Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     pecify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           Sending Functions       Original Orientation    To send the document in the orientation that can be read properly  specify the upper orientation of original  To use  the functions below  select the orientation in which the original is set on the platen        1 sided   2 sided Selection    When placing the original on the platen                                                                                   Top Edge Top   Top Edge Left        When placing the original on the document processor                                                                O                             Top Edge Top   Top Edge Left        Us
21.      scannerdata    Limit the number of simultaneous users to  20      Comments         Permissions  caching     C ox  cane   apy                            4       a  J   Permissions for scannerdata       Share Permissions      Group or user names              me    Permissions for Everyone Allow Deny  Full Control ia     Change    Read A                    Leam about access control and permissions     ox   _ canca                         Create a folder on the local disk  C         NOTE  For example  create a folder with the name   scannerdata  on the local disk  C         Right click the scannerdata folder and click Share and  Advanced sharing  Click the Advanced Sharing  button     The scannerdata Properties dialog box appears     In Windows XP  right click the scannerdata folder and  select Sharing and Security     or Sharing      Select the Share this folder checkbox and click the  Permissions button     The Permissions for scannerdata dialog box appears     In Windows XP  select Share this folder and click the  Permissions button     Click the Add button        2 33    Preparation before Use           Saari a 5 Enter the user name in the text box and click the OK  button   Select this object type   Users  Groups  or Builtn security principals Object Types     From this location   PC4050 Locations     Enter the object names to select  examples      CD                               OOTA E  6 Select the entered user  select the Change and Read  permissions  and click the 
22.     3 Press the A or V key to select  Service Setting         8 102    Default Setting  System Menu           4 Press the OK key  The Service Setting menu appears   Service Setting   gt  M    Network Status  New Developer    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Auto Drum Refresh         6 Press the OK key  Auto Drum Refresh appears   Auto Drum Refresh    Mm    lo O  L  Standard  Long             7 Press the A or V key to select  Off    Standard  or   Long      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the GE    screen returns to the Service Setting menu     Drum Refresh    This sets the refresh mode for the drum  When the printing quality declines  refreshing the drum can restore the  printing quality  This is primarily used for maintenance by service personnel        7 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  Adjust Maint       Document Box  O Edit Destination  0  Adjust Maint       Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Adjust Maint  menu appears   Adjust Maint      oK    Send Box Density  Correct  Bk Line    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Service Setting         4 Press the OK key  The Service Setting menu appears   Service Setting   gt  M    Network Status  New Developer    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Drum Refresh         8 103    Default Setting  System Menu              Start the drum  refresh   Are you sure       Yes jt    No          6 Press the OK key  
23.     4 Align the paper with the paper width guides and insert as  far as it will go        NOTE  If the paper is considerably curled in one direction   for example  if the paper is already printed on one side  try to  roll the paper in the opposite direction to counteract the curl   Printed sheets will then come out flat           Correct       Incorrect                  When loading envelope  place with the envelope flap  closed and keep the printing side face up  Insert  envelope against the guide with the flap on the front or  left side until they stop     5 Set the MP tray paper size on the printer s operation  panel  Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media on  page 2 49        2 46    Preparation before Use       Loading Envelopes    5 envelope may be loaded in the multi purpose tray  g    Acceptable envelope sizes are as follows                                      Hagaki 148x100  mm   Oufuku Hagaki 148x200  mm   Youkei 2 162x114  mm   Youkei 4 235x105  mm   Monarch 3 7 8 x7 1 2   Envelope  10  Commercial  10  4 1 8 x9 1 2   Envelope DL 110x220  mm   Envelope C5 162x229  mm   Executive 7 1 4 x10 1 2   Envelope  9  Commercial  9  3 7 8 x8 7 8   Envelope  6  Commercial  6 3 4  3 5 8 x6 1 2        To print on envelopes  press the envelope switches in the rear cover to change to envelope mode     1 Open the rear cover     2 Press the two envelope switches  green  to change the  paper feed mode to envelope mode        CAUTION  The fuser unit inside the printer is hot   Do no
24.     Default Setting  System Menu           Optional language Message display          Korean et o04  Simplified Chinese Hh  Traditional Chinese BE 8 ch WZ       If you are using one of the optional languages  it is  displayed in place of Portugues     Press the A or V key to select a language     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Common Settings menu        8 4    Default Setting  System Menu        Default Screen    Select the screen appearing right after start up  default screen   The options are as follows     The table below lists the available screens     Item Description                Status The Status Job Cancel screen  the screen shown  when the Status Job Cancel key is pressed   appears    Copy The Copy screen  the screen shown when the  Copy key is pressed  appears    Send The Send screen  the screen shown when the  Send key is pressed  appears    FAX The FAX screen  the screen shown when the    FAX key is pressed  appears        Document Box       The Document Box screen  the screen shown  when the Document Box key is pressed   appears     Use the procedure below to select the default startup screen        System       Sys  Menu Count      User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit      E 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  paid OK select  Common Settings               Common Settings   Language    Sound    Default Screen      Exit       gt  2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears    lt
25.     Group Name  1 4    Sales Section      Edit            2 Press the OK key  The Edit Destination menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  Address Book      4 Press the OK key  The Address Book list screen  appears     5 Press  Menu   the Right Select key   Menu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  Add Address      7 Press the OK key  Add Address appears     8 Press the A or V key to select  Group      9 Press the OK key  This displays the screen for editing  groups        NOTE  If the maximum number of groups has already been  registered  the screen will display Registered numbers  exceeded  and return to the Address Book        10 Enter each item and then press the OK key  Registered   is displayed and the screen returns to the Address Book  list screen     Refer to the descriptions below for how to enter each  item        8 111    Default Setting  System Menu        Entering Group Name       1 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to display Group Name                                   Detail   lt  0  Group Name  1 4  Sales Section    Edit    3 2 Press  Edit   the Right Select key   An entry screen  Group Name     0 appears   Salesi      ABC    Text    3 Enter the group name   If creating a new group name  the address number  allocated to the destination is already entered   4 Press the OK key  The group name is registered   Entering Group Member  1 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to display Group Member   Detail   lt  0  Group Member  2 3  30    Edit    x 2 Press  Edi
26.     Preparation before Use       Preparation for sending a document to a PC    Check the information that needs to be set on the machine and create a folder to receive the document on your  computer  Screens of Windows 7 are used in the following explanation  The details of the screens will vary in other    versions of Windows        NOTE  Log on to Windows with administrator privileges        Checking what to enter for  Host Name     Check the name of the destination computer     Computer name  domain  and workgroup settings  Computer name  PC4050  Full computer name  PC4050  Computer description   Workgroup  abcdnet   Windows activation   Computer name  domain  and workgroup settings  Computer name  PC4050  Full computer name  PC4050  bcdnet com  Computer description   Domain  abcdnet   Windows activation    Checking what to enter for  Login User Name     From the Start menu  select Computer and then  System Properties     Check the computer name in the window that appears     In Windows XP  right click My Computer and select  Properties  The System Properties dialog box appears   Click the Computer Name tab in the window that  appears and check the computer name     If there is a workgroup    All characters appearing in  Full computer name  should  be entered in Host Name   Example  PC4050     If there is a domain    The characters to the left of the first dot     in  Full  computer name  should be entered in Host Name    Example  pc4050     After checking the computer nam
27.     Replacement of the parts in the  maintenance kit is necessary at every  300 000 pages of printing and  requires professional servicing   Contact your service technician           10 11       Troubleshooting       Responding to an Error Lamp Flashes    If an error lamp flashes  press  Status Job Cancel  to check an error message  If the message is not indicated on the  Message Display when  Status Job Cancel  is pressed or the error lamp flashes for 1 5 seconds  check the following     Symptom    Cannot send fax     Checkpoints    Is the modular cord  connected correctly     Corrective Actions    Connect the modular cord  correctly     Reference Page       Is Permitted FAX No  or  Permitted ID No   registered correctly     Check Permitted FAX No   and Permitted ID No      FAX Operation Guide  Chapter 6  Registering  Permit FAX No   and   Registering Permit ID  No         Has a communication  error occurred     Check error codes in the  TX RX Result Report and  Activity Report  If the error  code starts with  U  or   E   perform the  corresponding procedure     FAX Operation Guide  Appendix   Error Code List        Is the destination FAX line  busy     Send again        Does the destination FAX  machine respond     Send again           Is there an error other  than above        Contact your Service  Representative              10 12    Troubleshooting       Clearing Paper Jams  If a paper jam occurs  a message will be displayed about the jam and copying or printing will sto
28.     TIFF Print  paid OK    0i   Paper Size Z    Image Resolution O  Print Resolution O          XPS FitTo Page    Select the XPS FitTo Page default     2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Function Default      4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  TIFF Print      6 Press the OK key  TIFF Print appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Paper Size    Image  Resolution  or  Print Resolution      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu        NOTE  Refer to page 6 4 for XPS FitTo Page           Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account      Exit               Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit            Use the procedure below to set the default XPS FitTo Page setting     1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears        8 56    Default Setting  System Menu        2 in 1 Layout          Function Default   gt m  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit    XPS FitTo Page  bmg OK    ol Off  On          Press the A or V key to select  Function Default      4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  XPS FitTo Page      6 Press the OK key  XPS FitTo Page appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      8 Press the OK key  Compl
29.     To maintain the right level of moisture content  bear in mind the following considerations        Store paper in a cool  well ventilated place     e Store paper flat and unopened in the package  Once the package is opened  reseal it if the paper is not to be  used for a while        Store paper sealed in the original package and box  Put a pallet under the carton to keep it raised above the  floor  Especially during rainy seasons keep the paper a sufficient distance away from wooden or concrete floors        Before using paper that has been stored  keep it at the proper moisture level for at least 48 hours   e Do not store paper where it is exposed to heat  sunlight  or dampness     Other Paper Specifications  Porosity  The density of the paper fibers  Stiffness  Paper must be stiff enough or it may buckle in the machine  causing jams     Curl  Most paper naturally tends to curl after the package is opened  When paper passes through the fixing unit  it  curls upward slightly  To deliver flat printouts  load the paper so that the curl faces towards the bottom of the paper  tray     Static electricity  During printing  paper is electrostatically charged so that the toner adheres  Choose paper that can  be discharged quickly so that copies do not cling together     Whiteness  Paper whiteness affects print contrast  Use whiter paper for sharper  brighter copies     Quality  Machine problems may occur if sheet sizes are not uniform or if corners are not square  edges are rough
30.     USB memory not  recognized     Check that the USB memory is  securely plugged into the machine        Is the USB host blocked     Select Unblock in the USB host  settings        Vertical streaks  appear on prints     Is the slit glass dirty     Clean the slit glass        The inside of the machine  may be dirty     Check the toner container and if  necessary replace        Refresh drum        The top edge or back  of the paper is dirty     The inside of the machine  may be dirty     Clean the inside of the machine        Part of the image is  periodically faint or  shows white lines     Is the developer unit  attached correctly     Attach the developer unit correctly        Open and then close the rear  cover              Refresh drum              10 4    Troubleshooting       Symptom    Cannot send via SMB     Checkpoints    Is the network cable  connected     Corrective Actions    Connect the correct network cable  securely     Reference  Page       Have the network settings for  the equipment been  configured properly     Configure the TCP IP settings  properly        Have the folder sharing  settings been configured  properly     Check sharing settings and access  privileges under the folder  properties        Has the SMB protocol been  set to  On      Set the SMB protocol setting to   On         Has the  Host Name  been  entered properly     Check the name of the computer to  which data is being sent         Has the  Path  been entered  properly     Check the share n
31.     cccccccsseeessessseeeeseeeeeeeeees 2 8  e Switching the Language for Display  Language            2 9  e Setting Date and Time             cccceeceee cece eeeeeeeettettaaees 2 11  e Network Setup  LAN Cable Connection                  0 2 14  e Installing Software 2 22 eoeri arti od idea en eater 2 16  e COMMAND CENTER  Settings for E mail                  2 28  e Sending E mail  i  2tecfetanticeens see edeteebeetene 2 29  e Preparation for sending a document to a PC              2 31  e Loading PADS Mans core 22h A othe ty erent oe Ree 2 41  s Eoading OMG IAS thefts oii eta leea tesa eee ects he 2 54       2 1    Preparation before Use       Check bundled items    Check that the following items have been bundled     e Quick Installation Guide   e Safety Guide   e Safety Guide  FS 3040MFP  FS 3140MFP    e DVD ROM  Product Library       DVD ROM  TWAIN compatible application     Documents Contained in the Included DVD ROM    The following documents are contained in the included DVD ROM  Product Library   Refer to them as necessary     Documents  Operation Guide  This Guide     FAX Operation Guide    KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide    Printer Driver User Guide   Network FAX Driver Operation Guide   KMnet Viewer User Guide   KM NET for Direct Printing Operation Guide  PRESCRIBE Commands Technical Reference    PRESCRIBE Commands Command Reference       2 2    Preparation before Use       Determining the Connection Method and Preparing Cables    Check the method to conne
32.     off   o2  On             Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      4 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu     When KPDL Auto  Is Selected for Emulation    If you use the KPDL Auto  emulation mode  KPDL and another emulation mode can be automatically switched  according to the data  alternative emulation      For alternative emulation  you can select one of the following printers  The default setting is PCL6     Line Printer  IBM Proprinter  DIABLO 630  EPSON LQ 850  PCL6    Also  as when you select  KPDL   set whether or not to output KPDL error reports  The default setting is Off     Use the procedure below to make the setting        1 In Emulation Set  press the A or V key to select  Emulation set    gt  0m  KPDL Auto       PCL6  KPDL  KPDL  Auto                 8 76    Default Setting  System Menu        EcoPrint    EcoPrint conserves toner when printing  This is recommended for test copies where faded printing is not a problem           Alt  Emulation    0m  DIABLO 630  EPSON LQ 850                KPDL Error Rpt  0  Off  02  On          Use the procedure below to specify the EcoPrint setting        Sys  Menu Count        Common Settings             Copy  Printer     Exit    Printer    O    01  Emulation Set   EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR                  Exit    EcoPrint    O  lo OfE    02  On          1    Press the OK key  Alt  Emulation appears     Press the A or V key to select the printer for alternative    emu
33.    6    7    Press the OK key  Language appears     Press the A or V key to select the desired language and  then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Common Settings menu        2 10    Preparation before Use       Setting Date and Time    Follow the steps below to set the local date and time at the place of installation     When you send an E mail using the transmission function  the date and time as set here will be printed in the header  of the E mail message  Set the date  time and time difference from GMT of the region where the machine is used        NOTE  Be sure to set the time difference before setting the date and time        System Menu   Counter    2       Sys  Menu Count    gt 00  System   User Job Account   05  Common Settings                Common Settings  m  Default Screen  Sound         Exit            Login User Name       Login Password       Login               Date Setting  Said OK    Date Format  Time Zone     Exit               Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    operation panel     In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Common Settings      Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Date Setting   and press    the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The Date Setting menu appears     Press the A or V 
34.    8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Network Settings menu        8 135    Default Setting  System Menu        Protocol Detail    Make other network related settings     NetBEUI    Description    Selects whether or not to  receive documents using  NetBEUI     Default Setting    Restarting the  System        Select whether or not to  receive documents using  LPD as the network  protocol        FTP  Server     Select whether or not to  receive documents using  FTP        FTP  Client     Select whether or not to  send documents using FTP   and the number of the port  to be used     On  Port number  21       Raw Port    Select whether or not to  receive documents using  Raw Port        LDAP    Select whether or not to use  LDAP        SNMP    Select whether or not to  communicate using SNMP        SNMPv3    Set SNMPv3        SMB    Select whether or not to  send documents using  SMB        SMTP   E mail TX     Select whether or not to  send e mail using SMTP        POP3   E mail RX     Select whether or not to  receive e mail using POP3        HTTP    Select whether or not to  communicate using HTTP        HTTPS    Select whether or not to    communicate using HTTPS     SSL must be set to  On  in  SSL Setting on page 8 140           Select whether or not to use  IPP  and the number of the  port to be used        Off  Port number  631             8 136    Default Setting  System Menu        Description    IPP over SSL Select whether or not 
35.    Printing from Applications         20 0    aaaeeeaa 3 16  SONGING ict E EE E dst a E ee E bev Rina es et Es 3 18  Confirm Destination Screen     0 0    tne 3 25  Specifying Destination    0 0    ee 3 26  Canceling JOOS  ots scar seeded anne Poe dak ee alata tan Pw eo EROA EEPE E ale 3 29  Checking Remaining Toner and Paper            0 00 cece eens 3 30  4 Copying Functions  Original SIZE a5 Ayra E neh E Ao ete eo ale dR E EEE hays ona Male 4 2  Paper Selection  24 0  624 eee E E eee oe Cee een See eae eee 4 3  Original  Onientations ic  cbt ee Ak ea Gh edd e a E a aN ah et Bol A he E 4 6  ECOFIN ern id on tee Ba heats Dyce E lds Hea Miele des Gas gh eget E Oh ara ae ets aes 4 8  Combine  Moda ani uar r Strahan aes wee td  Banat tens Se ad had BAe eee aa 4 9  Continuous SCan vee i le na ee Re ed 4 13  Job  Finish Notice  p28 fae ae es a es ar Stee SN Ste ea a Da deg a os 4 14  File Name Entry 0 2  0c  erri ee ek eon ea ek ee ee hae 4 16  Prot Ovendacs raes amak ne sh ad ang I en EEE STAVOREN aha AOE pea aaa aa gee 4 17       Contents       10    Sending Functions    Original SIZE Trene elt  Bel ein Pied eae hi ate a  oot ed Se eee net 5 2  Sending SIZ sais a Pea eh ioe had a a Rola ee Roh ae eb late el tae 5 3  ZOOM csi ck loser Set teh E he cE erences ec Ah T EE Pun E ttre E E go E Ree Nees E E E 5 5  Duplex Sendingen dees oe ara Paks seein a gM eee I Gated aoa Rae ene Be al 5 7  Original Orientation    2 0 0 0    ee eben teens 5 8  File FOnmatess es at ES he eg Ba eth te
36.    Select the default value for layout when  4 in 1  is selected for Combine  Items available for the default value are as    Item Description    follows     Right then Down    Arranges from upper left to right        T4 Down then Right    Arranges from upper left to bottom          Left then Down    Arranges from upper right to left        tT Down then Left       Arranges from upper right to bottom        Use the procedure below to select the default value for layout        System  User Job Account      Exit       05  Common Settings         1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings               8 58    Default Setting  System Menu              Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound         Exit               Function Default  0  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution     Exit                  Detail Setting   lt  lt    4 in 1 Layout  Border Line     Exit                  4 in 1 Layout  Sma OK    foy  Right then Down  t  Down then Right    Left then Down          2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Function Default      4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Detail Setting      6 Press the OK key  The Detail Setting menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  4 in 1 Layout      8 Press the OK key  4 in 1 Layout appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  4 Right then Down    4  Down then Right       L
37.    This machine can emulate the following printers     e    Line Printer  IBM Proprinter  DIABLO 630  EPSON LQ 850  PCL6   KPDL  KPDL Auto        8 74    Default Setting  System Menu        Use the procedure below to select the emulation        R 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  Printer      Common Settings  CoPy  Printer      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears   Printer   gt  m    EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Emulation Set          4 Press the OK key  Emulation Set  appears     Emulation Set   2 0m  PCL6  KPDL    fo7  KPDL  Auto              5 Press the A or V key to select the printer you want to  emulate     6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu        NOTE  If you select  KPDL  or  KPDL Auto    the operation  after selecting the emulation is different from others     If you select  KPDL   refer to page 8 76   If you select  KPDL Auto    refer to page 8 76           8 75    Default Setting  System Menu        When KPDL Is Selected for Emulation    When you use the KPDL emulation mode  set whether or not to output KPDL error reports  The default setting is Off     Use the procedure below to make the setting        1 In Emulation Set  press the A or V key to select  KPDL    Emulation Set           PCL6  KPDL    KPDL  Auto           2 Press the OK key  KPDL Error Rpt appears   KPDL Error Rpt     
38.    To deselect all files  select  Clear All    To show file details  select  Detail     Clear All   Detail                Document Box             Fiala  paid OK    Delete                Copies  aes OK     1   999       MEM copies          9 Press the OK key  The file print and delete selection  menu appears     10 Press the A or V key to select  Print  and press the OK  key        NOTE  To delete the selected file without printing it  select   Delete  and press the OK key  The file deletion confirmation  screen appears  Press  Yes   the Left Select key    Completed  appears and the file is deleted        11 The number of copies screen appears  Set the number  of copies and press the OK key     12 The file print confirmation screen appears  Press  Yes    the Left Select key   Accepted appears and printing  begins        6 12    7 Status   Job Cancel    This chapter explains how to check the status and history of jobs and pause or resume the jobs  being processed or waiting to be printed     This chapter also explains how to check the status of devices     e Checking Job Status             cccccccceseseseeeteeceeeeeteceeceeneeee 7 2  e Checking Job History             0 ccccccececeeeeeeseeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeees 7 8  e Sending the Job Log History                     eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 7 13  e Pause and Resumption of Jobs                        eeeeeeees 7 18  e Canceling of JobS      2 0      cecc eee ete 7 18  e Device CommMunication               c cceeeceeeeeeeeseeeeeceeeeeeeee 
39.    What are network locations   m   Home or work  private  networks  Networks at home or work where you know and trust the people and devit    Windows Firewall state  On    Incoming connections  Block all connections te    2 Click Change settings  select the File and Printer  Sharing checkbox  and click OK     1 From the Start menu  select Control Panel  System  and Security  and Check firewall status     2 Click Advanced settings        2 37    Preparation before Use                         rane cornecsors that   rat nas sia we Sachs  O anore covecors ta tna nas sua oo some    Prvate Prote   Actwe  hes o o       E oreas nan  N Comecnen secat hae     onsen             heca Corset Retreat  HTTP bn  BrwnchGache   Contnet Rawr  GD hocada Howind Cache Sarar HTE BramcnCache   Hosted Cach       EETEERereTy  PEERPEERERY       What type of mule would you ike to creste     Program  Fale that controls connections for a program        controls connections fer a TCP or UDP port   Prodafined   BranchCache  Contert Ratteval  Uses HTTP   Pade Cut controls connections for a Windows wpmence  O Custom  Caton rse                       oes tha tie sooty to TCP or UOP        1c  5 UDP     Doe thes ede apply be al local pots or apeeiiic local pote     EDG                    3 Click Inbound Rules          5 Select Port and click Next     6 Select TCP  select Specific local ports  enter  139   and  click Next        2 38    Preparation before Use             New Inbound Rule Wizard    Action    Spmc
40.    lt i    01  Language  Default Screen  Sound            Exit         Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Color Selection         6 Press the OK key  Color Selection appears   Color Selection  0m    o  Full Color  Grayscale  Black  amp  White                8 42    Default Setting  System Menu        7 Press the A or V key to select  Full Color    Grayscale   or  Black  amp  White      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu     Scan Resolution    Select the default scanning resolution  The options are 600x600dpi  400x400dpi U Fin  Ultra Fine   300x300dpi   200x400dpi S Fin  Super Fine   200x200dpi Fine  200x100dpi Norm   Normal      Use the procedure below to select the default resolution setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            Common Settings   lt i  Default Screen  Sound    2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears  GE      Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Scan Resoluti
41.    page 5 10      page 5 17     page 5 18      page 5 21      Refer to the FAX Operation Guide     Refer to the FAX Operation Guide     Refer to the FAX Operation Guide     Refer to the FAX Operation Guide       page 5 13       viii          Send key Function Menu key   Continued from    Continued from previous  previous page  page        Duplex       PTE       Encrypted TX          File Separation                Document Box key Sub Address Box       Polling Box                      page 5 7     page 5 23     page 5 24       Refer to the FAX Operation Guide     Refer to the FAX Operation Guide                                                                         Job Box    page 6 9  USB Memory     page 6 2   Document Box key Function Menu key Collate   page 3 15   yore aia mon Paper Selection    page 4 3  Duplex     page 3 12  File Name Entry    page 5 17  JobFinish Notice    page 4 14  Print Override    page 4 17  Encrypted PDF      TIFF Print    page 6 3  XPS FitTo Page    page 6 4   Document Box key Function Menu key Color Selection  page 5 15    When saving to USB A     TENT Original Size    page 5 2  Original Image    page 5 12  Scan Resolution    page 5 14  Storing Size azs  Zoom   page 5 5  Orig Orientation    page 5 8  Continuous Scan    page 5 16  File Format    page 5 10  File Name Entry    page 5 17  JobFinish Notice     page 5 21  Density    page 5 13  Duplex    page 5 7                                                                               Status Job Ca
42.    sheets are uncut  or edges or corners are crushed  In order to prevent these problems  be especially careful when  you cut the paper yourself           Appendix 13       Packaging  Choose paper that is properly packaged and stacked in boxes  Ideally  the packaging itself should have  been treated with a coating to inhibit moisture     Specially treated paper  We do not recommend printing onto the following types of paper  even if it conforms to the  basic specifications  When you use these kinds of paper  purchase a small amount first as a sample to test     e Glossy paper   e Watermarked paper   e Paper with an uneven surface   e Perforated paper   Special Paper   This section describes printing onto special paper and print media     The following paper and media can be used     e Transparency  OHP film     e Rough    Vellum  e Labels  e Recycled    e Preprinted      Bond   e Cardstock   e Color  Colour   e Prepunched   e Letterhead    e Envelope  e Thick  e High Quality       Custom 1 to 8    When using these paper and media  choose that are designed specifically for copiers or page printers  such as laser  printers   Use the multi purpose tray for transparencies  thick paper  envelopes  cardstocks  and label paper     Choosing Special Paper    Although special paper that meets the following requirements can be used with the machine  print quality will vary  considerably due to differences in the construction and quality of special paper  Thus  special paper is more like
43.    the Right Select key   press the A or V  Menu   gt  0 key to select  Add Account   and then press the OK key   Detail Edit  Delete   Add Account                     9 Enter the account name and press the OK key   Account Name    gt  0    E       ABC    10 Enter the account code and press the OK key           Account ID   ok     E E E E  NOTE  Any account ID that has already registered cannot    be used  Enter any other account ID                 11 Press the A or V key to select  Exit  and then press the    Sedep 01   lt  OK   OK key   lo  Exit  Detail Select  Detail  and press the OK key to see information    of the registered accounts              12 Account  List is displayed and the new account is added  to the account list     Managing Accounts    This changes the registered account information or deletes the account        11 19    Management       Use the procedure below to manage accounts        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    Q          2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account    Sys  Menu Count   9    04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit    A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and  ET press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login               The User
44.   11 16    Management       Login Logout    If job accounting is enabled  an account ID entry screen appears each time you use this machine     Use the procedure below to login and logout     Login    NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters              Account ID   ok      Counter            Logout    Logout    1 Inthe screen below  enter the account ID using the  numeric keys and press the OK key        NOTE  If you entered a wrong character  press the Clear  key and enter the account ID again     If the entered account ID does not match the registered ID  a  warning beep will sound and login will fail  Enter the correct  account ID    By pressing  Counter   the Left Select key   you can refer to  the number of pages printed and the number of pages  scanned        When the screen to enter the login user name and  password appears    If user login administration is enabled  the screen to enter the  login user name and password appears  Enter a login user  name and password to log in   Refer to Login Logout on page  11 5   If the user has already registered the account  information  the account ID entry would be skipped   Refer to  Adding a User on page 11 6      2 Proceed to complete the rest of the steps     When the operations are complete  press the Logout key to  return to the account ID entry screen        11 17    Management       Managing Accounts    This section explains how to add a new account  The following entries ar
45.   2 41  Placing Originals on  the Platen   2 54       Printing Printing    Copying Functions Documents Stored Printing from     4 1 in USB Memory Applications      6 2    3 16    Operation             Administrator tasks  To send documents    You can send scanned images via a network  Or  you can also store scanned images in  USB memory     sends        Send Send to Saving  as Folder Documents to  E mail  SMB  USB Memory          Plug the USB  memory    Create a shared folder on the destination  computer    2 31    Editing Destination  Address Book Adding  One Touch Keys    8 105  Place the originals on the platen    Sending    3 18  1 Saving Documents  Operation to USB Memory    Sending Functions    5 1  Scan to USB     6 6        1  If the destination is not stored in the address book  you can send by entering the address  directly        vi       Administrator tasks    To send a FAX FAX functions available only in FS 3140MFP       As well as sending a FAX via the telephone lines  you can also send a FAX via a network           It faxes  NOTE  For more information on setting up and sending a FAX  refer to the FAX Operation    a Guide        FAX directly    Send a FAX from a  computer       Connect the modular cord for the  telephone line to this machine   Selection of Telephone Line   Inch version only     Network Setup   LAN Cable Connection          Install the Network FAX  Driver on your computer  1         Selection of Transmit Terminal Identification    1  TTI    2 3 i
46.   2 sided gt  gt 2 sided   press  Detail   the Right  Select key  and you can select the binding edge of the  original     After pressing the OK key  select the binding edge of the  finished copies     After pressing the OK key  select the original setting  orientation     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the basic screen     Press the Start key  Copying begins     If the original is placed on the platen  replace it with the  next one before pressing the Start key     If there is no next original  press  End Scan   the Right  Select key   Copying begins        3 14    Basic Operation       Collate Copying    The machine can collate at the same time as it copies     You can use the Collate copy function for tasks such as those shown below                                Original          Function Menu        Paper Selection O    ea OK                Collate O   Duplex o    Exit     Collate    0   Off   023   On          Scan multiple originals and deliver complete sets of copies as  required according to page number  3    The procedure for using collate copying is explained below     1 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     2 Pressthe A or V key to select  Collate      3 Press the OK key  Collate appears     4 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      5 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the basic screen     6 Use the numeric keys to enter the number of copies  and  press the Start key 
47.   6 6    Document Box             Ready to scan     A440  1 Sided 300x300dpi   2 Sided    ScanRes             6 Press the OK key  The basic screen appears  Change  the original type  file format  etc   as necessary  For  changing scan settings  refer to Sending Functions on  page 5 1     7 Press the Start key  The original is scanned and the data  is stored in the USB memory        IMPORTANT  When removing the USB memory  ensure that  you use the correct removal procedure  as described in  Removing USB Memory on page 6 8           6 7    Document Box       Removing USB Memory    Remove the USB memory        IMPORTANT  Be sure to follow the proper procedure to avoid damaging the data or USB memory           1 Press the Document Box key  The Document Box  Document Box  Kad OK menu appears     Sub Address Box  Polling Box    USB Memor             2 Press the A or V key to select  USB Memory         3 Press the OK key  USB Memory appears     USB Memory  Sma OK      Folder 1  fAFile 1 oO      Menu     Select            4 Press  Menu   the Left Select key   A menu appears   Menu  Folder    pata OK    Memory Detail  Remove Memory       NOTE  This is the image on the screen when a folder is  selected   Open  is not displayed when a file is selected                 Press the A or V key to select  Remove Memory         Press the OK key  A confirmation message appears   USB memory can be    safely removed              7 Press  OK   the Right Select key  or remove the USB  memory  The sc
48.   97 to 14 02   in 0 01  increments    97 to 8 50   in 0 01  increments           X   Y    Metric models X  50 to 356 mm  in 1 mm increments   Y  50 to 216 mm  in 1 mm increments        Use the procedure below to set a custom original size        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   gt m    3 Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set     Default Screen  sound     Exit            4 Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears   Orig  Paper Set   i    5 Press the A or V key to select  Custom Orig Size    Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize     Exit            6 Press the OK key  Size Entry Y  appears   Size Entry Y   aes OK     1 97   8 50  7 Use the numeric keys to enter the paper length  Y      i 3 50 M          8 Press the OK key  Size Entry X  appears   Size Entry  X   aa OK       1 97   14 02   e402 Ff             9 Use the numeric keys to enter the paper width  X      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Orig  Paper Set  menu        8 8    Default Setting  System Menu        Default Original Size Setup    In the screen for setting the paper size for the paper feed cassette or multi purpose tray  select the paper size to be  used as the default value     Use the procedure below to select the paper size to be used as 
49.   Advanced    Protocols  fee     il     gt    E mail Recipient 1  E mail Recipient 2  E mail Recipient 3             SMTP    L gt  General   E mail Recipient 1   E mail Recipient 2   E mail Recipient 3                 SMTP Protocol      on    off    SMTP Port Number  25               SMTP Server Name   mailserver kyocera com    SMTP Server Timeout  30 seconds        Authentication Protocol     On O POP before         2 29    Preparation before Use       2 Enter the correct settings in each field     The settings to be specified in the SMTP settings screen are shown below     Item Description    SMTP Protocol    Enables or disables SMTP protocol  To use E mail  this protocol must be  enabled        SMTP Port Number    Set the SMTP Port Number or use the SMTP default port 25        SMTP Server Name    Enter the SMTP server IP address or its name  The maximum length of the  SMTP server name and IP address is 64 characters  If entering the name  a DNS  server address must also be configured  The DNS server address may be  entered on the TCP IP General tab        SMTP Server Timeout    Enter the default time out for the server in seconds        Authentication Protocol    Enables or disables the SMTP authentication protocol or sets POP before SMTP  as the protocol  The SMTP authentication supports Microsoft Exchange 2000        Authenticate as    Authentication can be set from three POP3 accounts or you can choose a  different account        Login User Name    When Other is selecte
50.   Enter the same e mail  address again and press the OK key                 6 If there are additional destinations  press the Add  Destination key  Repeat steps 2 to 5 to enter additional  destinations  Up to 100 destinations can be specified        3 19    Basic Operation       7 Press the Confirm Destination key to confirm the  registered destinations           Press the A or V key to select a destination and press  Dest  Confirm    lt 0 the OK key  Then  you can edit or delete the destination   WaaaaaaaaaGiiiHHEEHHE  Press  Exit   the Right Select key  to return to the basic  Mbbbbbbbbbet    H H    ale    Exit            8 Press the Start key  Transmission starts        NOTE  If the screen for confirming the destination before  transmission  page 8 88  is set to  On   the Confirm  Destination screen appears when the Start key is pressed   For more information  refer to Confirm Destination Screen  on page 3 25           3 20    Basic Operation       Send to Folder  SMB  Send to Folder  FTP     Stores a scanned original image file in the specified shared folder of any PC     Stores a scanned original image in a folder of an FTP server     NOTE     e Refer to Help of your operating system for details on how to share a folder       Be sure that SMB Protocol or FTP in the COMMAND CENTER is On  For details  refer to the KYOCERA  COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide     e Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters           1 Press the Send key    
51.   Text    A 7 Press the OK key  Body Entry appears  Enter e mail  Body Entry  paid OK   body text  up to 500 characters       If you press the Back key  you can return to Subject  Entry   ABC    Text               8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu     Continuous Scan    Set the continuous scan defaults  The available default settings are shown below     Continuous scan not performed       Continuous scan performed       Refer to page 4 6 for Original Orientation     Use the procedure below to select the default settings for continuous scanning        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit                  8 52    Default Setting  System Menu           Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Function Default  0  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution     Exit                  Continuous Scan   gt i  lo Oft  On             File Format    Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Function Default      Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Continuous Scan      Press the OK key  Continuous Scan appears     Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Function Default menu     Select the default file t
52.   Use the procedure below to set Summer Time        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings  M     o1  Language    Default Screen                Sound    Exit    3 Press the A or V key to select  Date Setting   and press GE  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name  W0 password with administrator privileges to log in  and  pal 2s       SEE press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            4 The Date Settings menu appears   Date Setting   gt  0    Date Format  Time Zone  Summer Time                  Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Summer Time    Press the OK key  Summer Time appears   Summer Time    m  ooff  On             Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Date Settings menu        8 31    Default Setting  System Menu        Auto Error Clear    If an error occurs during printing  the print job stops to wait for the next step to be taken by the user  In the Auto Error    Clear mode  automatically clear the error after a set amount of time elapses   The following errors are automatically cleared     Cannot duplex print on this paper    Send error    Cannot connect to Authentication Server    Incorrect accoun
53.   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i    01  Language    Default Screen    Sound  3    Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set                   4 Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears   Orig  Paper Set   i    ol  Custom Orig Size  Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize                  Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Media for Auto    6 Press the OK key  Media for Auto appears   Media for Auto  paid OK    All Media Type    Transparency             7 Press the A or V key to select  All Media Type  or the  paper type to be used for paper selection     8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Orig  Paper Set  menu        8 19    Default Setting  System Menu        Default Paper Source    Select the default paper source from Cassette 1 4 and Multi Purpose Tray     NOTE   Cassette 2    Cassette 3  and  Cassette 4  are displayed when the optional paper feeder installed        Use the procedure below to select the default paper source        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set          Press the OK key  The Orig  P
54.   characters        Select Character       Enter characters by selecting them  from the character palette that appears        Use the procedure below to adjust the Login Operation        System  User Job Account      Exit    05  Common Settings    1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings            Default Screen  Sound    Exit       2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu    Common Settings    appears     Language          Press the A or V key to select  Login Operation           l Use Numeric Key  Select Character       Login Operation  0m    Press the OK key  Login Operation appears           5 Press the A or V key to select  Use Numeric Key  or   Select Character      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Common Settings menu        8 66    Default Setting  System Menu        RAM Disk Mode    When optional memory is installed  a RAM disk can be created and its size can be set  Creating a RAM disk makes    it possible to print from a Job Box     The procedure for setting the RAM Disk Mode is explained below        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound                                          Exit     RAM Disk Mode  Sai OK    o OfFf  On  RAM Disk Size   1      1   64      64 MiS   Restart     Are you sure       Yes TARSI No            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press 
55.   document processor    the document processor  processor        Maximum Number of    Scanning cannot be performed due  scanned pages  to insufficient memory of scanner   Job is canceled  The job is canceled  Press the OK  key        Is the acceptable scanning Press the OK key to print  send or  count exceeded  store the scanned pages  Press the  Stop key to cancel printing  sending  or storing        Send error  An error has occurred during   HHHH transmission  The possible error  codes and their descriptions are as  follows    1101  The server name of the SMTP  server is not set correctly or the host  name is incorrect when sending scan  data to an FTP server  Use  COMMAND CENTER and register  the SMTP server name and the host  name correctly    1102  The login user name is  incorrect or the domain name has not  been entered  Enter login user name   domain name and password  correctly    1103  The network path name is  incorrect or you do not have access  to the folder specified  Use  COMMAND CENTER and register  the path name correctly    1104  No recipient address  Enter E   mail address correctly    1105  E mail   The SMTP protocol  setting is turned off  Use COMMAND  CENTER and turn on the SMTP  protocol setting    Scan to PC  SMB    SMB setting is  turned off  Use COMMAND CENTER  and turn on the SMB setting    Scan to PC  FTP    FTP setting is  turned off  Use COMMAND CENTER  and turn on the FTP setting    1106  The sender address setting  under E mail  SMTP is not reg
56.   gt   3 Press the A or V key to select  Default Screen            Default Screen   Status  02 Copy   FAX         4 Press the OK key  Default Screen appears    lt  gt           Press the A or V key to select the default screen     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Common Settings menu        8 5    Default Setting  System Menu        Sound  Set options for buzzer sound during the machine operations     The table below lists the buzzer types and their settings and details  The asterisk in the table is a default setting     Description    Key Emit a sound when the  Confirmation control panel are pressed        Job Finish Emit a sound when a print  job is normally completed        Ready Emit a sound when the  warm up is completed        Warning Emit a sound when errors  occur              Use the procedure below to set the buzzer sound for Key Confirmation for example        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i  Language 3 Press the A or V key to select  Sound      Default Screen    Sound            Exit    4 Press the OK key  Sound appears   Sound  Sma OK      FAX Speaker  FAX Monitor    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Buzzer         Press the OK key  Buzzer appears   Buzzer  Sma ok     7 Press the A or V key
57.   i on the FAX Operation Guide  2 1    Place the originals on the platen          FAX Operation   Basic     3 1  on the FAX Operation  Guide    About Network  FAX   7 1   on the FAX Operation   Guide         Operation          1  For more information  refer to the Network FAX Driver Operation Guide    2  If the destination is not stored in the address book  you can send the  FAX by entering the address directly        vii       Menu Map          Copy key       Function Menu key    Paper Selection       Collate       Duplex       Zoom       Combine       Original Size       Orig Orientation       Original Image       Density       EeoPrinkg       Continuous Scan       File Name Entry       JobFinish Notice          Print Override                Send key     Continued on  next page        Function Menu key     Continued on next page     Color Selection       Original Size       Original Image       Scan Resolution       Sending Size       Zoom       Orig Orientation       Continuous Scan       File Format       File Name Entry       Subject  Body       JobFinish Notice       FAX Resolution       FAX Delayed TX       FAX Direct TX       FAX RX Polling             Density            page 4 3     page 3 15     page 3 12    page 3 10     page 4 9     page 4 2     page 4 6     page 3 9     page 3 8     page 4 8     page 4 13     page 4 16     page 4 14     page 4 17       page 5 15      page 5 2      page 5 12      page 5 14      page 5 3      page 5 5      page 5 8     page 5 16   
58.   o  Oo          Details            Allow another program         E              Control Panel Home    System and Security  Network and Internet  Hardware and Sound  Programs    User Accounts and Family  Safety   Appearance and  Personalization    Clock  Language  and Region    Ease of Access    CE e  gt  Control Panel    System and Security    a              Search Control Panel    Action Center   Review your computer s status and resolve issues     Change User Account Control settings   Troubleshoot common computer pre  Restore your computer to an earlier time    Allow a program through Windows Firewall    System  View amount of RAM and processor speed   Check the Windows Experience Inde    Allow remote access   See the name of this computer      Device Manager    Windows Update    Turn automatic updating on or off   Checkfor updates   View installed update     Power Options  Require a password when the computer wakes  Change when the computer sleeps    Change what the power buttons    Aa i   gt  Control Panel    System and Security    Windows Firewall S Search Contre       Control Panel Home    Allow a program or feature  through Windows Firewall    Change notification settings    Turn Windows Firewall on or  off    Restore defaults       Troubleshoot my network    Help protect your computer with Windows Firewall    Windows Firewall can help prevent hackers or malicious software from gain  through the Internet or a network     How does a firewall help protect my computer  
59.   screen        8 115    Default Setting  System Menu        Adding a Destination on One touch Key  This machine has 11 one touch keys and you can register 2 destinations to each of them     The one touch keys are arranged as shown below     No 1 No 2 No 3 No 4  No 12 No 13 No 14 No 15          No 5 No6 No 7 No 8  No 16 No 17 No 18 No 19             NOTE  Refer to One Touch Key on page 3 3 for how to use them        Registering new destination    Use the procedure below to register a new destination under a One touch key        1 Inthe Send or FAX screen  press the one touch key to    Select Key No   0m which you want to register the destination and hold it  2  seconds or longer   Select Key Set  appears   No  12    The screen shown is the one when No 1 No 12 is  pressed and held                   Exit    2 Press the A or V key to select the key number to which  you want to register the destination   3 Press the OK key  The Address Book list screen  Addressbook   gt    appears    amp  Fiala   amp  Maury      Menu               4 Press the A or V key to select the destination you want  to register        NOTE  If you want to search from the Address Book  refer  to Search in Address Book on page 3 27        5 Press the OK key  The selected destination is registered  to the one touch key  Registered  is displayed and the  screen returns to the basic screen        8 116    Default Setting  System Menu        Editing One touch Key  Edit delete the destinations you added to One tou
60.   select  Printer      Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  LF Action      Press the OK key  LF Action appears              CR Action    5 Press the A or V key to select  LF Only    LF and CR  or     Ignore LF      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu     Set the character return action when the machine receives the character return code  character code ODH   The table  below shows the available settings  The default setting is CR Only     Item Description    CR Only    Only character return performed        LF and CR    Character return and line feed performed           Ignore CR    Use the procedure below to specify a CR action           Sys  Menu Count    lt     Common Settings  Copy      Exit            1    No character return performed        In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Printer         8 83    Default Setting  System Menu           2 Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears   Printer   lt  gt  m    EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  CR Action         4 Press the OK key   CR Action   lt       lo  CR Only  LF and CR  Ignore CR             5 Press the A or V key to select  CR Only    LF and CR   or  Ignore CR      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu     Paper Feed Mode    Set the default value of the paper feed direction used for the printer functi
61.   z          NOTE  When loading cover paper in a multi purpose tray  load the face  on which printing is supposed to be done   upward  When loading cover paper in a cassette  load the face  on which printing is supposed to be done  down        Use the procedure below to specify the actions performed for special paper types        7 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0 select  Common Settings      System  User Job Account  05  Common Settings      Exit                  8 21       Default Setting  System Menu              Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound         Exit               Orig  Paper Set   i  Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize     Exit                  SpcialPaper Act   0m    lo AdJ  PrintDirect    Speed Priority                SpcialPaper Act   0m  Adj  PrintDirect    02   Speed Priority          2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set       4 Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  SpcialPaper Act       6 Press the OK key  SpcialPaper Act  appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Adj  PrintDirect  or     Speed Priority      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Orig  Paper Set  menu        8 22    Default Setting  System Menu        Preset Limit  Restrict the number of copies that can be made at one time  Options are 1 999 copies     Use the procedure below to 
62.  10 13  Management   User Login Administration     0 0    0 0 ce E EIA e ERREA EE 11 2  Job  ACCOUNTING      sv aoe tached ies bed nigh ale cde oe as 11 15  Checking the Coume esra Taa a a E A eee eee 11 37  Appendix   Optional Equipment      ansann Appendix 2  Character Entry Method                  0 000 c eee teens Appendix 5  Paperetan s a fore at etree other Ea A ae cake lay Riders GA te NS ura taht oh gh MR Nears Appendix 9  Specifications  sra sabe  a ho n eka Seo a a Wate analy ba  aAa Malady he nae wale Appendix 18  EN ISO 7119 22 5 es ed a Ee Bt ee en a ee ee EY Appendix 21  EK TT B 2000 Ser Sel ooh eld a ee SA Ge Mei at ek MN tee ed Me a a Appendix 21  GIOSSANY chi BN ee ee A ek ee tee aera ot are toe Gia re te et whe tein a Nn aeeal Appendix 22  IND OSX as yn y et sahiorn seat E seins SH E rete andl 4a ae tt atl ahs aot  ea SANE ae A a Index 1          Quick Guide    Be sure to read Legal and Safety Information  before using this machine     Administrator tasks    You can print via a network or print  a PDF file directly from USB  memory     To make copies To print      Simply press the Start key to make  KX copies  You can also fine tune the  copy settings by changing the  paper size  adjusting the density   etc        Printing Documents Print  Stored in Removable via a  USB Memory network    Copying with  specific    settings       Connecting Cables    Network Setup   LAN Cable Connection     Install the printer  driver on your  computer   2 16    Loading Paper 
63.  22                 12 Document Processor   13 Inner Tray   14 Paper Length Guide   15 Paper Width Guide   16 Paper Width Adjusting Tab  17 Paper Size Dial   18 Cassette 1   19 Paper Width Guides                        20 Multi Purpose Tray  MP tray   21 Support Tray Section of the Multi Purpose Tray  22 Handholds  24   amp   SX 23  XS   lt     25  A  25  23 Rear Unit    24 Fuser Cover    25 Envelope Switch       1 5    Part Names       26  27  28  29  30  31    32  33  34  35  36  37  38  39  40  41       Top Cover   Original Width Guides   Original Table   Original Eject Table   Original Stopper   Document Processor Open Close Handle    32  33          34  35             USB interface Connector   Network Interface Connector indicators  LINE Connector    TEL Connector    Rear Cover   Power Cord Connector   Main Power Switch   Handholes   Left Cover   Waste Toner Box     Only on products with the fax function installed              1 6    2 Preparation before Use    This chapter explains the preparations before using this equipment for the first time as well as the  procedures for loading papers and originals     e Check bundled items              c c ccceeeeteeeeeeeeendeeeeeececnecee 2 2  e Determining the Connection Method and Preparing Cables   2 3  e Connecting Gables cs   cticade aie ccs ecccceieeeat 2 5   POWER ONION eneore s durin hate taal achat ine rade deat ATE EEE 2 6  e Auto Low Power Mode            ccccecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneees 2 8  e Sleep and Auto Sleep
64.  27       Management       Default Counter Limit  When you add a new account  you can change the default restrictions on the number of sheets used   You can set any number from 1 to 9 999 999 in 1 sheet increments     The items that can be set differ depending on whether  Split  or  Total  is selected for Managing the Copier Printer  Counts on page 11 22     Available Settings       Split  selected for Copier Printer Count       Copy Restriction    Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets  used for copying        Print Restriction    Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets  used for printing        Scan Restriction   Other     Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets  used for scanning  excludes copying         FAX TX  Restriction       Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets  used for sending faxes   For FS 3140MFP  only        Total  selected for Copier Printer Count       Print Restriction    Sets the default restriction on the total number of  sheets used for copying and printing        Scan Restriction   Other     Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets  used for scanning  excludes copying         FAX TX  Restriction       Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets  used for sending faxes   For FS 3140MFP  only     Use the procedure below to specify the counter limits     1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2    Sys  Menu Count   9     
65.  3 All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following  acknowledgement      This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young  eay cryptsoft com      The word    cryptographic    can be left out if the rouines from the library being used are not cryptographic related        4 Ifyou include any Windows specific code  or a derivative thereof  from the apps directory  application code  you  must include an acknowledgement      This product includes software written by Tim Hudson  tjh cryptsoft com        THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG    AS IS    AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES   INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR  A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE  LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES   INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF  LIABILITY  WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR  OTHERWISE  ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed   i e  this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution lice
66.  8 83   Duplex 8 79   EcoPrint 8 77   Emulation 8 74   Form Feed Timeout 8 82   LF Action 8 82   Orientation 8 81   Override A4 Letter 8 78  Printing 3 16  Printing from a Job Box 6 9  Printing from Applications 3 16  Printing Reports Sending Notice 8 93   Font List 8 94   Network Status Page 8 95   Service Status Page 8 95   Status Page 8 93   Transmission Result Reports 8 96  Private Print 6 9  Product Library 2 2    Q       Quick Copy mode 6 10  Quick Setup Screen  Changing Registration 8 72  8 86  8 90    R       RAM Disk Mode 8 67       Index 4    Index       Rear cover 1 6  Resolution Appendix 19  Appendix 20  Restarting the System 8 119    S    Printer Appendix 20  Scanner Appendix 20    Specifying Destination 3 26  Status   Job Cancel 7 1  Status Page 8 93  Appendix 24       Safety Conventions i  SAFETY OF LASER BEAM  USA  xvii  Scan Resolution 5 14  Default settings 8 43  Send  File Format 5 10  Image Quality 5 12  Original Size Selection 5 2  Sending Size Selection 5 3  Setup 8 86  Sending  Send as E mail 3 19  Send to Folder  FTP  3 23  Send to Folder  SMB  3 23  Sending E mail 2 29  Sending Functions 5 1  Sending Settings 8 86  Quick Setup Registration 8 86  Sending Size Selection 5 3  Sending to Different Types of Destinations   Multi Sending  3 28  Separator  Cleaning 9 5  Setting Date and Time 2 11  Setup  Copy 8 68  Date Timer 8 27  NetWare 8 131  Network 8 120  Printer 8 74  Send 8 86  Sleep 2 8  Slit Glass  Cleaning 9 3  Slit glass 1 4  SMTP Appendix 24  Sol
67.  A or V key to select  Duplex                  3 Press the OK key  Duplex appears   Duplex  bmg OK     0  1 sided gt  gt 1 sided  1 sided gt  gt 2 sided  2 sided gt  gt 1 sied                   4 Press the A or V key to select the desired duplex  copying mode        If you select  1 sided gt  gt 2 sided   press  Detail   the Right    Finish  Binding     lt  gt  Select key  and you can select the binding edge of the   o1   WdLeft Right finished copies and the original setting orientation   Top                  After pressing the OK key  select the binding edge of the  Orig Orientation  m finished copies and the original setting orientation   iiTop Edge Top             If you select  2 sided gt  gt 1 sided   press  Detail   the Right    Orig  Binding   lt 0 Select key  and you can select the binding edge of the  01     AA Left Right original and the original setting orientation   Top                x After pressing the OK key  select the binding edge of the  Orig Orientation  0m original and finished copies  and the original setting  iTop Edge Top orientation           iTop Edge left                3 13    Basic Operation             Orig  Binding  bmg OK    fo    lq Left Right  03 Top          Finish  Binding  0m  0 1   lq Left Right  HTop             Orig Orientation  0m       MiTop Edge left             Scanning     Job No   9999  Page s   1      Cancel               Set original   and press Start key   Job No   9999  Page s   3     Cancel    End Scan           If you select
68.  A or V key to select  Low Power Timer      Press the OK key  Low Power Timer appears     Press the A or V key or numeric keys to set the Low  Power Timer  Set the amount of time before entering the  low power state in minutes     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu        NOTE  Even during unusable time  the machine can be operated by entering the Unlock Code        Use the procedure below to set the Unusable Time        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               Common Settings  M  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login            1    In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key         8 40    Default Setting  System Menu              Timer Setting    0m  Sleep Timer  PanelReset Timer                              Exit    Unusable Time    O  lo7  Oft  On    Exit    Start Time  bmg OK    Hour Min   MY  00     Current Time 11 45                 End Time  Km OK    Hour Min   MY  00     Current Time 11 45                 Unlock Code  Kad OK     0000   9999    0101010           11  12    13    The Timer 
69.  ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY  OR CONDITION OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  THIS  WARRANTY SHALL NOT EXTEND TO  AND KYOCERA SHALL NOT BE LIABLE FOR  ANY  INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WHICH MAY ARISE OUT OF THE USE OF  OR  INABILITY TO USE  THE MFP     KYOCERA MITA AMERICA  INC  KYOCERA MITA CANADA  LTD     225 Sand Road 6120 Kestrel Road  Fairfield  New Jersey Mississauga  Ontario L5T 1S8  07004 0008  USA Canada                   xix       Laser Safety  Europe     Laser radiation could be hazardous to the human body  For this reason  laser radiation emitted inside this machine  is hermetically sealed within the protective housing and external cover  In the normal operation of the product by user   no radiation can leak from the machine     This machine is classified as Class 1 laser product under IEC 60825 1 2007     Caution  Performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual may result in hazardous radiation  exposure     These labels are attached to the laser scanner unit inside the machine and are not in a user access area     DANGER   GLASS 3B LASER  RADIATION WHEN WHEN OPEN     are ae eiai   ATTENTION   MENT ASEAN EN    CAS D OUVERTURE   ExPOSION   DANGEREUSE AU FAISCEAU    VORSICHT   KLASSE 3B LASE argc  en ABDEGKUNG GE  FFNET   NICHT p   sman AUSSI   ATTENZIONE   CLASSE AZIONE LASER I N CASO DI APERTURA   EVITARE ESPOSIZIONE AL FASCIO    PRECAUCION   CLASSE  aB RADIAGIONE LA LASER  CUANDO SE ABRE    EXPONERSE Al   VAROL CANN AERS
70.  Check the address bar  The third and following text  Organize v Include in library    Share with v Burn New folder strings    gt   should be entered for the path    Fr Favorites ne as In Windows XP  double click the scannerdata folder and  rpc Wi projecta yn check the address bar  The text string to the right of the  a or a third backslash     should be entered in Path     o  Example  scannerdata           NOTE  You can also specify a subfolder in the shared folder as the location where data is to be sent  In this case    share name name of folder in the shared folder  should be entered for the Path  In the example window above    scannerdata projectA  is the Path        Configuring Windows Firewall  for Windows 7     Permit sharing of files and printers and set the port used for SMB transmission        NOTE  Log on to Windows with administrator privileges           2 36    Preparation before Use       Checking file and printer sharing       K Siege  gt   gt  Control Panel    System and Security          Control Panel Home    System and Security  Network and Internet    Hardware and Sound    Programs    User Accounts and Family  Safety    Appearance and  Personalization    Clock  Language  and Region    Ease of Access    Y  at  WB       Action Center  Review your computer s status and resolve issues     Change User Account Cont   Troubleshoot common computer problems   Restore your computer to an earlier        Windows Firewall    Check firewall status    Allow a program thr
71.  E mail  Fold j i  Send  Foker  Displays the screen for sending              2 Pressthe A or V key to select  Folder SMB   or  Send to   gt m  Folder FTP      MrE mail  sFolder  SMB    BFolder  FTP           F 3 Press the OK key  Host Name SMB  or Host Name FTP   Host Name  SMB    0 appears     RD Centeri  4 Enter the host name                             ABC    Text   NOTE  Destination can be specified using the Address  Book or the One touch keys  Refer to Specifying  or Destination on page 3 26   Host Name  FTP    0  RD Centeri  ABC    Text    5 Press the OK key  Path appears   6 Enter the path name  Consider  that the share name but  Path   0 not the folder name on the destination PC has to be  RD3  reporti typed in   ABC    Text               7 Press the OK key  Login User Name appears        3 21    Basic Operation             Login User Name   MM                Mauryl     ABC    Text    Login Password   0  LETETETEETI     ABC    Text                  Check the connection   Are you sure       Yes ll No            Data to be entered are as follows     8 Enter the login user name  You have to enter the account  name of the destination PC     9 Press the OK key  Login Password appears     10 Enter the login password  You have to enter the  password of the account on the destination PC     11 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears        NOTE  If the screen for confirming the entry of a new  destination  page 8 88  is set to  On   screens to confirm the  entered ho
72.  Ease of Access Center    oe low vision   Use screen reader   Turn on easy access keys   Turn High Contrast on or off    i aer Cottons   Folder Options   Options  pecity single  or double click to open   Show hidden files and folders    Fonts    Preview  delete  or show and hide fonts   Change Font Settings   Adjust ClearType text      NVIDIA Control Panel    Windows XP  click My Computer and select Folder Options in Tools     2 Click the View tab and remove the checkmark from Use Sharing Wizard  Recommended  in Advanced    settings        r al  Folder Options     General Search    Folder views  You can apply the view  such as Details or Icons  that  you are using for this folder to all folders of this type    a       Advanced settings  Launch folder windows in a separate process a  Restore previous folder windows at logon  V  Show drive letters  V  Show encrypted or compressed NTFS files in color  V  Show pop up description for folder and desktop items  v  Show preview handlers in preview pane    Use   Sag Wizard Fecommerded  pami type into the Search Box      Select the typed item in the view            Restore Defaults                  ok    Caa    Aay _                  2 32    Preparation before Use       In Windows XP  click the View tab and remove the checkmark from Use Simple File Sharing  Recommended  in    Advanced settings     3 Click the OK button to close the Folder Options screen           r  Advanced Sharing     V  Share this folder    Settings    Share name   
73.  Job Account menu appears        Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set     User Job Account         User Login Set   Unknown ID Job    Exit            5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears   Job Account Set    gt  m    Each Job Account  Default Setting    Exit               6 Press the A or V key to select  Account  List         7 Press the OK key  Account  List appears   Account  List    0m    SeGUI Design   eRD Center    Menu               The procedure differs depending on the details to be edited        11 20    Management          Account  List   gt  oK  SUI R amp D DEP   SeRD Center     Menu               Detail   lt   OK    Account Name  1 7  GUI Design      Edit                  Overwrite   Are you sure       eGUI DESIGN         Yes   I No            Account  List  Ka oK  SUI R amp D DEP   SeRD Center     Menu               Menu     oK  Detail Edit    Delete    Add Account          Changing account information    1 Press the A or V key to select the account whose  information you want to change  and then press the OK    key     2 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to select the item you want to  change  press  Edit   the Right Select key   change  account information and restriction of use  and then    press the OK key        NOTE  Activate or deactivate restriction  Refer to  Restricting the Use of the Machine on page 11 23        Repeat step 2 to change items as necessary     4 After completing changing the account information   press the OK key 
74.  License    Copyright  C  1995 1998 Eric Young  eay cryptsoft com  All rights reserved     This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young  eay cryptsoft com   The implementation was written  so as to conform with Netscapes SSL     This library is free for commercial and non commercial use as long as the following conditions are aheared to  The  following conditions apply to all code found in this distribution  be it the RC4  RSA  Ihash  DES  etc   code  not just the  SSL code  The SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that  the holder is Tim Hudson  tjh cryptsoft com      Copyright remains Eric Young   s  and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed     If this package is used in a product  Eric Young should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library  used     This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation  online or textual  provided with  the package     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the  following conditions are met     1 Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer     2 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution    
75.  Login Set    gt m    Local User List  Group Auth     Exit               6 Press the A or V key to select  Group Auth          11 11    Management          7 Press the OK key  Group Auth  appears     Group Auth    gt  oK  lo Oft  On             8 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off    9 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  User Job Account menu     Displaying Network User Propertiy    Use the procedure below to display the property of the user logged on using the network authentication  This menu  can be used only when  Netwk Authentic   is selected as the user authentication method        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2    Sys  Menu Count   9          2 Press the A or V key to select  User Job Account      04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit    A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and  EAEE E press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login               The User Job Account menu appears        Press the A or V key to select  User Login Set     User Job Account  0m    Job Account  Set   Unknown ID Job    Exit                  11 12    Management          5 Press the OK key  The User Login Set  menu appears   User Login Set    
76.  Menu Counter key on the main unit  operation panel     2 Press the A or V key to select  User Job Account      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key         NOTE  The User Job Account menu appears Refer to  Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on  entering characters        3 The User Job Account menu appears        11 31    Management             User Job Account       User Login Set   Unknown ID Job     Exit               Job Account Set    M  Account  Report  Total Accounting     Exit                  Total Accounting   gt  M  Scanned Pages  FAX TX Pages     Exit                  Copy Print Pages   lt     Copy  13  1234567                Total Accounting   gt  M  Printed Pages  Scanned Pages    Counter Reset      Exit                  Reset counter   Are you sure      Total JobAccounting      Yes   I No            10    11    Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set       Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Total Accounting      Press the OK key  The Total Accounting menu appears     Press the A or V key to select the function of which you  want to check counts  and then press the OK key     If you select  Printed Pages  or  Scanned Pages   press  the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the counted items     After confirming the content  press the OK key  The  screen returns to the Total Accounting me
77.  MicroType   fonts by Monotype Imaging Inc  are installed in this machine   This machine contains the software having modules developed by Independent JPEG Group     All other brands and product names are registered trademarks or trademarks of their respective companies  The  designations     and    will not be used in this Operation Guide        xxii       GPL LGPL    This product contains GPL  http   www gnu org licenses gpl html  and or LGPL  http   www gnu org licenses   Igpl html  software as part of its firmware  You can get the source code  and you are permitted to copy  redistribute  and modify it under the terms of GPL LGPL  For further information including availability of the source code  visit http     www kyoceramita com gpl      Open SSLeay License    Copyright  c  1998 2006 The OpenSSL Project  All rights reserved     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or without modification  are permitted provided that the  following conditions are met     1 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer     2 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice  this list of conditions and the  following disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials provided with the distribution     3 All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following  acknowledgment      This product includes software developed by the 
78.  Mode  The device automatically enters Low Power Mode when 2 minutes have passed since the device was last used  The    amount of time of no activity that must pass before Low Power Mode is activated may be lengthened  For more  information refer to Auto Low Power Mode on page 2 8     Sleep  The device automatically enters Sleep when 15 minutes have passed since the device was last used  The amount of    time of no activity that must pass before Sleep is activated may be lengthened  For more information see Sleep and  Auto Sleep on page 2 8     Automatic 2 Sided Copy Function  This device includes 2 sided copying as a standard function  For example  by copying two 1 sided originals onto a    single sheet of paper as a 2 sided copy  it is possible to lower the amount of paper used  For more information see  Duplex Copying on page 3 12     Paper Recycling    This device supports the recycled paper which reduces the load on the environment  Your sales or service  representative can provide information about recommended paper types     Energy Star  ENERGY STAR    Program    We have determined as a participating company in the International Energy Star Program that this  product is compliant with the standards laid out in the International Energy Star Program        ENERGY STAR       XXvi       About this Operation Guide    This Operation Guide contains the following chapters     Chapter 1   Part Names  Identifies machine parts and operation panel keys     Chapter 2   Preparation 
79.  NOTE  For details of other items  refer to Store Job Status  screen on page 7 6              Store Job Log  Kad OK    0008  Scan OK  0009     maury   s data A  0010  aaaa A    Detail    0009 Detail   0  Result  1 9  Error  10200          Press the OK key or  Detail   the Right Select key  to  check the detailed information of the selected job        7 11    Status   Job Cancel       Press the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the display to other  information items  The items displayed are as follows     Result   Accepted Time   End Time   Job Name   Job Type   User Name   Original Pages  number of pages of the original   Color B  amp  W  color mode of the original    Sender Info   destination information     When complete job name not displayed in detailed information    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Job Name to see the complete job name  Press the OK key to return to the  original screen     When complete destination information not displayed in detailed information    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Sender Info  to see the complete destination information  Press the OK key  to return to the original screen        7 12    Status   Job Cancel       Sending the Job Log History    You can send the job log history by e mail  You can either send it manually as needed or have it sent automatically    whenever a set number of jobs is reached     Displaying Job Log History Menu       Sys  Menu Count    0  Counter  System     Exit            Login User Name   O    Logi
80.  OE OA MA lee ol lahat 5 10  Original Images seiis ee ek Ps oe eae ee ot ee ea ef ec he 5 12  Adjusting Density  iyya ota Ran aE e BARS aed be ae RM ee ate A hla ene ead 5 13  Scan  Resolution  sver 204 a Beet ee oad eed Rae een nae 5 14  Color   Grayscale   Black and White Selection            0 00 0  ee 5 15  Continuous Scan    sce ee ee ee ad E dd de ee 5 16  FileName  Entry    i 3 patie cas bas spied ENRE ao EE Wald et Mla a ela dg a eae ENO 5 17  Subject and Body Entry  cec eraci i Eripe ea PEE CER POE ERE nee 5 18  Woran aa a aa a a ord a A a N a N T A E N Seg 5 19  Job Finish Noc  rrr e ee ee ei a ee ee A E 5 21  FEP Encrypted  TA ccsa naro men eraa S GEES a e ahaha a E ace aad ena aed 5 23  File  Separation  sssi eent 2 eae a a aw a a be Peay ee aa 5 24  Scanning Image using Application          auaa auaa 5 25  Document Box   Printing Documents Stored in USB Memory             000  cece eae 6 2  Saving Documents to USB Memory  Scan to USB             0    ce eee 6 6  Removing USB Memory eese ia ene ok EEEa eee eee 6 8  Printing  trom a  Job  BOX    osre aiea dg ae ata ad Gade aaa Gand E alg hand ed OEA Alba 6 9  Status   Job Cancel   Checking Job Status eris ea bat en nee AE E E eea a 7 2  Checking  Job  HSO aaro an an flew aR E habia E REE a E E a A EA aE 7 8  Sending the Job Log History    1 2    0    0 eee 7 13  Pause and Resumption of Jobs             000 0  7 18  Canceling of Jobs  2s    ees ret he ee a ee et ee ea ee ead Pde 7 18  Device Communication      0  ey
81.  OK key    1   9999999   123456 Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to    Counter Limit           12 Repeat steps 10 to 11 set other default restrictions on the  number of sheets        11 30    Management       Counting the Number of Pages Printed    This counts the number of pages printed  Counts are classified into Total Job Accounting and Each Job Accounting   A new count can also be started after resetting the count data which was stored for a certain period of time     Types of the counts are as follows     Printed Pages Displays the number of pages copied and printed   and the total number of pages used  You can also  use  Duplex Pages  and  Combine Pages  to check  the number of pages used        Scanned Pages   Displays the number of pages scanned for copying     faxing  and other functions  as well as the total  number of pages scanned        FAX TX Pages    Displays the number of pages faxed        FAX TX Time  Displays the total duration of fax transmissions           is FAX functions available only in FS 3140MFP      Total Job Accounting Resetting the Counter    System Menu   Counter    2          Sys  Menu Count    0    04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings     Exit                  Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login            This counts the number of pages for all accounts and resets the counts for those accounts together at the same time     Use the procedure below to check and reset the counter     1 Press the System
82.  Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the menu for the selected paper type     When the selected paper type is  Custom 1 to 8   you can  further set whether to enable or disable duplex and the  name of the custom paper type     Press the A or V key to select  Duplex      Press the OK key  The Duplex menu appears     Press the A or V key to select whether to enable or  disable duplex     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the menu for the selected custom    paper type     Press the A or V key to select  Name    Press the OK key  Name Entry is displayed     Enter the name of the custom paper type        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        19    Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the menu for the selected custom    paper type        8 18    Default Setting  System Menu        Media for Auto Selection    When  Auto  is selected in Paper Selection  the paper source that is automatically selected can be limited by media  types  If Plain is selected  the paper source with plain paper loaded in the specific size is selected  Select  All Media  Types  for the paper source with any kind of paper loaded in the specific size     Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type used by Auto Selection        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System 
83.  Printing System  Choose or discover the printing system to install     F Custom select   Discover       Device Type                Finished          Information  T Use host name for port name    oRKYOLERA          Refresh                         Cancel          Installation on a Macintosh    This section explains how to install the printer driver in Mac OS     1 Turnon the printer and the Macintosh     2 Insert the included DVD ROM  Product Library  into the DVD ROM drive     3 Double click the DVD ROM icon        2 19    Preparation before Use       4 Double click either OS X 10 2 and 10 3 Only  OS X 10 4 Only or OS X 10 5 or higher depending on your Mac    OS version                                                              e070 Kyocera G  Gi 2 EEn  eje a    DEVICES  SHARED  n    PLACES   gq f g  SEARCH FOR  lt i Dna L p  Common files Document OS X 10 2 and 10 3 Only   a  a ca    8  8  amp   OS X 10 4 Only OS X 10 5 or higher Readme pdf  E 6 items  Zero KB available  0         A  5 Double click Kyocera OS X x x   e0e OSX 10 5 or higher oO  G 2 z   ee a     gt  DEVICES B   gt  SHARED     E     Kyocera OS X 10 5  build r   gt  PLACES PDL Setup   gt  SEARCH FOR  X 2 items  Zero KB available C        6 The printer driver installation program starts up     AO   install FS C2026MFP  C2126MFP  C2526MFP C2626MFP 3040MFP  3140MF          WZ KYOCERA     Introduction     Read Me     License     Destination Select    Installation Type     Installation      Summary          Welcome 
84.  Protocol   lt    m  SSL   IPP Security   HTTP Security      Exit                  IPP Security    O  IPP IPP over SSL  a TPPoverSSL only          10    The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Secure Protocol      Press the OK key  Secure Protocol appears     Press the A or V key to select  IPP Security      Press the OK key  IPP Security appears     Press the A or V key to select  IPP IPP over SSL  or   IPPoverSSL only      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu     Specify the protocol to be used for HTTP  The default setting is HTTPS only     Use the procedure below to make the setting           Sys  Menu Count        Report  Counter      Exit            1    In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key        8 142    Default Setting  System Menu              Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login               System   gt  oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit                  Network Setting   gt     Host Name  LAN Interface     Exit                  Secure Protocol   gt     SSL  IPP Security    HTTP Security      Exit                  HTTP Security    O  HTTP HTTPS  02 HTTPS only          A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Se
85.  Right Select key   This displays the list of destinations  registered to the group    Morgan   Morgan    Menu               2 Press the A or V key to select the destination you want  to delete          3 Press  Menu   the Right Select key   The group editing  Menu    0 menu appears   Detail    Add Member             4 Press the A or V key to select  Delete         8 113    Default Setting  System Menu              Delete   Are you sure      Msally      Yes lt No            Entering Address Number    5 Press the OK key  A confirmation message appears     6 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   Completed  is  displayed and the screen returns to Group Member     Address Number is an ID for a destination  When creating a new destination  the smallest unused address number  is automatically allocated  You can select any available number out of 100 numbers for individuals and 20 numbers    for groups                 Detail   lt  0  Address Number  4 4  019    Edit    Address Number        001   120           Editing a Destination    1 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to display Address Number     2 Press  Edit   the Right Select key   An entry screen  appears     3 Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to enter the  address number     4 Press the OK key  The address number is registered        NOTE  If you enter an address number that is already  registered  the screen will display This address number is  already registered  and return to the screen of step 2        Edit delete the dest
86.  Right Select key   the             ABC character type switches as follows  ABC  123  Symbol     Text   ABC      123    Text    Symbols   gt  oK    JLI ESHE Cet       5  lt    POO ALE el el      Text                        Symbols    NOTE  By pressing     on the numeric keys while entering  characters  you can directly display the Symbols screen                       Appendix 6       Entering Characters    After selecting a character type  use the procedure below to enter characters     Entering Alphabets and Numerals    Referring to the table below  press the key corresponding to the character you want to enter until it is displayed     Entry mode    Alphabetic Symbol    Available characters       Numeric       Alphabetic Symbol    abcABC2       Numeric    2       Alphabetic Symbol    defDEF3       DO O    Numeric    3       Alphabetic Symbol    ghiGHI4       Numeric    4       Alphabetic Symbol    jkIJKL5       Numeric    5       Alphabetic Symbol    mnoMNO6       Numeric    6       Alphabetic Symbol    pqrsPQRS7       4   A  7    Numeric    7       E   lt     Alphabetic Symbol    tuvTUV8       Numeric    8       Alphabetic Symbol    wxyzWXYZ9       Numeric    9       Alphabetic Symbol       _        space  0                            Numeric    0       T   gt     Alphabetic Symbol    Switch between upper  lowercase       Numeric      or    decimal point         Alphabetic Symbol  Numeric                3  om  o                    is entered when  123  is selected in the c
87.  Rules  These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation  This  equipment generates  uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and  if not installed and used in accordance with the  instructions  may cause harmful interference to radio communications  However  there is no guarantee that interference will not  occur in a particular installation  If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception  which can be  determined by turning the equipment off and on  the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the  following measures     e Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna    e Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver    e Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected   e Consult the dealer or an experienced radio TV technician for help    e The use of a non shielded interface cable with the referenced device is prohibited     CAUTION     The changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user   s  authority to operate the equipment     This device complies with Part 15 of FCC Rules and RSS Gen of IC Rules     Operation is subject to the following two conditions   1  this device may not cause interference  and  2  this device must accept  any interference  including interference that may cause undesired operation o
88.  Scan Resolution  e Sending Size   e Zoom   e Orig Orientation  e Continuous Scan  e File Format   e File Name Entry  e Subject Body   e JobFinish Notice     FAX Resolution  e FAX Direct TX   e FAX Delayed TX     FAX RX Polling   e Density   e Duplex   e FTP Encrypted TX  e File Separation       8 86    Default Setting  System Menu        Use the procedure below to set Select Key Set        R 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    lt    select  Send      Copy  Printer    Send      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Send menu appears   Send     oK    0  Select Key Set     DestinationCheck                                 Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Select Key Set     4 Press the OK key  Select Key Set  appears   Select Key Set    gt  m  8  Right    Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Left  or  Right    7 6 Press the OK key  This displays the function selection  Left   gt  0 screen for the flexible key selected in step 5  The screen  Color Selection shown is the one when  Left  is selected     Original Size    Original Image             7 Press the A or V key to select the function you want to  register to the flexible key     8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Send menu           IMPORTANT  If you try to set the function that is registered  This function is to the other flexible key  you cannot set it and This function is  already registered  already registered  is displayed   
89.  System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   gt       Language    Default Screen                Sound    Exit    3 Press the A or V key to select  Date Setting   and press  the OK key   f A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and  pie a hl thi  a press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login                  8 27    Default Setting  System Menu              Date Setting   gt  0  Date Format  Time Zone     Exit                  Date Time   lt  m  Year Month Day    2011 01 01     Time Zone Greenwich                 Date Time    0m  Hour Min  Second    45  50     Time Zone Greenwich           10    The Date Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Date Time      Press the OK key  The screen to enter the date of Date   Time appears     Set the date     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to move to the item  Year   Month    Day  you want to enter     Press the A or V key to set each item     Press the OK key  The screen to enter the time of Date   Time appears     Set the time     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to move to the item  Hour   Min     Second  you want to enter     Press the A or V key to set each item     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Date Settings menu        NOTE  If you try to change the date time when a trial  ap
90.  Timer                     Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Auto Sleep    6 Press the OK key  Auto Sleep appears   Auto Sleep  Sma OK    Off             7 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu     e Sleep Timer    If you select  On  for Auto Sleep  set the amount of time to wait before Auto Sleep  Options are between 1 and 240  minutes  every one minute     Use the procedure below to set the Auto Sleep time  The default setting is 75 minutes        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit                  8 35    Default Setting  System Menu              Common Settings  M  Default Screen  Sound         Exit            Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login               Timer Setting    O  Sleep Timer  PanelReset Timer                  Exit    Sleep Timer        1   240    S          Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The Timer Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Sleep Timer      Press the OK key  Sleep Timer appears     Press the A or V key to set the Sleep Timer  S
91.  Use       12 Select the options available for the printer and click Continue        Add Printer  mel Al         m    gt      a  Default Fax   IP   Windows Search             Installable Options    Make sure your printer s options are accurately shown here so you can take  full advantage of them  For information on your printer and its optional  hardware  check the documentation that came with it     Paper Feeders    Three  E   Optional Disk    RAM Disk 18        Cancel     Continue            13 The selected printer is added  This completes the printer setup procedure     80o       Print  amp  Fax        se rowa es             i      Idle t Use P n    Options  amp  Supplies       Status  Idle          Default printer    Last Printer Used     _  Share this printer on the network Sharing Preferences         Default paper size    A4       N  W Click the lock to prevent further changes        Uninstalling Software  Windows PC     The software can be uninstalled  removed  using the DVD ROM  Product Library  supplied with the printer        IMPORTANT  On Macintosh computers  because the printer settings are specified using a PPD  PostScript Printer    Description  file  the software cannot be uninstalled using the DVD ROM  Product Library         1 Exit all active software applications     2 Insert the enclosed DVD ROM  Product Library  into the DVD ROM drive  In Windows 7  Windows Server 2008    and Windows Vista  the user account control window may appear  Click Allow     3 Foll
92.  V key to select  Orig  Paper Set          Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears   Orig  Paper Set   i    Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  MP Tray Set          8 14    Default Setting  System Menu              MP Tray Set   bmg OK      ol  MP Tray Size    MP Tray Type      Exit                  MP Tray Size  pai OK    A5      a6 D                MP Tray Set   Km OK    MP Tray Size    MP Tray Type      Exit                  MP Tray Type  Km OK    Transparency  Rough          6 Press the OK key  The MP Tray Set  menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  MP Tray Size      8 Press the OK key  MP Tray Size appears     9 Press the A or V key to select the paper size     10 Press the OK key  The screen returns to the MP Tray  Set  menu     11 Press the A or V key to select  MP Tray Type      12 Press the OK key  MP Tray Type appears     13 Press the A or V key to select the paper type     14 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the MP Tray Set  menu        8 15       Default Setting  System Menu        Paper Weight    The machine is capable of printing under the optimum setting for the type of paper being used  A different paper type  setting can be made for each paper source including the MP tray  Not only can preset paper types be selected  but it  is also possible for you to define and select customized paper types  Paper type can be changed using the printer  driver an
93.  You may choose Auto mode as the default setting  refer to Density on page 8 45         The procedure for adjusting the density of copies is explained below     1 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears                          Function Menu  pala OK   Collate Oo  Duplex o    Exit    2 Press the A or V key to select  Density    se 3 Press the OK key  Density appears   Density  bmg OK    Auto  02  Manual  4 Press the A or V key to select  Auto  or  Manual    Press the OK key   Manual  Sma OK    ElLighter  1 When  Manual  is selected  Manual appears  Press the  FlNormall 0 Aor V key to select your desired density and then press    Darker  1 the OK key           Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen        6 Press the Start key  Copying begins        3 8    Basic Operation       Selecting Image Quality    Select image quality suited to the type of original     The table below shows the quality options     Image Quality Option Description    Text Photo    For originals with both text and  photographs        Photo    For photos taken with a camera        Text    For originals primarily consisting of text           The procedure for selecting the quality of copies is explained below           Function Menu     ol  Paper Selection O    1 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     om                Collate O  Duplex o    Exit     2 Pressthe A or V key to select  Original Image    3 Press the OK key  Original Image appears    Origin
94.  administrator privileges to log in  and  ET press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password        l NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for    Login   details on entering characters              3 The User Job Account menu appears        4 Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set     User Job Account         User Login Set   Unknown ID Job    Exit                  11 22    Management          5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears   Job Account Set   lt  M    Account Report  Total Accounting    Exit               6 Press the A or V key to select  Default Setting         7 Press the OK key  The Default Setting menu appears   Default Setting   gt  M    Apply Limit  Counter Limit    Exit               8 Press the A or V key to select  Copy Print Count         9 Press the OK key  Copy Print Count appears   Copy Print Count   gt       Total   Split             10 Press the A or V key to select  Total  or  Split      11 Press the OK key   Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the    Default Setting menu     Restricting the Use of the Machine  This section explains how to restrict the use of the machine by account or the number of sheets available     The items that can be restricted differ depending on whether  Split  or  Total  is selected for Managing the Copier   Printer Counts on page 11 22        11 23    Management       Restriction Items       Split  selected for Copier Printer Count    Print Restriction     Copie
95.  and then the Add port    button     3 Specify Add a Port settings     Enter any name in  Name   example  Scan to SMB   This will be the name of the new port  Enter  139  in  Port  Number   Select TCP for  Protocol      4 Click the OK button to close the Folder Options screen           2 40    Preparation before Use       Loading Paper    Paper can be loaded standardly in the cassette and the multi purpose tray  A paper feeder is also available as an    option  refer to Optional Equipment on Appendix 2      Before Loading Paper    ER GS  f N  A  gt   Ti  e       When you open a new package of paper  fan the sheets to  separate them slightly prior to loading in the following steps     Bend the whole set of sheets to swell them in the middle     Hold the stack at both ends and stretch it while keeping  the entire stack swelled     Raise the right and left hands alternately to create a gap  and feed air between the papers     Finally  align the papers on a level  flat table     If the paper is curled or folded  straighten it before  loading  Paper that is curled or folded may cause a jam        CAUTION  If you copy onto used paper  paper already used    for copying   do not use paper that is stapled or clipped  together  This may damage the machine           NOTE  If printouts are curled or not neatly stapled  turn the    stack in the cassette upside down        Avoid exposing opened paper to high temperatures and  high humidity as dampness can be a cause of problems   Seal any 
96.  and types that can be used in the paper source     Cassette    Supported types    Plain  Preprinted  Bond  Recycled   Rough  Letterhead  Color  Colour    Prepunched  High Quality  Custom 1  to 8    Optional paper feeder    Supported types    Plain  Preprinted  Bond  Recycled   Rough  Letterhead  Color  Colour    Prepunched  High Quality  Custom 1  to 8    Multi Purpose tray  MP tray     Supported types       Plain    Preprinted  Labels  Bond   Recycled  Rough  Vellum   Letterhead  Color  Colour   High  Quality  Custom 1 to 8          Supported paper sizes    A4  JIS B5  A5  Folio  Legal  Letter   Oficio Il  Statement  Executive  A6   B6  ISO B5  Envelope C5  16K   Custom  105 x 148 to 216 x 356mm   4 1 8 x 5 13 16 to 8 1 2 x 14 inches        Supported paper sizes    A4  JIS B5  A5  Folio  Legal  Letter   Oficio Il  Executive  B6  ISO B5   Envelope C5  16K  Custom  148 x 210  to 216 x 356mm  5 13 16 x 8 5 16 to  8 1 2 x 14 inches        Supported paper sizes    Letter  Legal  Statement  Executive   Oficio Il  A4  A5  A6  B5  B6  Folio   16k    Other sizes    Portrait 2 76 to 8 50  or 70 to 216 mm  Landscape 5 83 to 14 02  or 148 to  356 mm          No  of sheets    500  80g m      No  of sheets    500  80g m      No  of sheets    100  80g m            Thick paper A4  JIS B5  A5  Folio  Legal  Letter  1  Oficio Il  Statement  Executive  A6   B6  ISO B5  16K  Other sizes   Portrait 2 76 to 8 50  or 70 to 216 mm  Landscape 5 83 to 14 02  or 148 to  356 mm   Postcards Postcards  
97.  brings you back to the original screen     The table below lists the items displayed in the Sending Jobs Status screen     Item   Key Detail    Acceptance No  of job       Icons that indicate the job type  Sending Job FAX        Sending Job PC  SMB   gs     Sending Job PC  FTP  I  Sending Job E mail       Sending Job TWAIN2 Fi    m   Sending Job WSD Scan fF    When broadcast sending is done   Broadcast is displayed next to the  icon        Destination Destination  Either destination name   FAX number  E mail address  or  server name        Status of job   Be Sending   no icon  Sending Waiting  I  Pausing the job  X  Stop sending                7 5       Status   Job Cancel       Store Job Status screen          Status  Sma OK    Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause               Store Job Status   0  0008  44Scan                      1 2 3 4  0009 Detail   0  Status  1 8  Processing          Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  appears     Press the A or V key to select  Store Job Status      Press the OK key  Store Job Status appears  Press the  A or V key to check the store queue     Press the OK key to check detailed information of the  selected job        NOTE  You can also check the job information by pressing   Menu   the Right Select key  and selecting  Detail  in the    men    u that appears        Press the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the display to other  information items  The items displayed are as follows     Status  status of job    Accepted T
98.  conforms to the following specifications     Item Specifications    Top sheet weight 44 to 74 g m        Basis weight 104 to 151 g m    overall paper weight        Top sheet thickness 0 086 to 0 107 mm       Overall paper thickness 0 115 to 0 145 mm          Moisture content 4 to 6    composite        Colored Paper    Colored paper must conform to the specifications listed on the page 11 of the Appendix  In addition  the pigments in  the paper must be able to withstand the heat of printing  up to 200  C or 392  F   S  Preprinted Paper    Preprinted paper must conform to the specifications listed on the page 9 of the Appendix  The colored ink must be  able to withstand the heat of printing  It must be resistant to silicone oil as well  Do not use paper with a treated surface  such as glossy paper used for calendars     Recycled Paper    Recycled paper must conform to the specifications listed on the page 11 of the Appendix  however  its whiteness may  be considered separately        NOTE  Before purchasing recycled paper in volume  try testing a sample to ensure that the print quality           Appendix 17       Specifications       NOTE  Specifications are subject to change without notice        Machine    Item Description    Type    Desktop       Printing Method    Electrophotography by semiconductor laser  single drum system       Supported Original Types    Sheet  Book  3 dimensional objects  maximum original size  Folio Legal        Original Feed System    Fixed       Pa
99.  copied    8   Displays the number of destinations    9   Displays the destination              3 6    Basic Operation       Copying  Follow the steps as below for basic copying     1 Press the Copy key when the Copy key indicator is off     Copy  NOTE  If the Message Display is turned off  press the 3    Power key and wait for the machine to warm up              2 Place the originals on the platen or in the document  processor        NOTE  For loading instructions  refer to Loading  Originals on page 2 54              3 The paper source for copying is the location displayed on  Ready to copy  the panel     Copies  1   Letter a 2  Letter P  100      Zoom     Paper                           Paper source       A When you need to change the paper source  use the  Paper Selection  V0 Paper Selection menu  If  Auto  is selected  the most  0   Auto suitable paper source is automatically selected   wad D Pain For specifying the paper source  refer to Paper  2      BIAS D Plain Selection on page 4 3              4 Use the numeric keys to enter the copy quantity  Specify  the desired number up to 999     5 Press the Start key to start copying              3 7    Basic Operation       6 Remove the finished copies from the top tray   Adjusting Density    Use this procedure to adjust the density when copying     Density Adjustment Option Description    Manual Adjust density using 7 levels        Auto Optimum density is selected according  to the density of the original              NOTE 
100.  detailed information    When the job name in Job Name is displayed in a short form  press  Detail   the Right Select key  to see the complete  job name  Press the OK key to return to the original screen     When complete destination information not displayed in detailed information    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Sender Info  to see the complete destination information  Press the OK key  to return to the original screen        7 9    Status   Job Cancel       Displaying Send Job Log          Status  Sma OK    Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause                  Send Job Log  Kad OK    0004 MBroadcast OK  0003  40756545865 OK  0002 MmMorgan kyoc     A     Detail            Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  appears     Press the A or V key to select  Send Job Log      Press the OK key  Send Job Log appears  Press the A  or V key to check the send log     Ajob result icon is displayed on the extreme right of each  job     OK   Job completed normally  A   Job error      Job aborted       NOTE  For details of other items  refer to Send Job Status  screen on page 7 4              0004 Detail   0  Result  1 9  OK          Press the OK key or  Detail   the Right Select key  to  check the detailed information of the selected send log     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the display to other  information items  The items displayed are as follows     Result   Accepted Time   End Time   Job Name   Job Type   User Name   Original Pages  number of pa
101.  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The User Job Account menu appears     4 Press the A or V key to select  Unknown ID Job      5 Press the OK key  Unknown ID Job appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  Reject  or  Permit    7 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  User Job Account menu        11 14    Management       Job Accounting    Job accounting Manages the copy print count accumulated by individual accounts by assigning an ID to each  account     Job accounting helps the following activities in business organizations     e Manageability of up to 20 individual accounts    e Availability for account IDs with as many as eight digits  between 0 and 99999999  for security    e Integrated management of printing and scanning statistics through the use of an identical account ID   e Tracking the print volume for each account and for all accounts combined    e Restricting the print counter in one page increments up to 9 999 999 copies    e Resetting the print counter for each account or for all accounts combined     First Job Accounting Setup  Follow these steps for the first job accounting setup   Enable job accounting   page 11 15   v  Add an account   page 11 18   v  Log out   page 11 17   v    Other users log in for operations   page 11 17     Enabling Disabling Job Accounting  Enable job accounting  Use the procedure below to specify the job accoun
102.  gently a few times with a ruler  Printing onto paper with rough edges  may cause jams        NOTE  If the paper is not supplied correctly even after it is smoothed  load the paper in the multi purpose tray with  the leading edge raised a few millimeters        Label  Be sure to feed labels from the multi purpose tray     For selecting labels  use extreme care so that the adhesive may not come in direct contact with any part of the  machine and that the labels are not easily peeled from the carrier sheet  Adhesives that stick to the drum or rollers  and peeled labels remaining in the machine may cause a failure     When printing onto labels  you must be liable for the print quality and possible trouble     Labels consist of three layers as shown in the illustration  The  adhesive layer contains materials that are easily affected by  the force applied in the machine  The carrier sheet bears the      Top sheet top sheet until the label is used  This composition of labels    I Adhesive layer may cause more problems         Carrier sheet The label surface must be covered completely with the top  sheet  Gaps between labels may cause peeling of labels   resulting in a serious failure                 Appendix 16       Some label paper has large margins on the top sheet  When using such paper  do not peel these margins from the  carrier sheet before completing output     Allowed Not allowed             lt t    Top sheet       Carrier sheet                         Use label paper that
103.  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 14    Sending Functions       Color   Grayscale   Black and White Selection    This feature allows you to select the select the color mode used for scanning when sending images  You can select  from Full Color  Grayscale or Black  amp  White     Use the procedure below to select the color mode when sending scanned images   1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid OK     0  Color Selection O  Original Size Oo    Original Image O    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  Color Selection         5 Press the OK key  Color Selection appears   Color Selection  0m    o Full Color  Grayscale  Black  amp  White             6 Press the A or V key to select the desired color mode   7 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     8 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 15    Sending Functions       Continuous Scan    When the multi page originals cannot be placed in the document processor at one time  the originals can be scanned  in separate batches and then sent as one job  Wit
104.  key to select  I F Block Set          4 Press the OK key  The I F Block Set  menu appears   I F Block set         USB Host  Option I F    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  USB Device         8 147    Default Setting  System Menu           6 Press the OK key  USB Device appears     USB Device    O  o  Unblock  Block             7 Press the A or V key to select  Unblock  or  Block      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the System menu     Optional interface  Optional interface card setting     This locks and protects the optional interface slot  The default setting is Unblock     Use the procedure below to specify the optional interface setting          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  System      Report  Counter  System      Exit            7 A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name  W password with administrator privileges to log in  and    BE press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            2 Press the OK key  The System menu appears   System  Km oK    Network Setting  Security Level    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  I F Block Set          Press the OK key  The I F Block Set  menu appears   I F Block set         USB Host  USB Device  Option I F      Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Option I F         8 148    Default Setting  System Menu              6 Press the OK k
105.  not more than 20  of the total paper content  consists of cotton or other fibers     Supported Paper Sizes  Paper of the following sizes is supported by the machine     Measurements in the table take into account a  0 7 mm dimensional accuracy for length and width  Corner angles  must be 90     0 2       Cassette or Multi    Multi Purpose Tray Purpose Tray    B6  128 x 182 mm     Letter       ISO B5  176 x 250 mm     Legal       Envelope  10  Commercial  10   4 1 8 x 9 1 2      Statement         Envelope  9  Commercial  9   3 7 8 x 8 7 8      Executive       Envelope  6  Commercial  6 3 4   3 5 8 x 6 1 2      Oficio II       Envelope Monarch  3 7 8 x 7 1 2      A4  297 x 210 mm       Envelope DL  110 x 220 mm     A5  210 x 148 mm       Envelope C5  162 x 229mm     A6  105 x 148 mm          Hagaki  100 x 148mm                   B5  257 x 182 mm       Oufuku Hagaki  148 x 200 mm     Folio  210 x 330 mm        Youkei 4  105 x 235 mm     16K  273 x 197 mm        Youkei 2  114 x 162 mm        Size Entry  70 x 148 to 216 x 356 mm        A Except for the optional cassettes        Smoothness    The paper surface should be smooth  but it must be uncoated  With paper that is too smooth and slippery  several  sheets may accidentally be supplied at once  causing jams        Appendix 12       Basis Weight    In countries that use the metric system  basis weight is the weight in grams of one sheet of paper one square meter  in area  In the United States  basis weight is the weight in poun
106.  purchase     In order to obtain performance of this warranty  the Customer must immediately notify the Authorized  Kyocera Dealer from whom the product was purchased  If the Kyocera Dealer is not able to provide  service  write to Kyocera at the address below for the name and address of the Authorized Kyocera  Dealer in your area or check Kyocera   s website at www kyoceramita com us     This warranty does not cover MFP   s or accessories  which   a  have become damaged due to  operator negligence  misuse  accidents  improper storage or unusual physical or electrical stress    b  have used parts or supplies which are not genuine Kyocera brand parts or supplies   c  have  been installed or serviced by a technician not employed by Kyocera or an Authorized Kyocera  Dealer  or  d  have had the serial number modified  altered  or removed     This warranty does not cover Maintenance Kits or the components of Maintenance Kits  which  consist of the developing unit  the drum unit  the transfer roller  the fixing unit and the feed roller unit   which have a separate warranty     This warranty gives the Customer specific legal rights  The Customer may also have other rights   which vary from state to state  or province to province  Neither the seller  nor any other person  is  authorized to extend the time period or expand this warranty on behalf of Kyocera     THIS WARRANTY IS MADE IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES AND CONDITIONS   EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  AND KYOCERA SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS
107.  purpose tray     Load the paper in the multi purpose  tray which is of the size and type  indicated on the Message Display        Toner is running out     Prepare the toner container        Add toner     Is the displayed message  accompanied by a lit error  LED     Replace the toner container        Check waste toner  box     Prepare the waste toner box        Waste toner box is full     Replace the waste toner box        Check cassette 1     Does a paper lift error occurr  in the paper source s  cassette     Pull out the cassette for the paper  source displayed  either the paper  cassettes or optional paper feeders   and check if the paper is loaded  correctly        Cannot connect to  Authentication Server     Press the OK key and check the  following items     e Registration to Authentication  Serve    Password and computer address  for Authentication Server    e Connection of Network       Cannot duplex print  on this paper     Did you select a paper size   media type that cannot be  duplex printed     Select the available paper type   Press the OK key to print without  using Duplex        Account error     Set the accounting settings using  PRESCRIBE again        Incorrect account ID   Job is canceled     This job is canceled because it is  restricted by Job Accounting  Press  the OK key        Restricted by Job  Accounting  Cannot  print     This job cannot be printed because it  is restricted by Job Accounting  Press  the OK key        Cannot execute this  job  Restri
108.  returns to the Date Settings menu        8 29    Default Setting  System Menu        Time Zone    Set the time difference in the location you are from GMT     Use the procedure below to set the time difference        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               Common Settings  M  Default Screen  Sound     Exit               Login User Name   0    Login Password       Menu     Login               Date Setting   gt  0m  Date Format  Time Zone     Exit                  Time Zone    O  GMT Casablanca    B1  GMT Greenwich    EJ  01 00 Amsterdam          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  Date Setting   and press  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      4 The Date Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Time Zone      Press the OK key  Time Zone appears     7 Press the A or V key to select your location     8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Date Settings menu        NOTE  If you select a region that does not utilize summer  time  the summer time setting screen will not appear           8 30    Default Setting  System Menu        Summer Time  Set whether or not to apply summer time to the display of the date   
109.  to select  Key Confirmation    Job finish  Ready     Exit                  8 6    Default Setting  System Menu                    8  Key Confirmation  Mm  On  9  10  Display Bright     Set the brightness of the display     Use the procedure below to adjust the display brightness     1       Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Display Bright    gt m  Darker  1    4 Normal 0    Lighter 1             Original Paper Settings  Register additional types and sizes of originals and paper     Custom Original Size Setup    Press the OK key  Key Confirmation appears     Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Buzzer menu     In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Common Settings      Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu    appears     Press the A or V key to select  Display Bright       Press the OK key  Display Bright  appears     Press the A or V key to select the display brightness    from  Darker  3  to  Lighter  3      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Common Settings menu     Set up frequently used custom original size  The dimensions available are as follows        8 7    Default Setting  System Menu        The table below lists the sizes that can be registered     Input units Dimensions    Inch models
110.  to select  Top Edge Top  or  Top  Edge Left      7 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     8 Press the Start key to start copying        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 7    Copying Functions       EcoPrint    Use EcoPrint to save toner when printing  Use this function for test copies or any other occasion where high quality  print is unnecessary     The procedure for making copies using EcoPrint is explained below   1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears                 Function Menu  paid OK     lo  Paper Selection 1     Collate m   Duplex o     Exit     4 Press the A or V key to select  EcoPrint    5 Press the OK key  EcoPrint appears    EcoPrint  paid OK     On             6 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     7 Press the Start key to start copying        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 8    Copying Functions       Combine Mode    This mode allows you to copy 2 or 4 originals combined onto a single page  2 in 1 mode or 4 in 1 mode  The page  boundary of each original can be indicated        NOTE  Combine mode is available for the copy paper sizes of Folio  A4  B5  Legal  Oficio Il  Letter  Statement and  16K     2 in 1 M
111.  to set the Panel Reset Timer  Set  the amount of time before resetting the message display  on the panel in seconds  You cannot use the numeric  keys to enter this value     8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu     Low Power Timer    You can specify the amount of time to wait before Low Power Mode   Specify a value from 1   240 minutes  1 minute increments   The default setting is 2 minutes   For more information on Low Power Mode  refer to Auto Low Power Mode on page 2 8     Use the procedure below to set the Low Power Mode           1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings  M    01  Language    Default Screen                Sound    Exit    3 Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name  0m password with administrator privileges to log in  and  pas SSE press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            4 The Timer Settings menu appears   Timer Setting     oK    Sleep Timer  PanelReset Timer    Exit                  8 39    Default Setting  System Menu        Unusable Time          Low Power Timer         1   240     si           You can specify the prohibition period to use     Press the
112.  type and  press the OK key     If  NTLM  or  Kerberos  is selected for the server type   enter the host name  up to 64 characters  and domain  name  up to 256 characters  of the authentication server   and press the OK key  If  Ext   is selected for the server  type  enter the host name  up to 64 characters  and port  number of the authentication server  and press the OK  key        NOTE  If the login user name and password are rejected   check the following settings     Network Authentication setting of the machine  User property of the Authentication Server    Date and time setting of the machine and the  Authentication Server    If you cannot login because of the setting of the machine   login with any administrator registered in the local user list  and correct the settings  If the server type is  Kerberos   only  domain names entered in uppercase will be recognized        Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  User Login Set  menu        Management       Login Logout    Once you enable user login administration  a login user name and password entry screen appears each time you use  this machine     Login    Log in using the procedure below     NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters             1 If the screen below appears during the operations   Login User Name     perform the following login operations     Login Password       Login               2 Press the OK key  enter the login user name  and then  pr
113. 0  Confirmation      Confirmation    Register               Exit    2 Press the OK key  Dest  Confirm  appears   Dest  Confirm   pata OK  MMorgan GHt tttttttt I  NOTE  Press the OK key to edit delete the current  destination Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5  for details on entering characters     Exit                  3 Press  Exit   the Right Select key   The basic screen  reappears        7 14    Status   Job Cancel       Registering Destination       1 Inthe Destination menu  press the A or V key to select  Destination   lt 0  Register    Confirmation    Register      Exit            2 Press the OK key  Register appears   Register  Smid OK      01  address Book    Address Entry             To select a destination from the address book  press the  A or V key to select  Address Book  and then press the  OK key  This displays the address book  Select your  desired destination           NOTE  For selecting a destination from the address book   refer to Specifying Destination on page 3 26        To directly enter a destination  press the A or V key to  select  Address Entry  and then press the OK key  This  displays an entry screen  Enter the destination address  directly        3 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  Completed  screen returns to the Destination menu              NOTE  If the address of the selected destination has been    Register   lt 0 changed after you selected the destination from the address  01  Address Book book      is display
114. 0010 DBaaaa    Pause     Menu               4 Press  Pause   the Left Select key   Printing is paused     Pausing  Sma ok   0008 Copy II    0009  amp maury   s data Il  0010 Daaaa II    Resume     Menu               When you press  Resume   the Left Select key  to  resume printing           NOTE  When you press the Back key  a confirmation  Resume paused jobs  screen appears  Press  Yes   the Left Select key  to resume  Are you sure  printing          Yes     No               Canceling of Jobs    For canceling jobs  refer to Canceling Jobs on page 3 29        7 18    Status   Job Cancel       Device Communication    Configure the devices lines installed or connected to this machine or check their status  You can also control devices  depending on their status     Check of Device Status       1 Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  Status  Said OK   appears     Store Job Log    Printer    Pause               2 Press the A or V key to select  Scanner    Printer  or                                FAX    3 Press the OK key  This displays the status of the device  Scanner  LOK selected in step 2  T  Ready   Printer  OK   Processing   FAX  OK   Ready     Log               4 Press the OK key  The screen returns to the Status  menu     The items you can check are described below   Scanner   The information  scanning  pausing  etc   is displayed   Printer   Information  waiting  printing  etc   is displayed    FAX    The information  sending  waiting  etc   is displayed   
115. 100 x 148 mm  1    Oufuku Hagaki  return postcard        Return postcard  148 x 200 mm           Appendix 9          Supported types    Envelopes    Supported paper sizes    ISO B5  Envelope  10  Envelope  9   Envelope  6  Envelope Monarch   Envelope DL  Envelope C5  Hagaki   Oufuku Hagaki  Youkei 4  Youkei 2    Other sizes    Portrait 2 76 to 8 50  or 70 to 216 mm  Landscape 5 83 to 14 02  or 148 to  356 mm    No  of sheets       Transparency  OHP film        Letter  A4             Appendix 10       Basic Paper Specifications    This machine is designed to print on standard copy paper as used in regular     dry   copiers and page printers such as  laser printers  It also supports a variety of other types of paper that conform to the specifications given in this  appendix     Be careful when choosing paper  Paper unsuitable for the machine may cause jams or may be wrinkled     Supported Paper    Use standard copy paper for regular copiers or laser printers  The printing quality will be affected by the quality of  paper  Poor quality paper may result in unsatisfactory output     Basic Paper Specifications    The following table lists the specifications of paper that is supported with this machine  Refer to the subsequent  sections for further details     Criteria Specifications    Weight Cassettes  60 to 120 g m        Multi purpose tray  60 to 220 g m        Thickness 0 086 to 0 110 mm       Dimensional accuracy  0 7 mm       Squareness of corners 90    0 2         Moisture c
116. 105  Adding 8 105  Adding a Group 8 110  Choosing by One Touch Key 3 28  Choosing from the Address Book 3 26  Editing 8 114  One touch Key 8 116  Search 3 26  Sending to Different Types of Destinations   Multi Sending  3 28  Developer unit 1 4  Device 7 19  Checking Status 7 19  Configuring 7 20  DHCP Appendix 22  Document Box 6 1  Document Processor Appendix 21  How to Load Originals 2 55  Loading Originals 2 55  Not Supported Originals 2 55  Supported Originals 2 55  Document processor 1 5  Document processor open close handle 1 6  dpi Appendix 22  Duplex 3 12  8 79  Duplexer front cover 1 4  DVD ROM 2 2    E       EcoPrint Mode Appendix 22  Copy 4 8  Print 8 77  E mail  Send as E mail 3 19  Emulation Appendix 22  Selection 8 74  Energy Star Program xxvi  Enter E mail Subject and Body 5 18  Entry  Body 5 18  File Name 4 16  5 17  Subject 5 18  Error Handling 8 25  Error Messages 10 6  Expansion Memory Appendix 2    F       File  Format 5 10  File Name 4 16  File Separation 5 24  Front cover 1 4  FTP Appendix 23  FTP Encrypted TX 5 23  5 25    G       GPL LGPL  xxiii  Grayscale 5 15  Appendix 23    H       Handholds 1 5  Handholes 1 6       Image Quality  Copy 3 7  Send 5 12  Included Guides 2  Inner tray 1 5  Installation Precautions xv  Interface Block 8 146  IP Address Appendix 23       Index 2    Index       IPP Appendix 23    J    Destinations   3 28    N          Job  Available Status 7 2  Canceling 3 29  7 18  Checking History 7 8  Checking Status 7 2  Pause and Resum
117. 15   B5  gt  gt  A4   90   Folio  gt  gt  A4   86   A4  gt  gt  B5     Asia 70   A4  gt  gt  A5   50   25   Min    Pacific    Other 129   Statement  gt  gt  Letter   78   Legal  gt  gt  Letter      64   Letter  gt  gt  Statement              3 10    Basic Operation       The procedure for using zoom copying is explained below                                               1  Function Menu  bmg OK    Paper Selection DO  Collate O  Duplex o    Exit    2  3  Zoom  Sma OK     o  100   Auto  Standard Zoom  4  Standard Zoom  Kad OK    129  STMT  gt  gt  LTR   03  100   78  LGL  gt  gt  LTR  Zoom Entry  aa OK     25   400       2008  5  6    Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Zoom      Press the OK key  Zoom appears     Press the A or V key to select the desired  magnification     To copy in the same size as the original  select  100     To select automatic zoom  select  Auto      To use fixed magnifications  select  Standard Zoom  and  press the OK key  Standard Zoom appears  Press the A  or V key to select the desired magnification  If you select   Other  and press the OK key  you can select from  additional magnifications     To enter a magnification  select  Zoom Entry  and press  the OK key  Zoom Entry appears  Use the numeric keys  to enter the any magnification     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the basic screen     Press the Start key  Copying begins        Basic Operation       Duplex C
118. 4  e Sending Settings toc  te yes oemert nee eecisc eel 8 86  e Document Box SettingS           2     ccsseeseeeteeeeseeeeeeeeeeeees 8 88  e Printing Reports Sending Notice    n    8 93  e Adjustment Maintenance                  ssssssseseseeeseseeeeeeeeee 8 98  e Editing Destination  Address Book Adding One Touch Keys  8 105  e Restarting the System 20 0    eee eee e eee eee 8 119  e Network SOUP inns lncsitenenncdad nde davinett Raledasmacens 8 120     Network Security ay  cose one cori vere cea c enc peeverevenssevecesersecetete 8 139  e Interface Block Setting                 ccccceseeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeees 8 146  e Security Level  Security Level setting                 0 8 150  e Optional FUNCTIONS   0 0 00    cccceceeseeteeeeeteeeeeeeeeeees 8 150       8 1    Default Setting  System Menu        Common Settings    Common settings include     e How to display the Sys  Menu Count  menu    8 2  e Switching the Language for Display  Language     8 3  e Default Screen    8 5   e Sound    8 6   e Display Bright     8 7   e Original Paper Settings    8 7   e Switching Unit of Measurement    8 24   e Error Handling    8 25   e Date Timer    8 27   e Function Defaults    8 42   e Login Operation    8 66   e RAM Disk Mode    8 67    How to display the Sys  Menu Count  menu    1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter          Login User Name      not logged in  a login screen will appear  Then  enter the          When you are perf
119. 5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  Account  Report  and  then press the OK key     7 Inthe confirmation screen  press  Yes   the Left Select  key   A job accounting report is printed        11 36    Management       Checking the Counter    The number is counted by the following items     You can check the number of pages printed and scanned     Item Description    Printed   By Function   You can check the number of pages copied   Pages faxed   and printed  and the total number of  pages used           By Paper You can check the number of pages printed  Size for each paper size        Scanned Pages You can check the number of pages copied        faxed   and otherwise scanned  and the  total number of pages used          FAX functions available only in FS 3140MFP      System Menu   Counter    oS       Sys  Menu Count    lt                Report  Counter  System    Exit    Counter   gt  oK    ol  Printed Pages    Scanned Pages      Exit            Printed Pages    0m    ol  by Function    by Paper Size               Exit    Printed Pages   lt    amp   Copy  1 4    1234567             1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit  operation panel     2 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Counter   and then press the OK key     3 Press the A or V key to select  Printed Pages  or   Scanned Pages   and then press the OK key     If you select  Printed Pages   select  by Function  or  by  Paper 
120. 7 19       Status   Job Cancel       Checking Job Status    Check the status of jobs being processed or waiting to be printed     Available Status Screens    The processing and waiting statuses of jobs are displayed as a list on the Message Display in four different screens    Print Job  Send Job  Store Job  and Scheduled Job  The following job statuses are available     Screen    Print Job    Job statuses to be displayed    Copy   Printer   FAX reception   Document Box   E mail reception   Job Report  List   Printing data from removable memory       Send Job    FAX transmission    PC  SMB FTP  transmission  E mail   Application   Multiple destination   Sending Job FAX using Delayed  transmission       Store Job    Printer       Scheduled Job       Print Job Status Screen    Status  Sma OK      01I  Print Job Status    Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause                     Print Job Status   0  OOO8 E5ICopy             FAX    1 Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  appears     2 Press the A or V key to select  Print Job Status      3 Press the OK key  Print Job Status appears  Press the A  or V key to check the print queue        7 2    Status   Job Cancel          Press the OK key to check detailed information of the       0009 Detail   0 selected job   Status  1 8  Processing    NOTE  You can also check the job information by pressing   Menu   the Right Select key  and selecting  Detail  in the  menu that appears              Press the  lt  or  gt  key t
121. 80  www kyoceramita com    USA   KYOCERA MITA America  INC     Head office    225 Sand Road  P O  Box 40008  Fairfield  New Jersey 07004 0008  USA  Phone   1 973 808 8444   Fax   1 973 882 6000  www kyoceramita com us    KYOCERA CORPORATION    JAPAN   KYOCERA CORPORATION   Corporate Headquarters    6 Takeda Tobadono cho  Fushimi ku  Kyoto 612 8501  Japan   Phone   81 75 604 3500   Fax   81 75 604 3501  www kyocera co jp    KYOCERA    KSOCERA    First Edition 2011 05  2MFKMENOO0O    
122. A OLET  ALTTINA L LUOKAN 3B LASERSATEILYLLE    ALA KATSO S  TEESEEN     BS BARBARA  AFRT RS ARR   MERER     Ti  EESEL  FMT Re ARS   PAEERIE RR   AH   CLASS 3B nae Ase AQ lols   COERCED ZS eee ET   LEERRID  MNIWECIEEU        The label shown below is attached on the right side of the machine     CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT    KLASSE 1 LASER PRODUKT       Legal Restriction on Copying Scanning       It may be prohibited to copy scan copyrighted material without permission of the copyright owner     e Copying Scanning the following items is prohibited and may be penalized by low   It may not be limited to these items  Do not knowingly copy scan the items that are not to be copied scanned     Paper money  Bank note  Securities  Stamp  Passport  Certificate    e Local laws and regulations may prohibit or restrict copying scanning of other items not mentioned above        XX    Legal and Safety Information    Please read this information before using your machine  This chapter provides information on the  following topics     e Legal  Information         2 c 400 ce ene elie xxii  e Regarding Trade Names                 c  ecsseese ssseeesceeteeeteees xxii  e Energy Saving Control Function    xxvi  e Automatic 2 Sided Copy Function    xxvi    Paper Recycling  seisis me pretenie xxvi  e Energy Star  ENERGY STAR    Program    xxvi  e About this Operation Guide                         esseeeeeeeeeeees xxvii  e Conventions in This Guide                eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeetteees xxviii       Xxi 
123. A confirmation screen appears     7 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   Drum refresh is  executed        8 104    Default Setting  System Menu        Editing Destination  Address Book Adding One Touch Keys     Save frequently used destinations to Address Book or One touch keys  The saved destinations can be changed  The  destinations are available for Send as E mail  Send to Folder  and Fax Transmission        NOTE  COMMAND CENTER can be used to efficiently save and edit multiple destinations        Adding an Individual Destination    A maximum of 100 individual addresses can be registered  Each address can include the information such as  destination name  E mail address  FTP server folder path  computer folder path  and FAX No         NOTE     e lf user login administration is enabled  you can only edit destinations in the Address Book by logging in with  administrator privileges     e Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters           Use the procedure below to register a new individual contact   A 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to Gq  Sys  Menu Count       select  Edit Destination    FAX    Document Box     i  Edit Destination      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Edit Destination menu appears   Edit Destination         01  Addressbook    Print List                  Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Address Book    4 Press the OK key  The Address Book list screen  Addressbook   lt    appears        S
124. AutoPaperSelect        Auto   Priority          Select Key Set              page 8 42      page 8 43       Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide       page 8 44      page 8 45     page 8 46     page 8 47     page 8 48     page 8 49     page 8 50     page 8 51     page 8 52     page 8 53      page 8 54     page 8 55     page 8 56     page 8 57     page 8 58     page 8 60     page 8 61     page 8 62       page 8 63     page 8 64       page 8 66     page 8 67     page 8 68     page 8 69     page 8 70     page 8 71     page 8 72       xiii             System Menu   Counter key   Continued from  previous page     Printer    Emulation Set        EcoPrint       Override A4 LTR       Duplex       Copies       Orientation       FormFeed TimeOut       LF Action       CR Action       Paper Feed Mode       Send    Select Key Set        Document Box    Sub Address Box       Job Box       Polling Box       Select Key Set                 Edit Address Book  Destination   Print  List  Adjust Maint  Copy Denst  Adj        Send Box Density       Correct  Bk Line          Service Service Status  Setting       Network Status       New Developer       Auto DrumRefresh       Drum Refresh       FAX Country Code       FAX Call Set        Remote Diag Set           Remote Diag  ID                page 8 74     page 8 77     page 8 78     page 8 79     page 8 80     page 8 81     page 8 82     page 8 82     page 8 83     page 8 84     page 8 86       Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide       page 8 88       Re
125. B V     EUROPEAN HEADQUARTERS  Bloemlaan 4   2132 NP Hoofddorp   The Netherlands   Phone   31 20 654 0000   Fax   31 20 653 1256  www kyoceramita europe com    KYOCERA MITA Europe B V    Amsterdam  NL   Zweigniederlassung Z  rich  Hohlstrasse 614   CH 8048 Z  rich   Phone   41 1 908 49 49  Fax   41 1908 49 50  www kyoceramita ch    KYOCERA MITA SALES COMPANIES  IN EMEA    KYOCERA MITA INTERNATIONAL SALES   Europe  Middle East  amp  North Africa   Bloemlaan 4   2132 NP Hoofddorp   The Netherlands   Phone   31 20 654 0000   Fax   31 20 653 1256  www kyoceramita europe com    AUSTRIA   KYOCERA MITA AUSTRIA GmbH  Eduard Kittenberger Gasse 95  A 1230 Wien   Phone   43 1 86 3380   Fax   43 1 86 338 400  www kyoceramita at    BELGIUM   S A  KYOCERA MITA Belgium N V   Sint Martinusweg 199 201  BE 1930 Zaventem   Phone   32 2 720 9270   Fax   32 2 720 8748  www kyoceramita be    DENMARK   KYOCERA MITA Denmark A S  Ejby Industrivej 60   DK 2600 Glostrup   Phone   45 70 22 3880  Fax   45 45 76 3850  www kyoceramita dk    FINLAND   KYOCERA MITA Finland OY  Kirvesmiehenkatu 4  Fl 00880 Helsinki   Phone   358 9 4780 5200  Fax   358 9 4780 5390  www kyoceramita fi    FRANCE   KYOCERA MITA France S A    Espace Technologique de St Aubin  Route de l Orme   FR 91195 Gif sur Yvette CEDEX  Phone   33 1 6985 2600   Fax   33 16985 3409  www kyoceramita fr    GERMANY   KYOCERA MITA Deutschland GmbH  Otto Hahn Str  12   D 40670 Meerbusch   Germany  Phone   49 2159 918 O   Fax   49 2159 918 100  www k
126. Copying begins        3 15    Basic Operation       Printing   Printing from Applications    Follow the steps below to print documents from applications        NOTE  To print the document from applications  install the printer driver on your computer from the supplied DVD     ROM  Product Library                                                                                                                          Layout   Imaging   Publishing   Advanced            Media type   l Unspecified             Source  Destination            Auto source selection  Printer default       Orientation  Duplex      Portrait an E Print on both sides     Landscape m Flip on long edge  El Rotated Flip on short edge    Quality     mmn  _JEcoPrint                Print a    Printer  nome    a   a      a  Type     lt  a  Where  Print to file    Comment     Manual duplex  I  Page range Copies J  P    All Number of copies  fil       Current page Selection  i     Pages  Hl 7  F  Collate i  I  Enter page numbers and or page ranges l  iP  separated by commas  For example  1 3 5 12  i  ii  Print what   Document  z  Zoom li  Pages per sheet   I  Print  All pages in range EPEE n 1page z  f Scale to paper size  No Scaling Zi     me  ce             Create a document using an application     Click File and select Print in the application  The Print  dialog box appears     Click the W button next to the Name field and select this  machine from the list     Enter the desired print quantity in the Number of 
127. Count    gt    select  Report      Counter  System    Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Report menu appears   Report   lt  u    Admin Rpt Set   Result Rpt Set     Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Report Print         4 Press the OK key  The Report Print menu appears   Report Print   gt  m    Status Page  Font List    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Menu Map    Status  Page  or  Font List         8 94    Default Setting  System Menu              Print   Are you sure      Status Page         Yes     No         6 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears     The screen shown is the one when Status Page is  selected     7 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The selected report is  output  Accepted  is displayed and the screen returns to  the Report Print menu        NOTE  When acceptance of jobs is prohibited  Print  storing functions are restricted now  is displayed and the    output is canceled        Service Status Page    More detailed information is available than on the Status Page  Service personnel usually print the service status    pages for maintenance purpose     Network Status Page    Check the information including network interface firmware version  network address and protocol        MFP    Firmware Version          Sys  Menu Count       Document Box   4  Edit Destination      Exit               Adjust Maint     O  Send Box Density  Correct  Bk Line     Exit            Network Status Page       Use the procedure be
128. DuplexPaperError    PaperMismatchErr    Error Handling       Exit                  PaperMismatchErr  0m  Ignore  0 Display Error          11    12    Press the OK key  DuplexPaperError appears     Press the A or V key to select the method to handle if  duplex is disabled     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Error Handling menu     Press the A or V key to select  PagerMismatchErr      Press the OK key  PagerMismatchErr appears     Press the A or V key to select the method to handle  paper mismatch     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Error Handling menu        8 26    Default Setting  System Menu        Date Timer  Date Timer settings include        Date Time    8 27   e Date Format    8 29      Time Zone    8 30      Summer Time    8 31   e Auto Error Clear    8 32  e Auto Sleep    8 34   e Auto Panel Reset    8 37  e Low Power Timer    8 39  e Unusable Time    8 40       NOTE  If user login administration is enabled  you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator  privileges        Date Time GE  Set the date and time for the location where you use the machine  If you perform Send as E mail  the date and time  set here will be displayed on the header        CAUTION  Be sure to set Time Zone before the Date Time setup     Use the procedure below to set the date and time        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings    
129. E mail reception   Job Report   List   Printing data from removable  memory       Send Job FAX   PC  SMB FTP   E mail   Application  Multiple destination       Store Job    Printer          Scheduled Job FAX       Displaying Print Job Log       1 Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  Status  pata OK appears     01I  Print Job Status    Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause               2 Press the A or V key to select  Print Job Log         3 Press the OK key  Print Job Log appears  Press the A    Print Job Log  pai OK  or V key to check the print log   0006  amp lmaury   s da  A  0007 tom s da  OK       0008  amp susan   s da  OK    Detail                  7 8    Status   Job Cancel       Ajob result icon is displayed on the extreme right of each  job     OK   Job completed normally  A   Job error         Job aborted       NOTE  For details of other items  refer to Print Job Status  Screen on page 7 2           Press the OK key or  Detail   the Right Select key  to    0006 Detail  aed OK   check the detailed information of the selected print log   Result  1 9  Error Press the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the display to other    information items  The items displayed are as follows     Result  Accepted Time   End Time   Job Name   Job Type   User Name   Page and Copy    number of pages and copies to be printed    Original Page  number of pages of the original    Sender Info   destination information     00100             When complete job name not displayed in
130. Err  Clear appears   Auto Err  Clear   gt       lo O  L  On             7 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu     e Error Clear Timer    If you select  On  for Auto Error Clear  set the amount of time to wait before automatically clearing errors  Options are  between 5 and 495 seconds  every five seconds   The default setting is 30 seconds     If you set 0 as the time  errors are not displayed        NOTE  If you select  Off  for Auto Error Clear  the time display does not appear        Use the procedure below to set the automatic error clear delay        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings         Default Screen  Sound    Exit               3 Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key        8 33    Default Setting  System Menu        Auto Sleep          Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login               Timer Setting    O  Sleep Timer  PanelReset Timer     Exit                  Err  Clear Timer         5   495   P30    lt             A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The Timer Settings menu appears     Pre
131. F Comp   Set the default value for compression method for TIFF images handled by this machine     Use the procedure below to set the default value for color TIFF compression method        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i    01  Language  Default Screen  Sound            Exit         3 Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         8 64    Default Setting  System Menu              Function Default  0m  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution     Exit                  Detail Setting   lt  lt    4 in 1 Layout  Border Line     Exit                  Color TIFF Comp   i    O TIFF V6  TTN2          4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Detail Setting      6 Press the OK key  The Detail Setting menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Color TIFF Comp       8 Press the OK key  Color TIFF Comp  appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  TIFF V6  or  TTN2      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Detail Setting menu        8 65    Default Setting  System Menu        Login Operation    Specify the character entry method in the login screen that appears when user management is enabled     Item Description    Use Numeric Key    Use the numeric keys to select and enter
132. Gateway is displayed and cannot be  changed     When setting an Default Gateway  set the DHCP Setting   page 8 126  to Off        29 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu        8 125    Default Setting  System Menu        DHCP Settings    Select whether or not to use the DHCP server  The default setting is On     Use the procedure below to specify the DHCP setting        Sys  Menu Count    lt     Report  Counter      Exit            Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login               System     oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit                  Network Setting  0m  NetWare  AppleTalk     Exit                  TCP IP Settings  i  IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting     Exit            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      2 The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP Settings      6 Press the OK key  The TCP IP Settings menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP         8 126    Default Setting  System Menu              8 Press the OK key  TCP IP appears   TCP IP  Said OK      off  2J  On          9 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  
133. IMPORTANT  When pulling the cassette out of the printer   ensure it is supported and does not fall out        Standard paper sizes are marked on the inside of the  cassette                                                                                                                                                                                                                       LTR  LGL                               2 Turn the paper size dial so that the size of the paper you  are going to use appears in the paper size window        NOTE  When the paper size dial is set to OTHER the paper  size must be set into the printer on the operation panel   Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media on page 2 49              2 42    Preparation before Use       3 Pull the release lever on the left side guide and slide to  the desired paper size                 4 Ifyou are going to set paper that is longer than A4  pull  out the extension cassettes pushing the lock lever one  by one and adjust them to the desired paper size                                                                                                                                         5 Pull the release lever and slide the paper length guide to  the desired paper size     When using non standard size paper  move the paper  width guide and paper length guide all the way out  insert  the paper  then adjust the paper width guides and paper  length guide to the size of the paper  Adjust them so that  they are in l
134. JPEG  if  Black and White  is selected for the color mode        Use the procedure below to select the file format for transmission   1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid OK      ol  Color Selection UO  Original Size O  Original Image O                  Exit    4 Press the A or V key to select  File Format    Press the OK key  File Format appears   File Format  paid OK    TIFF  XPS      Detail               6 Press the A or V key to select the file format from  PDF     TIFF    XPS  or  JPEG      If Full Color or Grayscale has been selected for the color  mode for scanning  press  Detail   the Right Select key   and select the image quality     7 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending        5 10    Sending Functions       8 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu              5 11    Sending Functions       Original Image  Select image quality suitable to the type of original     The table below shows the quality options     Item Detail    Text Photo    Text and photos together        Photo    For photos taken with a camera        Text    Only text  no photos        For OCR            For documents to be read by OCR         This function is only available for black and white mode     Use the procedure below to select t
135. K key  Orig  Binding appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  HA Left Right  or    Ee Top      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Detail Setting menu     Select the default value for the binding edge of the finished copies when  1 sided gt  gt 2 sided  or  2 sided gt  gt 2 sided  is  selected for Duplex  Items available for the default value are as follows     ee eee       Ha Left Right Left right binding       He Top Top binding    Use the procedure below to select the default value for the binding edge of the finished copies        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account      Exit               Common Settings     gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         8 62    Default Setting  System Menu        Image Quality          Function Default   gt m  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution     Exit                  Detail Setting   lt  lt    4 in 1 Layout  Border Line     Exit                  Finish   Binding  0m   01 gt  li Left Right  Hi Top          4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Detail Setting      6 Press the OK key  The Detail Setting menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Finish Binding      8 Press the OK key  Finish Binding appears     9 Press the A 
136. Name Entry  e JobFinish Notice  e Density   e Duplex       8 90    Default Setting  System Menu        Use the procedure below to set Select Key Set        R 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  Document Box      Send  FAX  Document Box      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Document Box menu appears   Document Box   lt  m    0  Sub Address Box 3 Press the A or V key to select  Select Key Set     Select Key Set   Polling Box     Exit                  4 Press the OK key  Select Key Set  appears        Select Key Set    gt  0m    Store Gq                              Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Print  or  Store      6 Press the OK key  This displays the flexible key selection  Print   lt V 0 screen for the function selected in step 5  The screen  shown is the one when  Print  is selected   Right    Exit    7 Press the A or V key to select  Left  or  Right    A 8 Press the OK key  This displays the function selection  Left  pai OK   screen for the flexible key selected in step 7  The screen  Paper Selection shown is the one when  Left  is selected   04   Duplex    File Name Entry             9 Press the A or V key to select the function you want to  register to the flexible key     10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Document Box menu        8 91    Default Setting  System Menu                 IMPORTANT  If you try to set the function that is registered  This functi
137. Network Setting menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP Settings      Press the OK key  The TCP IP Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP         8 128    Default Setting  System Menu              TCP IP  bmg OK       ol  Off  02  Oon             TCP IP Settings   lt i  TCP IP  IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting    Exit               IPv4 Setting  bmg OK    DHCP    Bonjour  IP Address                  Exit    Bonjour  Sma OK    lo Oft          8 Press the OK key  TCP IP appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  TCP IP Settings menu     10 Press the A or V key to select  IPv4 Setting      11 Press the OK key  The IPv4 Setting menu appears     12 Press the A or V key to select  Bonjour      13 Press the OK key  Bonjour appears     14 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off  and then  press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  IPv4 Setting menu        8 129       Default Setting  System Menu        TCP IP  IPv6  Setup  Set up TCP IP  IPv6  to connect to the network  The default setting is Off     Use the procedure below to setup the TCP IP  IPv6  setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit              A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name     password with a
138. OK button   Share Permissions  Group or user names  In Windows XP  go to step 8     88  Everyone       3 PC4050  PC4050 james smith                         Add      Remove    Pemissions for james smith Allow Deny  Full Control    Change 7    Read 7 o                   Leam about access control and permissions                                           NOTE   Everyone  gives sharing permission to everyone on the network  To strengthen security  it is recommended  that you select Everyone and remove the Read permission checkmark        7 Click the OK button in the Advanced Sharing screen to  close the screen        2 34    Preparation before Use          G     scannerdata Properties               General   Sharing  Securty   Previous Versions   Customize          Object name  C  scannerdata    Group or user names        S amp  SYSTEM     PC0391  PC4050 james smith    amp   Administrators  PC4050 Administrators        To change permissions  click Edit     Pemnissions for SYSTEM Allow Deny       Full control   Modify   Read  amp  execute  List folder contents  Read   Write                click Advanced     Leam about access control and permissions       For special permissions or advanced settings           Slee       Apply                r  J   Permissions for scannerdata                Security          Object name  C  scannerdata    Group or user names          82  SYSTEM    jamessmith  PC4050 james smith    amp 2  Administrators  PC4050 Administrators                          
139. OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  TCP IP Settings menu        10 Press the A or V key to select  IPv4 Setting                           TCP IP Settings  i  TCP IP  IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting    Exit    11 Press the OK key  The IPv4 Setting menu appears  Gi  IPv4 Setting  bmg OK    Bonjour  IP Address    Exit    12 Press the A or V key to select  DHCP    13 Press the OK key  DHCP appears   DHCP  Said OK  Off  0 On          14 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off  and then  press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  IPv4 Setting menu        8 127    Default Setting  System Menu        Bonjour Settings    Select whether or not to use Bonjour  The default setting is Off     Use the procedure below to specify the Bonjour setting        Sys  Menu Count        Report  Counter      Exit            Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login            System     oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit                  Network Setting  0m  NetWare  AppleTalk     Exit                  TCP IP Settings  i  IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting     Exit               1    In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      Press the OK key  The 
140. OPERATION GUIDE              ry KYOCERA    Ec  sys    Introduction  Thank you for your purchase of FS 3040MFP  FS 3140MFP      This Operation Guide is intended to help you operate the machine correctly  perform routine maintenance and take  a simple troubleshooting action as necessary  so that you can always use the machine in good condition     Please read this Operation Guide before you start using the machine  and keep it close to the machine for easy  reference     We recommend the use of our own brand supplies  We will not be liable for any damage caused by the use of third  party supplies in this machine     A label shown in the illustration assures that the supplies are our own brand        Bi KSULCNG  o g KuaceRal  R QKYOCE    Included Guides    The following guides are supplied with the machine  Refer to them as necessary     Quick Installation Guide    Describes frequently used operations  convenient operations  routine maintenance  and troubleshooting action     Safety Guide    Provides safety and cautionary information for the installation and use of the machine  Be sure to read this guide  before using the machine     Safety Guide  FS 3040MFP  FS 3140MFP      Describes the machine installation space  cautionary labels  and other information  Be sure to read this guide before  using the machine     DVD ROM  Product Library   Operation Guide  This Guide     Describes how to load paper  basic copy  print and scan operations  and troubleshooting     FAX Operation Gui
141. OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit   http     www openssl org         4 The names    OpenSSL Toolkit    and    OpenSSL Project    must not be used to endorse or promote products  derived from this software without prior written permission   For written permission  please contact openssl core openssl org     5 Products derived from this software may not be called    OpenSSL    nor may    OpenSSL    appear in their names  without prior written permission of the OpenSSL Project     6 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment     This product includes  software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit  http  Awww openssl org         THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT    AS IS    AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED  WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO  THE    IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  DISCLAIMED  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY  DIRECT  INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE  DATA  OR  PROFITS  OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY   WHETHER IN CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT  INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF  SUCH DAMAGE        xxiii       Original SSLeay
142. Scanning WIA  Scanning       USB interface       USB2 0 compatible cable   Hi Speed USB compliant   Max  5 0 m  Shielded        i Network FAX and FAX functions available only in FS 3140MFP   For  details on Network FAX  refer to the FAX Operation Guide        Preparation before Use       Connecting Cables    Follow the steps below to connect cables to the machine     1 Turn the main power switch off  O                        2 Connect the machine to the PC or your network device   When using the network interface  remove the cap     When connecting the network cable  configure the  network  For details  refer to Network Setup  LAN Cable  Connection  on page 2 14                                               3 Connect one end of the supplied power cable to the  machine and the other end to a power outlet              IMPORTANT  Only use the power cable that comes with the machine           2 5    Preparation before Use       Power On Off    Power On    When the main power indicator is lit     Press the Power key     Power            When the main power indicator is off     Turn the main power switch on                    IMPORTANT  When turning off the main power switch  do not turn on the main power switch again immediately  Wait  more than 5 seconds  and then turn on the main power switch           2 6    Preparation before Use       Power Off    Before turning off the main power switch  press the Power key on the operation panel to off  Make sure that the  memory indicator 
143. Security Level    Exit               3 Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting         8 140    Default Setting  System Menu           4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears   Network Setting   gt       Host Name  LAN Interface    Exit               oi    Press the A or V key to select  Secure Protocol         6 Press the OK key  Secure Protocol appears   Secure Protocol   lt    m    01  SSL  IPP Security  HTTP Security                  Exit    7 Press the A or V key to select  SSL    8 Press the OK key  SSL appears   SSL    0m  Gi    02  on             9 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu     IPP Security  Specify the protocol to be used for IPP  The default setting is  PP IPP over SSL     Use the procedure below to make the setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    M select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit              A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and    TE press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login                  8 141    Default Setting  System Menu        HTTP Security          System     oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit                  Network Setting   gt     Host Name  LAN Interface     Exit                  Secure
144. Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Unusable Time      Press the OK key  Unusable Time appears     Press the A or V key to select  On      Press the OK key  Start Time appears     Press the A or V key to set the Start Time     Press the OK key  End Time appears     Press the A or V key to set the End Time     Press the OK key  Unlock Code appears     Press the A or V key or numeric keys to set the unlock    code     14    Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu        8 41    Default Setting  System Menu        Function Defaults  Defaults are the values automatically set after the warm up is completed or the Reset key is pressed     Set the defaults for available settings such as copying and sending  Setting the frequently used values as defaults  makes subsequent jobs easier     Color Selection    Select the default color mode setting  The available default settings are shown below     Color mode Description       Full Color Scan document in full color        Grayscale Scan document in grayscale for smoother  and finer finish        Black  amp  White Scan document in black and white        Use the procedure below to select the default color mode setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   S0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings
145. Size  in the next screen  and then press the OK  key     4 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to check the count        11 37    Management       5 After completing checking the count  press the OK key   The screen returns to the menu for the account        11 38    Appendix    e Optional Equipment                  cc ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees Appendix 2  e Character Entry Method                   c     esseeeees Appendix 5  s Papere er canines aa Appendix 9     Specifications eie ierann ieiunii eerie Appendix 18      NGIOSSALY ver a a a a eaaa Appendix 22       Appendix 1       Optional Equipment    Overview of Optional Equipment    The following optional equipment is available for the machine     Expansion Memory       Paper Feeder     gt     Paper Feeder    The paper feeder allows you to add three more paper  cassettes to the bottom of the machine for continuous  feeding of a large volume of paper  Paper capacity and  loading method are the same as Cassettes 1     Expansion Memory    To expand the printer memory for more complex print jobs  and faster print speed  you can plug in optional memory  module  dual in line memory module  in the memory slot  provided on the main controller board  You can select  additional memory module from 128  256 or 512 MB  The  maximum memory size is 768 MB        NOTE  The expansion memory should only be installed by  your service technician  We shall not be liable for any damages  caused by improper installation of expansion memory           Appendix 2 
146. Source          SpcialPaper Act        Preset Limit       Measurement       Error Handling       Date Setting          Timer Setting       Err  Clear Timer       Sleep Timer       PanelReset Timer       Low Power Timer          Auto Err  Clear       Auto Sleep       Auto Panel Reset          Unusable Time             page 8 3      page 8 5      page 8 6      page 8 6      page 8 6      page 8 7      page 8 7      page 8 9      page 8 10     page 8 12     page 8 12     page 8 12     page 8 12     page 8 14     page 8 16     page 8 19     page 8 20     page 8 21      page 8 23     page 8 24     page 8 25     page 8 27      page 8 32      page 8 34      page 8 37     page 8 39      page 8 32     page 8 34     page 8 37     page 8 40       xii             System Menu   Counter key   Continued from  previous page      Continued on  next page     Common  Settings     Continued from  previous page     Function Color Selection  Default       Scan Resolution       FAX Resolution       Original Image       Density       Zoom       Collate       Orig Orientation       EcoPrint          File Name Entry       Subject Body       Continuous Scan       File Format       File Separation       TIFF Print       XPS FitTo Page       Detail Setting  2 in 1 Layout       4 in 1 Layout       Border Line       Orig  Binding       Finish   Binding       Image Quality       Coloma iE hy  Comp              Login Operation       RAM Disk Mode          Copy    Photo Processing       Paper Selection       
147. Start key to start copying        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 16    Copying Functions       Print Override    This function allows you to suspend the current print job when you need to make copies immediately  When the  interrupt copy job is completed  the machine resumes the suspended print job        1 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid OK      Collate O  Duplex O    Exit      2 Press the A or V key to select  Print Override                  3 Press the OK key  Print Override appears     Print Override  bmg OK    lo OfE  On             4 Press the A or V key to select  On      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed  the machine  is put into the interruption copy mode  and the basic  screen appears     6 Perform the interrupt copy job in the same fashion as a  normal copy job  When the interrupt copy job is  completed  the machine resumes the suspended print  job        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           Copying Functions          4 18    5 Sending Functions    This chapter explains the functions available for sending originals     e Original SIZ Goiyietired sie Sager eee lca ok os ee a 5 2     Sending SIZE sjnnens Mets eRe 5 3  Win ZOOM e ane a lane aia wean Pi a a ed Santee ees 5 5    Duplex Sending x 5  25 ecaeeerecaccets bi eeideo eds Scecencee lence 5 7  e Original Orientation    2           ccececceecceeeeeeedeeeseeeseece
148. The format of an IP address is four sets of numbers separated by dots  e g  192 168 110 171  Each number should  be between 0 and 255     IPP    IPP  Internet Printing Protocol  is a standard that uses TCP IP networks such as the Internet to enable print jobs to  be sent between remote computers and printers IPP is an extension of the HTTP protocol used to view websites and  enables printing to be carried out via routers on printers in remote locations  It also supports the HTTP authentication  mechanisms along with SSL server and client authentication as well as encryption     KPDL  Kyocera Page Description Language   Kyocera s PostScript page description language compatible with Adobe PostScript Level 3   Multi Purpose  MP  Tray    Use this tray instead of the cassettes when printing onto envelopes  Hagaki  transparencies  or labels     NetBEUI  NetBIOS Extended User Interface     An interface  developed by IBM in 1985  as an update from NetBIOS  It enables more advanced functions on smaller  lt   networks than other protocols such as TCP IP  etc  It is not suitable for larger networks due to lack of routing   capabilities to choose the most appropriate routes  NetBEUI has been adopted by IBM for its OS 2 and Microsoft for   its Windows as a standard protocol for file sharing and printing services     NetWare   Novell s network management software that is able to run on a variety of operating systems    POP3  Post Office Protocol 3    A standard protocol to receive E mail f
149. The options are between 5 and 495 seconds     Use the procedure below to set the form feed timeout        _ 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    lt    select  Printer      Common Settings  Copy  Printer      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears   Printer   lt  gt  m    EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  FormFeed Timeout         4 Press the OK key  FormFeed Timeout appears   FormFeed TimeOut         5   495   MRS  lt  lt               5 Press the A or V key to set the Form Feed Timeout  You  can set the timeout delay in seconds  You cannot use the  numeric keys to enter this value     6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu     LF Action    Set the line feed action when the machine receives the line feed code  character code OAH   The table below shows  the available settings  The default setting is LF Only     Item Description    LF Only Only line feed performed        LF and CR Line feed and character return performed           Ignore LF No line feed performed        Use the procedure below to specify a LF action        8 82    Default Setting  System Menu              Sys  Menu Count        Common Settings             Copy  Printer     Exit    Printer    O    01  Emulation Set     EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR    Exit               LF Action    O  LF and CR  Ignore LF    In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  
150. Tray  return it to its original package and reseal it     If using the FS 3140MFP  the main power switch is off  transmitting receiving Fax is disabled  Do not turn off the main  power switch  but press the Power key on the operation panel to enter Sleep mode        Xvi       SAFETY OF LASER BEAM  USA     1  Safety of laser beam    This machine has been certified by the manufacturer to Class 1 level under the radiation performance  standards established by the U S DHHS  Department of Health and Human Services  in 1968  This indicates  that the product is safe to use during normal operation and maintenance  The laser optical system  enclosed  in a protective housing and sealed within the external covers  never permits the laser beam to escape     2  The CDRH Act    A laser product related act was implemented on Aug  2  1976  by the Center for Devices and Radiological Health   CDRH  of the U S  Food and Drug Administration  FDA   This act prohibits the sale of laser products in the U S   without certification  and applies to laser products manufactured after Aug  1  1976  The label shown below indicates  compliance with the CDRH regulations and must be attached to laser products marketed in the United States  On this  machine  the label is on the rear           FS 3040MFP   Mr       FS 3140MFP                                      3  Optical unit    When checking the optical unit  avoid direct exposure to the laser beam  which is invisible  Shown at below is the label  located o
151. V key to    select  Copy      2 Press the OK key  The Copy menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Photo Processing      4 Press the OK key  Photo Processing appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Dithering Normal   or     Dithering Rough          8 68    Default Setting  System Menu        Paper Selection    6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Copy menu     Set the default paper selection  The table below shows the available settings     Item Description    Automatically select the cassette    containing paper in the same size as    originals        Def  PaperSource          Sys  Menu Count        User Job Account  Common Settings      Exit               Copy    O  Paper Selection  AutoPaperSelect      Exit                  Paper Selection   lt       Def  PaperSource          Use the procedure below to set the default paper selection     1    Select paper source set by Default Paper  Source  refer to page 8 20         In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Copy      Press the OK key  The Copy menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Paper Selection      Press the OK key  Paper Selection appears     Press the A or V key to select  Auto  or  Def  Paper    Source      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Copy menu        8 69    Default Setting  System Menu        Auto Paper Selection    If  Auto  is selected for Paper Selection  set the paper size sele
152. Vista x64  Edition  Windows Server 2008  Windows Server 2008 x64 Edition  Windows  7  Apple Macintosh OS 10 x                Interface Standard USB Interface Connector  1  USB Hi Speed   USB Host  1  Network interface  1  10 BASE T 100 BASE TX   Page Description Language PRESCRIBE  Scanner    Item Description    Operating System Windows XP  Windows Vista  Windows Server 2003  Windows Server 2008   Windows 7       System requirements IBM PC AT compatible   CPU  Celeron 600Mhz or higher  RAM  128MB or more   HDD free space  20MB or more  Interface  Ethernet    Resolution 600 dpi  400 dpi  300 dpi  200 dpi  File Format JPEG  TIFF PDF  XPS             Scanning Speed 4 1 sided  B W 35 Images min  Color 13 Images min   A4 landscape  600 dpi  Image quality  Text Photo original        Interface Ethernet  10 BASE T 100 BASE TX   USB2 0  Hi Speed USB     Network Protocol TCP IP          Transmission PC transmission SMB Scan to SMB   System FTP Scan to FTP  FTP over SSL  E mail transmission SNMP Scan to E mail   TWAIN scan     WIA scan 2           1 Available Operating System   Windows XP  Windows Server 2003  Windows Vista  Windows 7  Windows Server  2008   2 Available Operating System   Windows Vista  Windows 7  Windows Server 2008       Appendix 20       Document Processor    Item Description    Original Feed Automatic feed  Method       Supported Original   Sheet originals  Types       Paper Size Maximum  Legal A4  Minimum  Statement A5       Paper Weight Simplex  50 to 120 g m   Du
153. a document is printed  with Proof and hold selected in the printer driver  the document will be simultaneously stored on the RAM disk  The  required number of copies can be printed whenever needed from the operation panel  If more documents than the       6 10    Document Box       set maximum are stored  the oldest job will be overwritten each time a new job is stored  When the machine power  is turned off  jobs stored in this mode are erased  For the number of documents that can be stored in Quick Copy  mode  see Quick Copy Jobs on page 8 88        1 Press the Document Box key  The Document Box menu  Document Box   lt 0 appears     Sub Address Box  Polling Box    Job Box             2 Press the A or V key to select  Job Box         3 Press the OK key  The Job Box menu appears   Job Box  o gt     Quick Copy             4 Press the A or V key to select  Quick Copy                     Press the OK key  The user selection menu appears    Quick Copy   gt  0   amp  Maury   6 Press the A or V key to select the user    7 Press the OK key  The print file selection menu appears    amp  Fiala  paid OK   f AData02 Oo  fAData0d3 o    Menu     Select               8 Press the A or V key to select the file to be printed  and  then press  Select   the Right Select key   The selected  file will be marked     If you need to add another file  repeat this procedure to  select the file           NOTE  To select all files  press Menu  the Left Select key        Menu   lt 0 and select  Select All
154. achina cis cents eSEE aun KEIEN EEE EEGA aed a Re Beg platy Boba  Sas ya OER ak 1 4  2 Preparation before Use  Check bundled Kems crisa cirri i etai er d a e o eee ee 2 2  Determining the Connection Method and Preparing Cables       n a saasaa aaaeeeaa 2 3  Connecting Cables eat eo Et a e dd a A a Sa eee eden ce el 2 5  Power On Offec sci eae Be ota Ay a ie a bd dda e A N 7  2 6  Auto Low Power Mode            00  e eee eens 2 8  sleep and Auto Sleep nt  feat iaaa ori a aa O a ae alee GO dele deena ta aad 2 8  Switching the Language for Display  Language               00 0 eee eee 2 9  Setting Date and Time         2 2    eee ee 2 11  Network Setup  LAN Cable Connection              0 00000 ee eee 2 14  Installing SOMWANC esi  tetes gare a a RS ee td FP anda Renae gah EAE Reta ahh Boe EEA 2 16  COMMAND CENTER  Settings for E mail     0       0 000 eee 2 28  sending  Emal 2  aaa a ee ea a a ceed ca hh eed id a Ta es 2 29  Preparation for sending a document toa PC           0 0    cc eee 2 31  Loading  PAPER ccs hai EEA OG  ant aeata aia baa aah tee oh alls ones 2 41  Loading Originals  verie p44 cert ne paid Pee oo ee ode ee eee oe ee 2 54  3 Basic Operation  LOGIN LOG OU s s a sta wean Ee e tor gale Bead OES A A alla ean eee Bae aye erage 3 2  One Touch Keys and Program KeyS           000 cette tee eee 3 3  Message  Display  2    i sous Haha ghee S ae eg aed alo Sig Ra eal ey Salat 3 6  COPYING cate atk heath tee aerate DEI cet ioe teen lrh OS GRE Aral I E ES en 3 7  Printing
155. ada   703 5 W  European countries        Power FS 3040MFP     Consump     Standard  94 5 W U S A  Canada   95 8 W  European countries   With options  101 6 W U S A  Canada   103 7 W  European countries        tion  During    Standard  104 6 W U S A  Canada   97 9 W  European countries   With options  113 0 W U S A  Canada   102 1 W  European countries        Power FS 3040MFP     Consump     Standard  34 0 W U S A  Canada   72 7 W  European countries   With options  37 0 W U S A  Canada   73 1 W  European countries        tion  Low    power mode  FS 3140MFP     Standard  42 8 W U S A  Canada   74 8 W  European countries   With options  43 3 W U S A  Canada   75 6 W  European countries        Power FS 3040MFP     Consump     Standard  6 8 W  U S A  Canada   6 9 W  European countries   With options  8 8 W  U S A  Canada   9 1 W  European countries        tion  Sleep    mode  FS 3140MFP        Standard  10 4 W  U S A  Canada   10 6 W  European countries   With options  12 5 W  U S A  Canada   12 6 W  European countries        Power Consumption   Power off     0 1W       Options       Paper feeder  up to 3 units           Appendix 19       Printer    Item Description       Printing Speed Same as Copying Speed        First Print Time 9 5 seconds or less   A4  feed from Cassette        Resolution Fine 1200  Fast 1200  600 dpi  300 dpi       Operating System Windows XP  Windows XP Professional  Windows Server 2003  Windows  Server 2003 x64 Edition  Windows Vista x86 Edition  Windows 
156. again  A confirmation screen appears     5 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The account  information is changed  Registered  is displayed and the    screen returns to Account  List     Deleting an account    1 Press the A or V key to select the account you want to  delete  and then press  Menu   the Right Select key      2 Press the A or V key to select  Delete         11 21    Management          3 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears   Delete     Are you sure      g eUI R amp D DEPT          Yes     No            4 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The account is  deleted Completed  is displayed and the screen returns  to Account  List     Managing the Copier Printer Counts    You can select how the copying and printing page counts are shown   either the total of both or each of copying and  printing individually  The selection may influence restriction on the count and count method  Refer to Restricting the  Use of the Machine on page 11 23  Counting the Number of Pages Printed on page 11 31 and Printing an Accounting  Report on page 11 35 for details     Use the procedure below to set the counting methods     1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter                2 Press the A or V key to select  User Job Account    Sys  Menu Count   9    04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with
157. age 3 25           3 24    Basic Operation       Confirm Destination Screen    If the screen for confirming the destination before transmission  page 8 88  is set to  On   Check through the all  destination and press  Next   appears when the Start key is pressed     Use the procedure below to operate the Confirm Destination screen                                   1 Press the A or V key to check all destinations   Destination List   m  MMorgan  t ttteHH HH    Press the OK key to edit or delete the selected      l0667741234 To add a destination  press  Cancel   the Left Select key     Cancel     Next   to return to the previous screen   MMorgan      tt FH    OO  Detail  Delete  2 After the checking is finished  press  Next   the Right  Set original Select key   Set original and press Start key  is displayed  and press Start key  on the screen     Cancel    If there are destinations that are hidden and not yet  Check the destination checked  the screen displays Check the destination list  list through the end  through the end  and returns to the Destination List  screen  Check all destinations   3 Place the original on the platen and press the Start key     Transmission starts        3 25    Basic Operation       Specifying Destination  When specifying destination  choose from the Address Book or use the One touch keys     Choosing from the Address Book  Select a destination registered in the Address Book       1 Inthe basic screen for sending  press the Address  Select Addr Bo
158. ainer Replacement    When the message display displays Add toner  replace the toner     Every time you replace the toner container  be sure to clean the parts as instructed below  Dirty parts may deteriorate  output quality        CAUTION  Do not attempt to incinerate the toner container or the waste toner box  Dangerous sparks may cause  burns        Toner Container Replacement       NOTE  You do not have to turn machine power off before  starting the replacement  Any data that may be processing in  the machine will be deleted if you turn the machine power  off        1 Open the top cover and front cover                       e Ose a ee  is  coo a    2 Push toner container lock lever to the right and pull out  the toner container                                      Tl                         3 Put the old toner container in the plastic bag  contained  in the toner kit  and discard it later according to the local  code or regulations for waste disposal        4 Take the new toner container out of the toner kit        9 5    Maintenance       5 Shake the new toner container at least 10 times as  shown in the figure in order to distribute the toner evenly  inside the container     6 Remove the label from the toner container     7 Set the new toner container in the machine and push  down on the top of the toner container to install it firmly  in place as shown at the left                                                  8 Close the top cover and front cover     Proceed to the n
159. al Image  Km OK     Photo   Text          4 Press the A or V key to select the image quality suited  to the type of original     5 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the basic screen     6 Press the Start key  Copying begins        3 9    Basic Operation       Zoom Copying  Adjust the magnification to reduce or enlarge the original image  The following zoom options are available     Auto Zoom    Automatically reduces or enlarges the original image suitably    to the selected paper size   Lettei R Statement R  129         C          Zoom Entry    Manually reduces or enlarges the original image in 1   increments between 25  and 400            Standard Zoom  Reduces or enlarges at preset magnifications     The following magnifications are available     Zoom Level  OriginalCopy        Inch Standard   100   400   Max    200   129   Statement  gt  gt  Letter    Models 78   Legal  gt  gt  Letter   64   Letter  gt  gt  Statement   50    25   Min         Other 141   A5  gt  gt  A4   115   B5  gt  gt  A4   90   Folio  gt  gt  A4    86   A4  gt  gt  B5   70   A4  gt  gt  A5        Metric   Standard   100   400   Max    200   141   A5  gt  gt  A4    Models 115   B5  gt  gt  A4   86   A4  gt  gt  B5   70   A4  gt  gt  A5    50   25   Min         Other 129   Statement  gt  gt  Letter   90   Folio  gt  gt  A4    78   Legal  gt  gt  Letter   64   Letter  gt  gt  Statement        Metric Standard   100   400   Max    200   141   A5  gt  gt  A4         Models 1
160. al is selected automatically     7 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     8 Press the Start key to start copying        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           Copying Functions       Selecting the Multi Purpose Tray  Change the paper size and media type     The available paper sizes and media types are shown in the table below     Category    Standard   Letter  Legal  Statement  Executive  Oficio Il   Sizes A4  A5  A6  B5  B6  Folio  16K  ISO B5   Envelope  10  Envelope  9  Envelope  6   Envelope Monarch  Envelope DL  Envelope  C5  Hagaki  Oufuku Hagaki  Youkei 4  Youkei  2 and Custom        Inch models  Horizontal  5 83 to 14 02   in 0 01  increments    Vertical  2 76 to 8 50   in 0 01  increments        Metric models   Vertical  70 to 216 mm  in 1 mm increments    Horizontal  148 to 356 mm  in 1 mm  increments           Plain  Transparency  Rough  Vellum  Labels  Recycled   Preprinted     Bond  Cardstock  Color  Prepunched      Letterhead     Envelope  Thick  High Quality  Custom 1 to  8             For instructions on how to specify the custom paper size  Custom    refer to Adding a Custom Size and Media Type for Paper to Print on  page 8 10   at The input units can be changed in the System menu    Refer to Switching Unit of Measurement on page 8 24       For instructions on how to specify the custom paper types 1 to 8   refer to Paper Weight on page 8 16   To pr
161. al parts  For instructions  refer to  Cleaning on page 9 2        NOTE  Return the exhausted waste toner box to your  dealer or service representative  The collected waste toner  box will be recycled or disposed in accordance with the  relevant regulations        Prolonged Non Use and Moving of the Machine    Prolonged Non use  If you ever leave the machine unused for a long period of time  remove the power cord from the wall outlet     We recommend you consult with your dealer about the additional actions you should take to avoid possible damage  that may occur when the machine is used next time     Moving the Machine  When you move the machine     e Move it gently   e Keep it as level as possible to avoid spilling toner inside the machine   e Be sure to consult a service technician before attempting long distance transportation of the machine        WARNING  If you ship the machine  remove and pack the developer unit in a plastic bag and ship them separately  from the machine        Replacing the maintenance kit  MK 370     When the print position shifts out of place or originals are not feeded  components must be replaced  Contact your  Service Representative and purchase the maintenance kit  Follow the procedure below to replace the maintenance  kit        9 8    Maintenance       Replace the paper feed roller    1 Open the left cover of the document processor     2 Lift the lever to release the lock     3 Move the front side and remove the paper feed roller  ee    1 Whil
162. ame for the  shared folder        Has the  Login User Name   been entered properly     Check the domain name and login  user name          Has the same domain name  been used for the  Host  Name  and  Login User  Name      Delete the domain name and  backslash       from the  Login  User Name         Has the  Login Password   been entered properly     Check the login password        Have exceptions for  Windows Firewall been  configured properly     Configure exceptions for Windows  Firewall properly        Do the time settings for the  equipment  domain server   and data destination  computer differ     Set the equipment  domain server   and data destination computer to  the same time           Is the touch panel displaying  Send error         Refer to Responding to Send Error             You can also enter a full computer name as the host name  for example  pc001 abcdnet com       You can also enter login user names in the following formats    Domain_name user_name  for example  abcdnet james smith    User_name domain_name  for example  james smith abcdnet        10 5    Troubleshooting       Responding to Error Messages    If the control panel displays any of these messages  follow the corresponding procedure     Alphanumeric    Error Message    Load paper in cassette  1     Check points    Is the indicated cassette out  of paper     Corrective Actions    Load paper     Reference  Page       Load paper in MP  Tray     Is the paper of the selected  size loaded in the multi 
163. an aa e OEE E ed en ee ends 7 19    Default Setting  System Menu     Common Settings       2 08 fl i eee Se oe at de Roe 8 2  Copy  SEMIS o Eana Ea aE darko Man Peon ana ERAEN RRE ES a Ea aE 8 68  Printer Setings ernea See ee cn E a hate ete at E E ee 8 74  SOENGING SEMINGS 1s Henk Ae eS ok ed hg Bid hdl il ed ok ESE EE Bi dh hile 8 86  Document Box Settings    0    0    8 88  Printing Reports Sending Notice    1    0    teas 8 93  Adjustment Maintenance      0    0    ee tee eee eae 8 98  Editing Destination  Address Book Adding One Touch Keys               00 0 e eee eee 8 105  Restarting the System    0    eens 8 119  Network Set  p nony ate rele seguir a tune wave E A APEE R pa ada Danaa Soba  aaa ada a E 8 120  Network  Secunity en arec ner eee DE ee be bee eee eee eee eras 8 139  Interface  Block  Setting  onea es eg eh eh a ets 8 eto 8 146  Security Level  Security Level setting        onan 0  cece eee 8 150  Optimal FUNCOMS eina Ai foc a tanka dates abl at Aaa beia apana ini alsa aana Gae Daa dae 8 150  Maintenance   ETa a A EE E EE ates E T E E E S E E E E E EE E E E 9 2  Toner Container Replacement       n    nannaa aaaea 9 5  Replacing the Waste Toner BOX           00  cece eee ae 9 7  Replacing the maintenance kit  MK 370     naa nanaaaaaa aaa 9 8  Troubleshooting   Solving Malfunctions eiea sedora e i a a a E a a Da a 10 2       iii    Contents       11    Responding to Error Messages           0    cee eee eae 10 6  Clearing Paper Jams i iee ete i e e eee eee ee
164. and press the Start  key     6 After scanning all originals  press  End Scan   the Right  Select key  to start copying        3 5    Basic Operation       Message Display    The following examples explain the messages and icons used on the message display     ah WN               Ready to copy   M sally  H  HHHHF FH         Duplex          a   a                                                                            Copier Screen Send Screen  Reference    Meaning  number   1   Indicates the current status of the machine  Also displays the title of the current  menu whenever the operation panel is being used    2   Displays an icon that indicates the currently selected source of paper feed  The  meaning of each icon is as indicated below   l   The standard paper cassette is currently selected  When this icon is   displayed as     there is no paper is the cassette      The paper cassette for the optional paper feeder is currently selected   Z When this icon is displayed as 7   4 or 4   there is no paper is the  t   cassette     The MP Tray is currently selected  When this icon is displayed as there  is no paper is the MP Tray    3   Displays the size of the original s     4   Displays the current setting when there is a corresponding menu that can be  selected using the left or right Select keys    5   Displays the title of the corresponding menu that can be selected using the left  or right Select keys    6   Displays the number of copies    7   Displays the paper size to be
165. aper Set  menu appears   Orig  Paper Set   i    Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Def  PaperSource         Press the OK key  Def  PaperSource appears   Def  PaperSurce  0m    loll Cassette 1    Cassette 2  Cassette 3             7 Press the A or V key to select the paper source to be  used preferentially     8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Common Settings menu        8 20    Default Setting  System Menu        Special Paper Action    When printing on Prepunched  Preprint  and Letterhead  punch holes might not be aligned or the print direction might  be upside down depending on how originals are set and the combination of copying functions  In such a case  select   Adj  PrintDirect  to adjust the print direction  When paper orientation is not important  select  Speed Priority      The table below lists the available settings and their details     Item Description    Adj  PrintDirect Adjust print direction  Print speed is a little  slower  Select this item to print on  Prepunched  Preprint and Letterhead        Speed Priority Give the job speed top priority and  disregard the paper orientation  Select this  item when paper orientation is not  important           If you select  Adj  PrintDirect   load paper according to the steps below     Example  copying on Letterhead    gL    Original Finished Cassette Multi Purpose Tray         Original Finished Cassette Multi Purpose Tray       
166. ation  Refer to Sending to Different Types of  Destinations  Multi Sending  on page 3 28           3 18    Basic Operation       Send as E mail    Sends a scanned original image as an E mail attachment        NOTE        You must have a network environment in which this machine can connect to a mail server  It is recommended 3  that the machine be used in an environment in which it can connect to the mail server at any time over a LAN     e Access the COMMAND CENTER beforehand and specify the settings required for sending e mail  For details   see COMMAND CENTER  Settings for E mail  on page 2 28     e Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the Send key     E mail  Fold j  Send  Foker  Displays the screen for sending              2 Press the A or V key to select  E mail    Send to  Sma OK       Folder  SMB    BFolder  FTP           3 Press the OK key  Address Entry appears                       Address Entry   0  E  ABC    Text    4 Enter the destination e mail address   NOTE  Destination can be specified using the Address  Book or the One touch keys  Refer to Specifying  Destination on page 3 26   5 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  Ready to send  screen returns to the basic screen   Dest   1       as EALA Wee NOTE  If the screen for confirming the entry of a new   1 sided   300x300dp1 destination  page 8 88  is set to  On   a screen to confirm the    Duplex    ScanRes    entered e mail address appears
167. be set between 000 and  255        IMPORTANT  When the DHCP Setting  page 8 126  is  On    the current IP address is displayed and cannot be changed     When setting an IP address  set the DHCP Setting  page 8   126  to Off        21 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu     22 Press the A or V key to select  Subnet Mask      23 Press the OK key  Subnet Mask appears     24 Use the arrow keys to enter the Subnet Mask     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to move the cursor position  horizontally     Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to enter the  Subnet Mask  Each 3 digits can be set between 000 and  255        IMPORTANT  When the DHCP Setting  page 8 126  is  On    the current Subnet Mask is displayed and cannot be  changed     When setting an Subnet Mask  set the DHCP Setting  page  8 126  to Off        25 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the IPv4 Setting menu     26 Press the A or V key to select  Default Gateway         8 124    Default Setting  System Menu              27 Press the OK key  Default Gateway appears   Default Gateway   0    M  000 000 000          28 Use the arrow keys to enter the Default Gateway     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to move the cursor position  horizontally     Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to enter the  Default Gateway  Each 3 digits can be set between 000  and 255        IMPORTANT  When the DHCP Setting  page 8 126  is  On    the current Default 
168. before Use  Explains adding paper  placing originals  connecting the machine  and necessary configurations before first use     Chapter 3   Basic Operation  Describes the procedures for basic copying  printing and scanning     Chapter 4   Copying Functions  Describes the functions you can use when copying     Chapter 5   Sending Functions  Describes the functions you can use when sending originals     Chapter 6   Document Box  Provides a basic guide to using document boxes     Chapter 7   Status   Job Cancel   Explains how to check the job status and job history and how to pause or resume jobs being printed or waiting to print   Also explains how to check the device status    Chapter 8   Default Setting  System Menu    Describes the System Menu options for general machine operation     Chapter 9   Maintenance  Describes cleaning and toner replacement     Chapter 10   Troubleshooting  Explains how to handle error messages  paper jams and other problems     Chapter 11   Management  Explains user login administration and job accounting     Appendix    Explains how to enter characters  and lists the machine specifications   Introduces the convenient optional equipment available for this machine   Provides information on media types and paper sizes  Also includes a glossary of terms        xxvii       Conventions in This Guide    The following conventions are used depending on the nature of the description     Convention    Bold    Description    Indicates the operation panel  key
169. cess       9 Click the plus symbol     to add the installed printer driver        ole Print  amp  Fax    crs 7    _            ea were    W 5 iie COptions  amp Sippliesi     Location   E  e idle  Kind    Status  Idle    C Share this printer on the network   Sharing Preferences                Default printer    Last Printer Used      Default paper size    A4          1  ol Click the lock to prevent further changes  Q     10 Click the IP icon for an IP connection and then enter the IP address and printer name     When you click the AppleTalk icon for an AppleTalk connection  enter the printer name        2 21    Preparation before Use          NOTE  AppleTalk icon is not displayed on Mac OS X 10 6                    Protocol    Line Printer Daemon   LPD Z   Address   i    Enter host name or IP address     Queue  B    Leave blank for default queue           Name  No Selection  Location  No Selection  Print Using   3                                    gt m Bonjour P    Bonjour         Bonjour       Bonjour  aon Bonjour      Bonjour  aa so Bonjour YA      Bonjour            Senile  Name  No Selection  Location  No Selection  Print Using  E  Add  A       11 Select the installed printer driver and click Add                 Protocol    Line Printer Daemon   LPD     Address   a5 pea sb gee        Valid and complete address     Queue  Z     Leave blank for default queue              Name    e            Location     Print Using    Seemee 4          4          2 22    Preparation before
170. ch Key     Use the procedure below to edit the one touch key        1 Inthe Send or FAX screen  press the one touch key    Select Key No   V m where you want to edit the destination and hold it  2  seconds or longer   Select Key Set  appears   No  12    The screen shown is the one when No 1 No 12 is  pressed and held                   Exit    2 Press the A or V key to select the key number where  you want to edit the destination   3 Press the OK key  The Key Edit appears   Key Edit    O    Detail    Delete    Exit      4 Press the A or V key to select  Edit                  NOTE  If you select  Delete  here and press the OK key   you can delete the registration of the destination  If you  press  Yes   the Left Select key  in the screen that appears   Completed  is displayed and the registration of the  destination is deleted           5 Press the OK key  The Address Book list screen    Addressbook   gt  0 appears    amp  Fiala   amp  Maury     Menu               6 Press the A or V key to select the destination you want  to newly register        NOTE  If you want to search from the Address Book  refer  to Search in Address Book on page 3 27           7 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears   Overwrite     Are you sure   No  1      Yes   I No                  8 117    Default Setting  System Menu        Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The selected  destination is registered to the one touch key   overwriting the previous one  Registered  is displayed  and the scree
171. copies  box  Enter any number up to 999     When there is more than one document  select Collate  to print out one by one in the sequence of the page  numbers     Click Properties button  The Properties dialog box  appears     Select the Basic tab and click Page Size button to select  the paper size     To print on the special paper such as thick paper or  transparency  click the Media Type menu and select the  media type        3 16    Basic Operation       7 Click Source and select the paper source        NOTE  If you choose Auto source selection  papers are  supplied automatically from the paper source loaded with  paper of optimum size and type  To print on special paper  such as envelope or thick paper  place it on the multi  purpose tray and select MP Tray           8 Select paper orientation  either Portrait or Landscape   to match the orientation of the document     Selecting Rotated will print the document rotated 180     9 Click OK button to return to the Print dialog box     10 Click OK button to start printing     Printing Using Half Speed Mode    When printing on a paper with a smooth surface or thick paper  adjust the printing speed using the printer driver  For  details  refer to Printer Driver User Guide        Basic Operation       Sending    This machine can send a scanned image as an attachment to an E mail message or to a PC linked to the network   In order to do this  it is necessary to register the sender and destination  recipient  address on the networ
172. ct the equipment to a PC or network  and prepare the necessary cables     Connection Example    Determine the method to connect the equipment to a PC or network by referring to the illustration below     Administrator s       Connecting a scanner to your PC network with a network    cable  100BASE TX or 10BASE T     COMMAND CENTER  Network    Network settings  Scanner   default settings  User and   destination registration   n     fi a                                   USB    Printing  Network  A    Network FAX ot Network    z  I l I  I   I  I   I  I   I  I H I  I   I  I I  3        3 D  i FAX i    FAX 1  I I  I I  I I  I I  I I  I I  I I             LIL LL LY     Send E mail    Sends the image data  of scanned originals to  the desired recipient  as a file attached to an  E mail message     Send SMB    Saves the scanned  image as a data file on  your PC     Send FTP    Sends the scanned  image as a data file on  the FTP     TWAIN Scanning    WIA Scanning    TWAIN and WIA are  standardized interface  for communication  between software  applications and image  acquisition devices        Preparation before Use       Preparing Necessary Cables    The following interfaces are available to connect the equipment to a PC  Prepare the necessary cables according to    the interface you use     Available Standard Interfaces    Function    Printer Scanner   Network FAX     Interface    Network interface    Necessary Cable    LAN  10Base T or  100Base TX  Shielded        Printer TWAIN  
173. ctable media types are as follows    Plain  Transparency  Rough  Vellum  Labels  Recycled   Preprinted  Bond  Cardstock  Color  Prepunched   Letterhead  Envelope  Thick  High Quality and Custom  1 8    To change to a media type other than Plain  refer to Paper Weight on page       2 51    Preparation before Use          NOTE  If using the FS 3140MFP  and the multi purpose tray is used to print a received FAX  the available media    types are as shown below   Plain  Recycled  Bond  Color  High Quality and Rough       System Menu   Counter    Q          Login User Name   0       Login Password       Login            Sys  Menu Count    gt 00  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings       Common Settings   gt m  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Orig  Paper Set    gt m  Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize     Exit                  MP Tray Set   Kad ox      ol  MP Tray Size    MP Tray Type      Exit               1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit  operation panel     When you are performing user management and have  not logged in  a login screen will appear  Then  enter the  user ID and password to log in        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        2 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      3 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     4 Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set       5 Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  me
174. cted by  Group Authorization           This job is canceled because it is  restricted by Group Authorization   Press the OK key              10 6    Troubleshooting       Error Message    Close front cover     Check points    Is there any cover which is  open     Corrective Actions    Close the cover indicated on the  operation panel     Reference  Page       Close Document  Processor     Is the document processor  open     Close the document processor        Is the top cover of the  document processor open     Close the top cover of the document  processor        Left cover is open     Is the left cover open     Close the left cover        Job Accounting  restriction exceeded   Cannot print     The job is canceled  Press the OK  key        Job Accounting  restriction exceeded   Cannot scan     The job is canceled  Press the OK  key        Polling box limit  exceeded   Job is canceled     Polling box is full  and no further  storage is available  The job is  canceled  Press the OK key        Incorrect Login User  Name or Password   Job Is canceled     Enter correct login user name or  password        Failed to store job  retention data  Job is  canceled     Is there insufficient space  available on the RAM disk     Printing using the Job Box function  failed because there was insufficient  space available on the RAM disk   Change the size of RAM disk with the  numeric keys        RAM disk error  Press   OK         A RAM disk error has occurred  Look  at the error code given i
175. ction method when the zoom changes  The table below  shows the available settings     Item Description    MostSuitableSize Select paper based on the current zoom  and the size of the original        Same as OrigSize Select paper that matches the size of the  original  regardless the zoom           Use the procedure below to specify the action performed for Auto Paper Selection          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  Copy      User Job Account  Common Settings  Copy      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Copy menu appears   Copy    O  Paper Selection  AutoPaperSelect      Exit               Press the A or V key to select  AutoPaperSelect          4 Press the OK key  AutoPaperSelect  appears   AutoPaperSelect         0  MostSuitableSize  Same as OrigSize             5 Press the A or V key to select  MostSuitableSize  or   Same as OrigSize      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Copy menu        8 70    Default Setting  System Menu        Auto   Priority    When a paper source of different size from the original is selected  select whether automatic zoom  reduce zoom  is    performed     The table below shows the available settings  The default setting is Off     No zoom performed  copied in original size         Automatic zoom performed as appropriate        Use the procedure below to specify the automatic zoom priority        Sys  Menu Count        User Job Account  Common Sett
176. d Line             9 Press the A or V key to select   None       Solid Line        Dotted Line  or     Positioning Mark      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Detail Setting menu     Orig  Binding    Select the default value for the binding edge of the original when  2 sided gt  gt 1 sided  or  2 sided gt  gt 2 sided  is selected  for Duplex  Items available for the default value are as follows     a a i    Ha Left Right Left right binding          He Top Top binding       Use the procedure below to select the default value for the binding edge of the original        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   gt i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default   gt     Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Detail Setting         8 61    Default Setting  System Menu        Finish Binding          Detail Setting   lt  lt    4 in 1 Layout  Border Line     Exit                  Orig  Binding  bmg OK     01 gt  ld Left Right  Hy Top          6 Press the OK key  The Detail Setting menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Binding      8 Press the O
177. d for Authenticate  the login user name set here will be  used for SMTP authentication  The maximum length of the login user name is  64 characters        Login Password    When Other is selected for Authenticate  the password set here will be used for  authentication  The maximum length of the login password is 64 characters        POP before SMTP Timeout    Enter the timeout  in seconds  if you chose POP before SMTP as the  Authentication Protocol        Test    This will test if the SMTP connection can be successfully established        E mail Size Limit    Enter the maximum size of E mail that can be sent in kilobytes  When the value is  O  the limitation for E mail size is disabled        Sender Address    Enter the E mail address of the person responsible for the machine  such as the  machine administrator  so that a reply or non delivery report will go to a person  rather than to the machine  The sender address must be entered correctly for  SMTP authentication  The maximum length of the sender address is   128 characters        Signature    Enter the signature  The signature is free form text that will appear at the end of  the E mail body  It is often used for further identification of the machine  The  maximum length of the signature is 512 characters        Domain Restriction    3 Click Submit        Enter the domain names that can be permitted or rejected  The maximum length  of the domain name is 32 characters  You can also specify E mail addresses           2 30
178. d images   1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid ox     Color Selection O  Original Size O  Original Image O                  Exit    4 Press the A or V key to select  Original Size    Press the OK key  Original Size appears   Original Size  Km OK    0  Letter d  Legal       Statement 4             6 Press the A or V key to select the desired original size  and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     7 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           Sending Functions       Sending Size    Select the sending size  the size of image to be sent      The table below lists the sizes     Sending Same as OrigSize  Legal  Letter  Statement  Executive     Sizes Offcio Il  A4  A5  A6  B5  B6  Folio  16K  ISO B5  Envelope   10  Envelope  9  Envelope  6  Envelope Monarch   Envelope DL  Envelope C5  Hagaki  Oufuku Hagaki     Youkei 4 and Youkei 2    Relationship between Original Size  Sending Size  and Zoom          Original Size  page 5 2   Sending Size  and Zoom  page 5 5  are related to each other  Refer to the following table     Original Size and the size you    p the same different  wish to send as are    Original Size Specify as Specify as  necessary necessary       Sending Size Select  Same as   Select the  OrigSiz
179. d the operation panel  The following types of paper can be used        IMPORTANT  If selecting the paper weight  print quality may be poor because of improper fixing of toner        Paper source       Paper Weight Displayed in  Paper Operation Panel  Cassette    Paper Type Duplex path    MP tray    Plain Yes Normal2       Transparency Yes Extra Heavy       Yes Normal2       Yes Heavy1       Yes Normal3       Yes Normal2  Yes Light    Yes Normal3             Letterhead Yes Normal3       Color Yes Normal3       Prepunched Yes Normal2       Envelope Yes No Heavy3       Cardstock Yes No Heavy3  Thick Yes No Heavy3          High quality Yes Yes Normal2  Custom 1  to 8   Yes Yes Normal2                      Yes  Can be stored No  Cannot be stored       je This is a paper type defined and registered by the user  Up to eight types of user settings may  be defined  User can also enable or disable the duplex path when using Custom     For Custom 1 8  settings for duplex printing and media type name can be changed     Item Description    Prohibit Duplex printing not allowed        Permit Duplex printing allowed           Change names for Custom 1 8  Names  should be not more than 16 characters   Selecting media type at multi purpose tray   the name after change will be displayed           Use the procedure below to set the paper weight        8 16    Default Setting  System Menu              Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account      Exit               Common Settings   lt i  D
180. de    Describes how to operate FAX  check transmission results  print reports  and use Network FAX     KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide  Printer Driver User Guide   Network FAX Driver Operation Guide   KMnet Viewer User Guide   KM NET for Direct Printing Operation Guide  PRESCRIBE Commands Technical Reference  PRESCRIBE Commands Command Reference       Safety Conventions in This Guide  The sections of this guide and parts of the machine marked with symbols are safety warnings meant to protect the  user  other individuals and surrounding objects  and ensure correct and safe usage of the machine  The symbols and  their meanings are indicated below      WARNING  Indicates that serious injury or even death may result    from insufficient attention to or incorrect compliance with the  related points     CAUTION  Indicates that personal injury or mechanical damage  A may result from insufficient attention to or incorrect compliance  with the related points     Symbols    The A symbol indicates that the related section includes safety warnings  Specific points of attention are indicated    inside the symbol   AN       General warning     AN       Warning of danger of electrical shock     A       Warning of high temperature     The    symbol indicates that the related section includes information on prohibited actions  Specifics of the prohibited  action are indicated inside the symbol     S       Warning of prohibited action     Q       Disassembly prohibited     The   symbol 
181. dministrator privileges to log in  and    A T press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            2 The System menu appears   System     0    I F Block Set   Security Level    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting         4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears   Network Setting   gt       NetWare  AppleTalk    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP Settings         6 Press the OK key  The TCP IP Settings menu appears   TCP IP Settings        IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting    Exit               7 Press the A or V key to select  IPv6 Setting         8 130    Default Setting  System Menu           8 Press the OK key  IPv6 Setting appears              IPv6 Setting   gt     On    Exit    9 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off    10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the TCP IP Settings menu   NetWare Setup    Select the NetWare network connection  After that  select frame types for NetWare network from Auto   Ethernet ll  802 3  802 2  or SNAP  The default settings is  Off      Use the procedure below to setup the NetWare setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to                   Sys  Menu Count    gt  M select  System   and press the OK key   Report  Counter     Exit       A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name     password with administrator privileges to log in  and  TT press  Login   the R
182. ds of one ream  500 sheets  of paper cut to the  standard size  or trade size  for a specific grade of paper  Paper that is too heavy or too light may be supplied  incorrectly or cause paper jams  which may cause excessive wear of the machine  Mixed paper weight  i e    thickness  may cause several sheets to be supplied at once accidentally and may also cause blurring or other printing  problems if the toner fails to adhere correctly     The recommended basis weight is between 60 and 120 g m  for the cassettes and between 60 and 220 g m  for the  multi purpose tray     Thickness    Avoid using paper that is too thick or thin  Signs that paper may be thin include frequent problems with paper jams or  with several sheets being supplied at once  Paper jams may also indicate that the paper is too thick  The proper  thickness is between 0 086 and 0 110 mm     Moisture Content    Paper moisture content is the ratio of moisture to dryness expressed as a percentage  Moisture affects how the paper  is supplied  the electrostatic changeability of the paper  and how the toner adheres     Paper moisture content varies depending on the relative humidity in the room  High relative humidity causes paper to  become damp  making the edges expand so it appears wavy  Low relative humidity causes paper to lose moisture   making the edges tighten and weakening print contrast     Wavy or tight edges may cause the paper to slip when it is supplied  Try to keep the moisture content between 4 to  6  
183. e     A technical specification for connecting scanners  digital cameras  and other image equipment to the computers  The  TWAIN compatible devices enable to process image data on any relevant application software  TWAIN is adopted on  a large number of graphic software  e g  Adobe Photoshop  and OCR software     USB  Universal Serial Bus  2 0    A USB interface standard for Hi Speed USB 2 0  The maximum transfer rate is 480 Mbps  This machine is equipped  with USB 2 0 for high speed data transfer        Appendix 24       WIA  Windows Imaging Acquisition     A function to import images supported after Windows Me XP from digital cameras and other peripheral devices This  function replaces what TWAIN used to do  the feature is provided as a part of Windows functions and improves ease  of operation  so that you import images directly to My Computer without using any application           Appendix 25          Appendix 26    Index       Index    Numerics       1 sided 2 sided Selection 5 7    A       Accessibility Appendix 22  Adjusting Density 5 13  Auto 3 8  Manual 3 8  Adjustment Maintenance 8 98  Copy Density Adjustment 8 98  Correcting Fine Black Lines 8 100  Developer Refresh 8 101  8 102  Send Box Density 8 99  AppleTalk Appendix 22  Auto Low Power Mode 2 8  Auto Paper Selection Appendix 22  Auto Sleep 2 8  Appendix 22    B       Bonjour Appendix 22  Bundled Items 2 2  Buzzer 8 6    C       Cassette   Loading Paper 2 42   Paper Size and Media Type 8 12  Cassette 1 1 5  Chan
184. e    Remove Software       Advanced Tools    Hardware Documentation  Software Documentation  Software Release Notes    Select Language  Install drivers and utilities  a  1    D      c  2011 KYOCERA MITA Corporation       www kyoceramita com      From this point  the procedure differs depending on your version of Windows and your connection method   Proceed to the correct procedure for your connection type     e Express Mode    Custom Mode    Express Mode    In Express Mode  the installer automatically detects the printer when it is turned on  Use Express Mode for standard  connection methods     1 Inthe installation method selection window  select Express Mode  The print system detection window appears  and the installer detects the connected printers  If the installer does not detect a print system  check that the print  system is connected via USB or a network and that it is turned on  Then click Refresh to search print system  again        NOTE  While the information shown in Windows Vista and Windows 7 Windows XP installation dialog boxes differs  slightly  the installation procedure is the same           Installation Method  Choose how to install the software     Express Mode  Install the recommended printing software  The printing system must be connected      lt  Custom Mode    Create a custom installation      Utilities    Install printing system utilities only     ORKYOCERS   el                    2 Select the printer you want to be installed  and click Next        P
185. e  click the EES   Close  button to close the System Properties screen     In Windows XP  after checking the computer name  click  the Cancel button to close the System Properties  screen     Check the domain name and user name for logging onto Windows     1    From the Start menu  select All Programs  or  Programs   Accessories and then Command Prompt     The Command Prompt window appears        2 31    Preparation before Use             Copyright  lt e B  Microsoft Corporation  All rights reserved     Microsoft Windows  Version 6 1 7600  i and then click Enter     iC  Users james smith gt net config workstation  Computer nane    User name    Workstation active name  ABCDNET     Net BT    Tepip  CRRRRRRRE  RRRR RARK RARK RARKAKARARARY CRARRRARARKRKD  Software version Windows 7 Ultimate    Workstation domain  Logon domain    ICOM Open Timeout  lt sec gt   ICOM Send Count  lt hyte gt    ICOM Send Timeout  lt msec gt    The command completed successfully     iC  Users  james  smith gt        Creating a Shared Folder    Check the domain name and user name for logging onto Windows     BE Command Prompt  ama 2   Atthe Command Prompt  enter  net config workstation     yal  Canputer hans Screen example  user name  james smith  and domain       NOTE  If there is a workgroup in System Properties  configure the settings below to limit folder access to a specific    user or group     1 From the Start menu  select Control Panel  Appearance and Personalization  and then Folder Options    
186. e  menu for the account        11 34    Management       Printing an Accounting Report  Total pages counted at all relevant accounts can be printed as an accounting report     Reports have different formats depending on how the count of copiers and printers is administered     When Split is selected for Managing the Copier Printer Count    ACCOUNT REPORT  MFP    Firmware Version       For the count by paper size  the report will be printed by size   Use the procedure below to print a job accounting report     1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter          Sys  Menu Count    gt  0       2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account         User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name   m password with administrator privileges to log in  and  MEAE press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password        l NOTE  The User Job Account menu appears Refer to    Login   Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on  entering characters                 3 The User Job Account menu appears        11 35    Management             User Job Account       User Login Set   Unknown ID Job     Exit               Job Account Set    M  Account  Report  Total Accounting     Exit                  Print   Are you sure      Total JobAccounting      Yes IGNE No            4 Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set       
187. e  required size       Zoom Select  100   Select  Auto    or  Auto                  NOTE  When you select Sending Size that is different from Original Size  and select the Zoom  100    you can  send the image as the actual size  No Zoom         Use the procedure below to select the size for transmission when sending scanned images     1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid OK      Original Size Oo  Original Image oO    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  Sending Size         Press the OK key  Sending Size appears     Sending Size  bmg OK     0l Same as OrigSize  Letter   Legal             6 Press the A or V key to select the desired sending size        5 3    Sending Functions       7 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     8 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 4    Sending Functions       Zoom    Scans the original by automatically zooming it depending on the sending size     The table below lists the available options     Item Detail    No Zoom  to be scanned at actual size        Zoomed automatically according to the specified  sending size              NOTE  When zooming in or out  see Sending Size on page 5 3 when selecting the sending size     When Custom Size or Size Entry is se
188. e Carbon paper   e Originals with very slippery surfaces   e Originals with adhesive tape or glue   e Wet originals   e Originals with correction fluid which is not dried  e irregularly shaped  non rectangular  originals   e Originals with cut out sections   e Crumpled paper   e Originals with folds  Straighten the folds before loading  Failure to do so may cause the originals to jam      e Originals bound with clips or staples  Remove the clips or staples and straighten curls  wrinkles or creases before  loading  Failure to do so may cause the originals to jam      How to Load Originals       IMPORTANT  Before loading originals  be sure that there are no originals left on the original eject table  Originals left  on the original eject table may cause the new originals to jam        1 Adjust the original width guides to fit the originals           2 55    Preparation before Use       2 Place the originals  Put the side to be scanned  or the  first side of two sided originals  face up  Slide the  leading edge into the document processor as far as it will    go        IMPORTANT  Confirm that the original width guides exactly  fit the originals  If there is a gap  readjust the original width  guides  The gap may cause the originals to jam        Ensure that loaded originals do not exceed the level  indicator  Exceeding the maximum level may cause the  originals to jam  see the figure      Originals with punched holes or perforated lines should  be placed in such a way that the h
189. e pressing down on the hooks  x2  shown in the  diagram  lift up and remove the separation pad              9 9    Maintenance       Install a new paper feed roller and separation pad    1 Remove the new separation pad and paper feed roller  from the maintenance kit and follow the removal  procedures in reverse to install           9 10    10 Troubleshooting    This chapter explains how to solve problems with the machine     e Solving Malfunctions 200 0    ceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 10 2  e Responding to Error Messages    10 6  e Clearing Paper Jats sctch goct cee ieieaniloul ieee 10 13       10 1    Troubleshooting       Solving Malfunctions    The table below provides general guidelines for problem solving     If a problem occurs with your machine  look into the checkpoints and perform procedures indicated on the following  pages  If the problem persists  contact your Service Representative     Symptom    The operation panel  does not respond  when the main power  switch is turned on     Checkpoints    Is the machine plugged in     Corrective Actions    Plug the power cord into an AC  outlet     Reference  Page       Pressing the Start key  does not produce  copies     Is there a message on the  Message Display     Determine appropriate response to  the message and respond  accordingly        Is the machine in Sleep  mode     Press the Power key to recover  the machine from Sleep mode  The  machine will be ready to copy  within 15 seconds        Blank sheets are  ejec
190. e required     Account Name Enter the account name  up to 32 characters         Account ID Enter the account ID as many as eight digits     between 0 and 99999999         Restriction This Prohibits printing scanning or restricts the  number of sheets to load  Refer to Restricting the  Use of the Machine on page 11 23           Use the procedure below to register a new account        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    cS       SS N 2 Press the A or V key to select  User Job Account    Sys  Menu Count   0    04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit    A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and  TT press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login               The User Job Account menu appears        4 Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set     User Job Account         User Login Set   Unknown ID Job    Exit                  11 18    Management          5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears   Job Account Set    gt  m    Each Job Account  Default Setting    Exit               6 Press the A or V key to select  Account  List         7 Press the OK key  Account  List appears   Account  List   gt  0m    SeGUI Design   eRD Center    Menu                  8 Press  Menu
191. e the procedure below to select the orientation when placing the originals on the platen for sending   1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid oK     Original Size O  Original Image O    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Orientation         5 Press the OK key  Orig Orientation appears   Orig Orientation  0m  ia    iTop Edge Top  op Edge Left                    5 8    Sending Functions       Press the A or V key to select  Top Edge Top  or  Top  Edge Left      Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending           NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu        5 9    Sending Functions       File Format    Select the file format of the image to send     The table below lists the file formats and their details     Adjustable range of image    File Format    quality    Color mode    1 Low Quality  High Comp   to   Full Color  Grayscale  Black  5 High Quality  Low Comp  and White          1 Low Quality  High Comp   to   Full Color  Grayscale  Black  5 High Quality  Low Comp   and White          to   Full Color  Grayscale    5 High Quality  Low Comp           1 Low Quality  High Comp         1 Low Quality  High Comp   to   Full Color  Grayscale  5 High Quality  Low Comp                  NOTE  You cannot select  
192. ed before  Address Entry   Refer to   2 Address Entry Confirming Current Destination on page 7 14 and reconfirm    the destination address                    7 15    Status   Job Cancel       Automatic Job Log History Transmission    This function automatically sends the job log history to the specified destinations whenever a set number of jobs has  been logged     Use the procedure below to set automatic job log history transmission        1 Inthe Job Log History menu  press the A or V key to                      Job Log History    select  Auto Sending    Send History  Destination    Exit     2 Press the OK key  Auto Sending appears   Auto Sending  Sma OK    ooff  02  On   3 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On     R If you select  On  and press the OK key  Jobs appears   Jobs  a OK   Use the numeric keys to enter the number of jobs to be   1   16  sent at a time   MET  obs             4 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Job Log History menu     Manual Job Log History Transmission  You can also send the job log history to the specified destinations manually     Use the procedure below to send the job log history manually        1 Inthe Job Log History menu  press the A or V key to  Job Log History   gt  select  Send History    Auto Sending  Destination     Exit            2 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears   Send the job log    history   Are you sure       Yes   I No                  7 16    Status   Job Cancel   
193. ed in the document processor at one time  the originals can be  scanned in separate batches and then copied as one job  With this function  originals are scanned until you press     End Scan   the Right Select key      The procedure for making copies using Continuous Scan is explained below        Function Menu        om    Paper Selection DO             0  off  On       Collate O  Duplex o     Exit    Continuous Scan  i          1 Press the Copy key     2 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Continuous Scan      4 Press the OK key  Continuous Scan appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     6 Place the originals in the document processor or on the  platen and press the Start key     7 Place the next original and press the Start key  Repeat  these steps to scan the remaining originals     After scanning all originals  press  End Scan   the Right  Select key  to start copying        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 13    Copying Functions       Job Finish Notice    Sends a notice by E mail when a copy job is complete  User can be notified of the completion of a copy job while  working at a remote desk  saving the time spent waiting beside the machine for copying to finish        NOTE  PC should be configured in advance so that E mail can be used        Exa
194. eeeeees 5 8  FileFormat  de a a a a 5 10  e Original Image        eeeeeeeeesssesesreerrrrrrrrrrrrrrrrreneeeeene 5 12   Adjusting Density zeriet vetekcepSeusesiveluddenddaed deem binii 5 13  e Scan Resolution        eeeeeeeeeesessssesrrrrrrrrrrrrrrrrrrrreeee 5 14  e Color   Grayscale   Black and White Selection            5 15  e Continuous Scan i  ics  noes ain det ects a ded ceed 5 16     FileName Enty  cence cc ge pwc gepaar 5 17  e Subject and Body Entry             ccceeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaes 5 18      WSD SCaMy sic ccisve certs tide e 5 19  e Job Finish NOUGG 2 2 2 4 cpa oat eee 5 21    PTP Encrypted eX wiec2eva tent eeaeee aiea 5 23  e File Separation es ceecies siivts wae tee cia edetvuas cade dussaateauslaes 5 24  e Scanning Image using Application                ee 5 25       Sending Functions       Original Size    Select the size of originals that will serve as the basis for scanning  Be sure to select the original size before starting  the sending process     Choose the original size from the following groups of original size     Original Letter  Legal  Statement  Executive  Officio Il  A4  A5  A6   Sizes B5  B6  Folio  16K  ISO B5  Envelope  10  Envelope  9     Envelope  6  Envelope Monarch  Envelope DL  Envelope  C5  Hagaki  Oufuku Hagaki  Youkei 4  Youkei 2 and  Custom           i Regarding the setting method of Custom Original Size  refer to  Custom Original Size Setup on page 8 7     Use the procedure below to select the original size when sending scanne
195. een returns to the  Cassette 1 Set  menu        2 50    Preparation before Use                  Cassette 1 Set    gt m  Cassette 1 Size  Cassette 1 Type    Exit      11 Press the A or V key to select  Cassette 1 Type            Rough  Recycled       Cassette 1 Type  oi    12 Press the OK key  Cassette 1 Type appears           13 Press the A or V key to select the desired paper type  and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Cassette 1 Set  menu     Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray    To fix the type of paper to be used in the multi purpose tray  specify the paper size When using other than a plain    paper  specify the media type     Item Description    Standard  Sizes    Select from the standard sizes  Selectable paper sizes  are as follows    Inch size  Letter  Legal  Statement  Executive  and Oficio  II   Metric size  A4  A5  A6  B5  B6  Folio  16K  ISO B5   Envelope  10  Commercial  10   Envelope  9   Commercial  9   Envelope  6  Commercial  6 3 4    Envelope Monarch  Envelope DL  Envelope C5  Hagaki   Oufuku Hagaki  Youkei 4  Youkei 2 and Custom          Enter the size not included in the standard size   Selectable paper sizes are as follows    Inch size   X  Horizontal   5 83 14 02   in 0 01  increments    Y  Vertical   2 16 8 50   in 0 01  increments   Metric size   X  Horizontal   148 356 mm  in 1mm increments    Y  Vertical   70 216 mm  in 1mm increments        Media Type    8 16           Sele
196. efault Screen  Sound         Exit               Orig  Paper Set    gt  0m  Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize     Exit                  Media type Set   0  Transparency  Rough     Exit                  Plain  Kad OK      ol  Paper Weight      Exit                  Paper Weight  paid OK    Normal 3  04 Normal 2  Normal 1          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set       4 Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Media Type Set       6 Press the OK key  Media Type Set  menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select the paper type for which  you want to make settings     8 Press the OK key  The menu for the selected paper type  appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  Paper Weight      10 Press the OK key  The Paper Weight menu appears     11 Press the A or V key to select the weight of paper        8 17    Default Setting  System Menu              Plain  Kad OK      ol  Paper Weight      Exit               Custom X  Kad OK      ol  Paper Weight                Duplex  Name     Exit    Duplex  bmg OK      Prohibit      Exit                  Custom X  bmg OK      ol  Paper Weight                      Duplex  Name     Exit    Name Entry   0  RD Centeri     ABC     Text    Custom X  bmg OK    Paper Weight  Duplex  Name     Exit            12    13  14    15    16    17  18   
197. eft then Down  or     Down then  Left      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Detail Setting menu        8 59    Default Setting  System Menu        Border Line    Select the default value for border line when  2 in 1  is selected for Combine  Items available for the default value are    Item Description    None No border line     as follows          Solid Line Draws solid border lines          Dotted Line Draws dotted border lines                Positioning Mark Puts a mark on the border line position     Use the procedure below to select the default value for border line        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               Common Settings   lt i  Default Screen  Sound         Exit               Function Default   lt 0  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution     Exit                  Detail Setting   lt  lt    4 in 1 Layout  Border Line     Exit            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Function Default      Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Detail Setting      Press the OK key  The Detail Setting menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Border Line         8 60    Default Setting  System Menu           8 Press the OK key  Border Line appears   Border Line  paid OK        Solid Line  i Dotte
198. elect  Off  or  On      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu        8 78    Default Setting  System Menu        Duplex    Select binding orientation for duplex mode  The table below shows the available settings     Description Finish    Off No duplex mode       Bind Long Longer edge  Edge bound             Bind Short Shorter edge  Edge bound                Use the procedure below to select a duplex setting        F 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  Printer      Common Settings  Copy  Printer      Exit                  2 Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears   Printer    O    EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Duplex         4 Press the OK key  Duplex appears   Duplex    m  oi  off   Bind Long Edge  Bind Short Edge             5 Press the A or V key to select  Off    Bind Long Edge   or  Bind Short Edge      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu        8 79    Default Setting  System Menu        Copies  Set the default number of copies  from 1 to 999     Use the procedure below to specify the default number of copies        7 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  Printer      Common Settings  Copy  Printer      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears   Printer    O    Emulation Set   EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR 
199. ement             Each Job Account   gt      eRD Center  SUI R amp D DEPT                 GUL DESIGN   lt  m  Scanned Pages  FAX TX Pages     Exit                     FAX TX Pages   lt   0  FAX  1 3  1234567    Limit 1234567             GUI DESIGN   lt     Printed Pages  Scanned Pages    Counter Reset      Exit               Reset counter   Are you sure        CUI DESIGN      Yes   I No            10    11    12    13    14    Press the OK key  The Each Job Accounting menu  appears     Press the A or V key to select the account of which you  want to check counts     Press the OK key  A menu for the account appears     Press the A or V key to select the function of which you  want to check counts  and then press the OK key     If you select  Printed Pages   select the item for which  you want to check printed page counts  and then press  the OK key  Press the  lt  or   gt  key to switch the counted  items     If you select  Scanned Pages   press the  lt  or  gt  key to  switch the counted items     If the number of output sheets is restricted by an account  management function  the upper limit on the number of  output sheets is also displayed     After confirming the content  press the OK key  The  screen returns to the menu for the account     To reset the counter  press the A or V key to select   Counter Reset      Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears     Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The counter is reset   Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to th
200. ensity appears     Press the A or V key to select  Auto  or  Manual      If you select  Manual   press the OK key  and then select  the density on the next screen     Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 13    Sending Functions       Scan Resolution    Select the fineness of scanning resolution  The finer the scanning becomes  the larger the number becomes   the  better the image quality becomes  However  better resolution also results in larger file size  file capacity  and longer  scanning and sending times  The selectable resolution is 200x100dpi Normal  200x200dpi Fine  200x400dpi Super    Fine  300x300dpi  400x400dpi Ultra Fine  or 600x600dpi     The procedure for adjusting the scanning resolution when sending a scanned image is explained below                          1  2  3  Function Menu  Kad OK    01  Color Selection O  Original Size O  Original Image O    Exit    4  5  Scan Resolution   0  200x400dpi S Fin   04  300x300dpi  400x400dpi U Fin  6  7  8    Press the Send key   Place the original     Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Scan Resolution      Press the OK key  Scan Resolution appears     Press the A or V key to select the desired scan  resolution     Press the OK key     Completed 
201. er Job Account      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The User Job Account menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  User Login Set       5 Press the OK key  The User Login Set  menu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  Local User List         Management             Local User List         Admin     Userl         Menu                                       Local User List   lt  m   amp  DeviceAdmin   amp  Userl     Menu    Detail   lt   amp   User Name  1 6  Userl     Edit    Local User List        amp  DeviceAdmin   amp  Userl     Menu    Menu    O    Detail Edit    Delete  Add User          7 Press the OK key  Local User List appears     The procedure differs depending on the details to be  edited     Changing user information    1 Press the A or V key to select the user whose  information you want to change  and then press the OK  key     2 Inthe same fashion as registering a new user  press the   lt 1 or  gt  key to select the desired item  press  Edit   the  Right Select key   change information  and then press  the OK key     Repeat step 2 to change items as necessary     After completing changing the user information  press  the OK key again     5 The overwrite confirmation screen appears     Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The user information  is changed and the screen returns to Local User List     Deleting a user    1 Press the A 
202. ered        NOTE  If you enter an address number that is already  registered  the screen will display This address number is  already registered  and return to the screen of step 2        Adding a Group    Compile two or more individuals into a group  Designations in the group can be added at the same time  When adding  a group  a maximum of 20 groups can be added in the Address Book        NOTE  If user login administration is enabled  you can only edit destinations in the Address Book by logging in with  administrator privileges    Before adding a group in the Address Book  the individuals to be included in the group must be added first  Up to  100 destinations can be added as the addresses  Among them  one destination can be assigned for a FTP or SMB  address  The available addresses will be 99 in total for email and or fax addresses  For example  you can add 75  email addresses  24 fax addresses  and a FTP address        Use the procedure below to register a group        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  Edit Destination     FAX   Document Box    fi  Edit Destination      Exit                  8 110    Default Setting  System Menu              Edit Destination         01  Addressbook    Print List                              Exit    Addressbook    O   amp Fiala   amp  Maury     Menu    Menu    O  Detail Edit  Delete       Add Address                            Add Address    0m  Contact   0J  Group   Detail   lt   OK
203. erface to be used  The default setting is Auto     Use the procedure below to select the interface        Sys  Menu Count        Report  Counter    System      Exit            Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login               System     oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit                  Network Setting   gt     NetWare  AppleTalk          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      2 The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  LAN Interface         8 120    Default Setting  System Menu           6 Press the OK key  LAN Interface appears     LAN Interface    O    10Base Half  10Base Full             7 Press the A or V key to select the desired LAN  interface     The available LAN interfaces are as follows     Auto  10Base Half  10Base Full  100Base Half  100Base Full    8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Network Setting menu  GE    Set up TCP IP to connect to the Windows network  Set the IP addresses  subnet masks  and gateway addresses   The default settings are  TCP IP Protocol  On  DHCP  On  Bonjour  Off      TCPIIP  IPv4  Setup       NOTE  Prior to the IP address entries  obtain 
204. escription    100  Copy  send save  at actual size  100          Auto Automatically reduce or enlarge the             Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account      Exit               Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Function Default  0  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit    Zoom  Sma OK     01  100     Auto          originals to match paper size  sending size     Use the procedure below to select the default zoom setting     1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Function Default      4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Zoom      6 Press the OK key  Zoom appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  100   or  Auto      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu        8 46    Default Setting  System Menu        Collate    Set the defaults for Collate  The table below shows the available settings     een    Collate Collate not performed        Collate performed           NOTE  Refer to page 3 15 for Collate Offset        Use the procedure below to set the default Collate Offset settings        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press 
205. ess the OK key     3 Press the V key to select  Login Password   press the  OK key  enter the login password  and then press the OK  key     4 Check the login user name and password are correct   and press  Login   the Right Select key      Logout  To log out the machine  press the Logout key to return to the    login user name login password entry screen   Logout    Auto Logout    Logout is automatically executed in the following cases     e When the Power key is pressed to enter the sleep mode  e When auto sleep is activated   e When auto panel reset is activated   e When auto low power mode is activated       Management       Adding a User    This adds a new user  You can add Up to 21 users  including the default login user name   The table below explains  the user information to be registered                 Description   User Name  Enter the name displayed on the user list  up to 32  characters     Login User Enter the login user name to log in  up to 32   Name  characters   The same login user name cannot be  registered    Login Enter the password to log in  up to 64 characters     Password    Access Level  Select Administrator or User for user access  privileges        Account Name Add an account where the user belongs  The user   who registered his her account name  can log in  without entering the account ID  Refer to Job  Accounting on page 11 15     E mail Address The user can register his her E mail address  The  registered address will be automatically selected  
206. essor 2 55  Placing on the Platen 2 54  Original eject table 1 6  Original Orientation  Copy 4 6  Document Processor 4 6       Index 3    Index       Send 5 8  Original Size Selection   Send 5 2  Original SSLeay License xxiv  Original stopper 1 6  Original table 1 6  Original width guides 1 6  Originals   Copy 4 2   Custom 8 7   Setup 8 7   Size Selection 4 2  5 2    P       Paper  Appropriate Paper Appendix 12  Auto Selection 8 19  Before Loading 2 41  Cassette 8 12  Custom 8 10  Default Paper Source 8 20  Loading Envelopes 2 47  Loading in the Cassettes 2 42  Loading in the Multi Purpose Tray 2 45  Multi Purpose Tray 8 14  Setup 8 7  Size and Media 2 49  Appendix 9  Special Paper 8 21  Appendix 14  Specifications Appendix 11  Weight 8 16  Paper Feeder Appendix 2  Paper guage 1 4  Paper Jam 10 13  Cassette 1 10 14  Document Processor 10 17  Duplexer 10 15  Jam Location Indicators 10 13  MP Tray 10 14  Paper Feeder 10 14  Precaution 10 13  Rear Unit 10 17  Paper length guide 1 5  Paper Selection 4 3  Cassette 4 3  Multi Purpose Tray 4 4  Paper size dial 1 5  Paper width adjusting tab 1 5  Paper width guide 1 5    Paper width guides    MP tray 1 5  Part Names 1 1  Platen 1 4    Placing Originals 2 54  POP3 Appendix 23  PostScript Appendix 23  Power Cable   Connecting 2 9  Power cord connector 1 6  Power Off 2 7  Power On 2 6  PPM Appendix 23  Preparation 2 1  Preparing Cables 2 4  Printer   Setup 8 74  Printer Driver Appendix 24  Printer Settings 8 74   Copies 8 80   CR Action
207. et the  amount of time before entering the sleep state in  minutes  You cannot use the numeric keys to enter this  value     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu        8 36    Default Setting  System Menu        Auto Panel Reset    If no jobs are run for a certain period of time  automatically reset settings and return to the default setting     NOTE  Refer to page 8 42 for the default settings        e Auto Panel Reset ON OFF  Select to use Auto Panel Reset or not     Use the procedure below to specify the auto panel reset setting  The default setting is On        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            Common Settings  M    Language    Default Screen    2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears  gi                Sound    Exit    3 Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name  W password with administrator privileges to log in  and  EE E EE  press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            4 The Timer Settings menu appears   Timer Setting  Km oK    Sleep Timer  PanelReset Timer    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Auto Panel Reset         6 Press the OK key  Auto Panel Reset appears   Auto Panel Reset   gt       off  2J  On   
208. eted  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu     Select the default value for layout when  2 in 1  is selected for Combine  Items available for the default value are as     een OS    follows     EH  LtoR H TtoB Arranges from left to right or top to bottom        E R to L Arranges from right to left        Use the procedure below to select the default value for layout        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               Common Settings   lt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         8 57    Default Setting  System Menu        4 in 1 Layout          Function Default   gt m  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution     Exit                  Detail Setting   lt  lt    4 in 1 Layout  Border Line     Exit                  2 in 1 Layout bmg OK    0  L to R WH T to B  0 BI R to L          4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Detail Setting      6 Press the OK key  The Detail Setting menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  2 in 1 Layout      8 Press the OK key  2 in 1 Layout appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  E43 L to R J T to B  or   E1 R to L      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Detail Setting menu  
209. etting   gt     NetWare  AppleTalk                  Exit    WSD SCAN Kad OK    off   2  On          WSD Print Setup    Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  WSD SCAN      Press the OK key  The WSD SCAN menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Network Settings menu     Select whether or not to use WSD Print  The default setting is On     Use the procedure below to setup the WSD PRINT setting  The machine must be restarted after the setting is    changed        Sys  Menu Count        Report  Counter      Exit            Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login               System     oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit            In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting         8 134    Default Setting  System Menu              Network Setting   gt     NetWare  AppleTalk                  Exit    WSD PRINT    O  Off  023    On          4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  WSD PRINT      6 Press the OK key  The WSD PRINT menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off   
210. ext section        NOTE  Return the exhausted toner containerto your dealer  or service representative  The collected toner container will  be recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant  regulations           9 6    Maintenance       Replacing the Waste Toner Box    When replacing the toner container  the used waste toner box in the machine should also be replaced with the new  one from the new toner kit  A new waste toner box is included with the toner kit  The machine will not operate without    replacing the waste toner box     1 Open the left cover  While holding the waste toner box   press the lock lever and then gently remove the waste  toner box        NOTE  Remove the waste toner box as gently as possible  so as not to scatter the toner inside  Do not let the opening of  the waste toner box face downward           2 Close the cap to the old waste toner box after removing  the box from the machine     3 To prevent toner from spilling  put the old waste toner  box in the plastic bag  contained in the toner kit  and  discard it later according to the local code or regulations  for waste disposal     4 Open the cap of the new waste toner box           9 7    Maintenance       5 Insert the new waste toner box as shown at the left   When the box is set correctly  it will snap into place           6 Make sure that the waste toner box is correctly inserted  and close the left cover     7 After replacing the toner containers and the waste toner  box  clean the intern
211. ey  Option I F appears     Option I F   lt  0m  0 Unblock  Block          7 Press the A or V key to select  Unblock  or  Block      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the System menu           8 149    Default Setting  System Menu        Security Level  Security Level setting     The Security Level setting is primarily a menu option used by service personnel for maintenance work  There is no  need for customers to use this menu     Optional Functions  You can use the optional applications installed on this machine     Opt  Functions    Although nothing is currently displayed  when the optional functions that will be released in the future is installed  the  licenses can be set using this menu        8 150    9 Maintenance    This chapter describes cleaning and toner replacement     e Cleaning Ree rae ee ee  e Toner Container Replacement                    cceeeeeeeeeeeeeees  e Replacing the Waste Toner BOX                     eeeeeeeeee  e Replacing the maintenance kit  MK 370                 008       Maintenance       Cleaning    Clean the machine regularly to ensure optimum output quality        CAUTION  For safety  always unplug the power cord before cleaning the machine        Glass Platen    Wipe the inside of the document processor and the glass platen with a soft cloth dampened with alcohol or mild  detergent        IMPORTANT  Do not use thinner or other organic solvents           Document Processor    If black streaks or dirt appea
212. ey on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2    Sys  Menu Count    0          2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account      04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name     password with administrator privileges to log in  and  TT press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password        NOTE  The User Job Account menu appears Refer to    Login   Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on  entering characters                 3 The User Job Account menu appears        4 Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set     User Job Account         User Login Set   Unknown ID Job    Exit            5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears   Job Account Set    gt  m    Each Job Account  Account  List    Default Setting      Exit                  11 26    Management             Default Setting  M  Copy Print Count  Counter Limit                  Exit    Apply Limit    O  Immediately  03   Subsequently    Alert Only          6 Press the A or V key to select  Default Setting      7 Press the OK key  The Default Setting menu appears     8 Press the A or V key to select  Apply Limit      9 Press the OK key  Apply Limit appears     10 Press the A or V key to select  Immediately     Subsequently  or  Alert Only      11 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Default Setting menu        11
213. ey to select  Subject Body    f Press the OK key  Subject Entry appears   Subject Entry   0  a  ABC    Text    6 Enter the subject and press the OK key   NOTE  Up to 60 characters can be entered for the subject     7 Enter the body and press the OK key   Body Entry   7 0  E NOTE  Up to 500 characters can be entered for the body   ABC    Text   Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending              8 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 18    Sending Functions       WSD Scan    WSD Scan saves images of originals scanned on this machine as files on a WSD compatible computer        NOTE  For information on operating the computer  refer to the operating system help for your computer   To use WSD Scan  WSD Scan Setup  page 8 133  must be set to  On  in the network settings        Installing Driver Software to the destination machine  The example shows you how to install the driver software to a Windows Vista PC   1 Click Start and then Network in the computer     2 Right click the machine   s icon and then click Install        NOTE  If the User Account Control window appears  click  Continue     If the Found New Hardware window appears  click Cancel        3 During the installation  double click the icon shown on  the task bar to display the Driver Software Installation  screen  When Your devices are ready to use is  disp
214. f the device       The above warning is valid only in the United States of America     Radio Tag Technology    In some countries the radio tag technology used in this equipment to identify the toner container may be subject to authorization  and the use of this equipment may consequently be restricted     Other precautions  for users in California  the United States     This product contains a CR Coin Lithium Battery which contains Perchlorate Material   special handling may apply   See www dtsc ca gov hazardouswaste perchlorate           xviii       Warranty  USA        FS 3040MFP  FS 3140MFP   MULTIFUNCTIONAL PRODUCT LIMITED WARRANTY    Kyocera Mita America  Inc  and Kyocera Mita Canada  Ltd   both referred to as    Kyocera     warrant  the Customer   s new Multifunctional Product  referred to as    MFP      and the new accessories  installed with the initial installation of the MFP  against any defects in material and workmanship for  a period of one  1  year  or 300 000 copies prints from date of installation  whichever first occurs  In  the event the MFP or an accessory is found to be defective within the warranty period  Kyocera   s  only obligation and the Customer   s exclusive remedy shall be replacement of any defective parts   Kyocera shall have no obligation to furnish labor     This warranty is valid only for the original retail purchaser  referred to as the    Customer     of a new  Kyocera MFP in the United States of America or Canada  based upon the country of
215. fer to the FAX  Operation Guide       page 8 90     page 8 105     page 8 105     page 8 98     page 8 99     page 8 100     page 8 95      page 8 95     page 8 101     page 8 102     page 8 103       Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide       Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide       Xiv       Environment    The service environmental conditions are as follows        Temperature  50 to 90 5   F  10 to 32 5   C   e Humidity  15 to 80      However  adverse environmental conditions may affect the image quality  Avoid the following locations when  selecting a site for the machine     e Avoid locations near a window or with exposure to direct sunlight   e Avoid locations with vibrations    e Avoid locations with drastic temperature fluctuations    e Avoid locations with direct exposure to hot or cold air    e Avoid poorly ventilated locations     If the floor is delicate against casters  when this machine is moved after installation  the floor material may be  damaged     During copying  some ozone is released  but the amount does not cause any ill effect to one   s health  If  however  the  machine is used over a long period of time in a poorly ventilated room or when making an extremely large number of  copies  the smell may become unpleasant  To maintain the appropriate environment for copy work  it is suggested  that the room be properly ventilated     Cautions when handling consumables    A CAUTION    Do not attempt to incinerate the toner container or the waste toner box  Dangero
216. folder access  For example   abcdnet james smith    64 chars       Login Password    Password for folder access    64 chars       Encryption       If secure communication is On   encryption method can be  selected from Auto  DES  3DES  and AES     number  format   E g  FTPhostname  140        Detail     Ntid7004     Folder  SMB                 RD Centeri       Host Name  SMB                 or       If you specify a port number other than the default  21   use the  Hostname  port    1 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to display Folder SMB  or    2 Press  Edit   the Right Select key   An entry screen    Enter the host name           RD Centeri       Host Name  FTP      NOTE  Destination can be specified using the Address  Book or the One touch keys  Refer to Specifying    Enclose the IPv6 address in brackets                     Path   RD3  reporti       4 Press the OK key  Path appears      lt  0 Folder FTP    4 6   Edit       0 appears   ABC 3  Text J       gt      Destination on page 3 26    ABC  Text J      ae wi  ABC  Text J             8 108    Default Setting  System Menu        5 Enter the path name           6 Press the OK key  Login User Name appears                 Login User Name       Maury     ABC    Text    7 Enter the login user name     8 Press the OK key  Login Password appears   Login Password    gt     LETTETTTTET    ABC    Text            9 Enter the login password           10 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears  Gq  Check the connection     Are you 
217. for subsequent operations that need any E mail  function           i Mandatory at user registration        NOTE  By default  one of each default user with machine administrator rights and administrator privileges is already  stored  The following are the default user s properties     User Name  DeviceAdmin  Login User Name  4000  Login Password  4000  Access Level  Administrator    It is recommended to periodically change the user name  login user name and login password regularly for your  security        Use the procedure below to register a new user        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit  operation panel     System Menu   Counter          2 Press the A or V key to select  User Job Account    Sys  Menu Count    gt 00  4  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings     Exit                     Management             Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login                  User Job Account  0m  ol  User Login Set   Job Account  Set   Unknown ID Job     Exit                  User Login Set    lt     User Login  Local User List  IC Card Setting    Exit                  Local User List  wm  S Admin     DeviceAdmin      Menu                           Menu    O  Detail Edit  Delete  Add User  User Name    gt  0  E A  ABC    Text            A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  pre
218. ges of the original   Color B  amp  W  color mode of the original   Destination       7 10    Status   Job Cancel       When complete job name not displayed in detailed information    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Job Name to see the complete job name  Press the OK key to return to the    original screen     When complete destination name not displayed in detailed information    When there is only one destination  press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Destination to see the complete  destination name  Press the OK key to return to the original screen     When there are two or more destinations  press  List   the Right Select key  in Destination to display the destination  list  Press the A or V key to select the desired destination and press the OK key  This displays the complete name  of the destination  Press the OK key to return to the destination list     Pressing  Exit   the Right Select key  while the destination list is displayed brings you back to the original screen     Displaying Store Job Log       Status       Pause          lt  gt  w    01I  Print Job Status    Send Job Status  Store Job Status                      Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  appears     Press the A or V key to select  Store Job Log      Press the OK key  Store Job Log appears  Press the A  or V key to check the store queue     Ajob result icon is displayed on the extreme right of each  job     OK   Job completed normally  A   Job error        Job aborted      
219. ging Language 2 9  8 3  Cleaning   Separator 9 5   Slit Glass 9 3  Color   Color   Grayscale   Black and White   Selection 5 15   Color mode   Color Selection  Copy  8 42  Combine Mode   2 in 1 Mode 4 9   4 in 1 Mode 4 10    Page Boundary Lines 4 11  COMMAND CENTER 2 28  Connecting   LAN Cable 2 5   Power Cable 2 9   USB Cable 2 9  Connection Method 2 3  Continuous Scan   Copy 4 13   Send 5 16  Conventions in This Guide xxviii  Copy   Adjusting Density 3 8   Collate Copying 3 15   Duplex Copying 3 12   Offset Copying 3 15   Originals 4 2   Selecting Image Quality 3 9   Setup 8 68   Zoom Copying 3 10  Copy Settings 8 68   Auto Paper Selection 8 70  8 71   Paper Selection 8 69   Quick Setup Registration 8 72  Copying Functions 4 1  Counting the Number of Pages Printed   Each Job 11 33   Printing a Report 11 35   Total Job 11 31  Counting the Number of Pages  Printed 11 31    D       Date Timer 8 27  Auto Panel Reset 8 37  Date Format 8 29  Date Time 8 27  Low Power Timer 8 39  Time Zone 8 30  Default 8 42  2 in 1 8 57  4 in 1 8 58       Index 1    Index       Collate Offset 8 47  Color Selection  Copy  8 42  Continuous Scan 8 52  Density 8 45  EcoPrint 8 49  E mail Subject Body 8 51  File Format 8 53  File Name 8 50  File Separation 8 54  Image Quality 8 63  Original Image 8 44  Original Orientation 8 48  Scan Resolution 8 43  TIFF Print 8 55  XPS FitTo Page 8 56  Zoom 8 46  Default Gateway Appendix 22  Default Screen 8 5  Density Adjustment  Copy 3 8  Send 5 13  Destination 8 
220. gt m    Local User List  Group Auth     Exit               6 Press the A or V key to select  NW User Property         7 Press the OK key  NW User Property appears   NW User Property   gt       lo O  L  On             8 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off    9 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  User Job Account menu     Unknown login user name Job    This specifies the behavior for handling the jobs sent with unknown login user names or User ID  i e  unsent IDs   If  the User Login is set to invalid and Job Accounting is set to valid  follow the procedure when the Account ID is  unknown     The table below shows the available settings    wee o e O       Reject The job is rejected  not printed      Permit The job is permitted to be printed     Use the procedure below to process jobs sent from unknown users           NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    a    Sys  Menu Count   9          2 Press the A or V key to select  User Job Account      User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings     Exit                     11 13    Management             Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login                  User Job Account       User Login Set   Job Account  Set       Exit               Unknown ID Job    O  lol Reject  Permit          A login screen will appear  Then 
221. h Key on       page 8 116 for more information on adding one touch keys                    O Shift Lock    KS                   Sending to Different Types of Destinations  Multi Sending     You can specify destinations that combine e mail addresses  folders  SMB or FTP  and fax numbers  This is referred  to as Multi Sending  This is useful for sending to different types of destination  e mail addresses  folders  etc   ina  single operation     No  of broadcast items E mail   Up to 100  Folders  SMP  FTP    Total of 1 SMB and FTP  FAX   Up to 100    Also  depending on the settings  you can send and print at the same time     Procedures are the same as used in specifying the destinations of respective types  Continue to enter E mail address  or folder path so that they appear in the destination list  Press the Start key to launch transmission to all destinations  at one time        3 28    Basic Operation       Canceling Jobs    Follow the steps below to cancel any print or send job being executed     Canceling Jobs    You can also cancel jobs by pressing the Stop key       1 During a printing or sending job  press the Stop key  The  Job Cancel List   lt  gt  Job Cancel List menu appears     Print Job List  Send Job List  Store Job List          NOTE  Pressing the Stop key pauses a printing job but  does not pause a sending job                Exit      2 Press the A or V key to select the type of job you want  Print Job List   lt 0 to stop  and then press the OK key  An output 
222. h this function  originals can be scanned one after another until you    press  End Scan   the Right Select key      The procedure for using continuous scanning when sending scanned images is explained below                             1  2  Function Menu  bmg OK    Color Selection O  Original Size O  Original Image O    Exit    4  Continuous Scan  i  ol Off  On  5  6  7  8    Press the Send key     Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Continuous Scan      Press the OK key  Continuous Scan appears     Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     Specify the destination   Place the original  and press the Start key     Place the next original  and press the Start key  Scan the  remaining originals by the same procedure     When you have scanned all the originals  press  End  Scan   the Right Select key  to start sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 16    Sending Functions       File Name Entry    This setting allows you to assign a document name to scanned images  You can specify a default for the document  name     Use the procedure below to assign names to scanned documents that you are sending   1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu   lt 0   0  Color Selection O  Original Si
223. haracter type selection     or     is entered when only numerals are entered and no character    type is selected        Appendix 7          Characters associated with different keys can be entered consecutively  To enter a character associated with the  same key after another  use cursor keys to move the cursor to the next entry position before entering it     If you use cursor keys to move the cursor to an entry position apart from the end of the line and enter a character  there  spaces are automatically entered in between     Entering Symbols       Fi Press  Text   the Right Select key  or   on the numeric  Symbols   lt  0 keys to display the Symbols screen  Use cursor keys to  dI    R  O k       13 lt  select the symbol you want to enter and then press the     gt PO      _         fa t OK key       Text               Entry When  Select Character  Is Selected in Login Operation Settings    In the login screen that appears when user management is enabled  the character entry method may vary depending  on the settings   Refer to Login Operation on page 8 66           If a character palette appears on the screen  use cursor  Login User Name      keys to select the desired character from the displayed  Morgani characters  and then press the OK key to enter it    Babcdefghijklmnopaqrst                   uvwxy ZABCDEFGHIJKLMNO NOTE  Numerals can be entered directly by pressing    Next   numeric keys                 Appendix 8       Paper    This section explains the paper sizes
224. have       user ID and password to log in   Login Password        l NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for    Login   details on entering characters              F 2 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count     select  Common Settings    System    User Job Account    05  Common Settings                2 49    Preparation before Use             Common Settings     gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Orig  Paper Set   i  Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize     Exit                  Cassette 1 Set   i    Cassette 1 Size    Cassette 1 Type      Exit                  Cassette 1 Size  0m  l Letter H  Legal P    Statement P          Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set       Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears     Press the A or V key to select from  Cassette 1 Set   to   Cassette 4 Set          NOTE   Cassette 2    Cassette 3  and  Cassette 4  are  shown when the optional cassettes are installed        10    Follow the steps below when you select the main unit  cassette  Cassette 1   Operate in a similar fashion when  you select an optional cassette  Cassette 2 to 4      Press the OK key  The Cassette 1 Set  menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Cassette 1 Size      Press the OK key  Cassette 1 Size appears     Press the A or V key to select the desired paper size  and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the scr
225. he quality when sending scanned originals                             1  2  3  Function Menu  bmg OK    01  Color Selection QO  Original Size O  Original Image O    Exit    4  5  Original Image  Sma OK    01I   Text Photo  Photo  Text  6  7  8    Press the Send key   Place the originals     Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Original Image      Press the OK key  Original Image appears     Press the A or V key to select the desired image quality   Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 12    Sending Functions       Adjusting Density    Use the procedure below to adjust the density when scanning the originals     The table below shows the available settings     Item Detail    Manual    Adjust density using 7 levels        Auto       The procedure for adjusting the density is explained below                             1  2  3  Function Menu  paid OK    01  Color Selection QO  Original Size O  Original Image O    Exit    4  Density  Kad OK    Auto  0 Manual  6  7  8       Optimum density is selected according to the  density of the original     Press the Send key   Place the original     Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Density      Press the OK key  D
226. ier  Off     Edit            Print Restrict    lt    m  Counter Limit  Reject Usage             Limit Pages    0   1   9999999     IPERI ages                Overwrite   Are you sure       eGUI DESIGN      Yes eof No            3 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to select the item to be restricted  and then press  Edit   the Right Select key      When selecting  Split  in Copy Print Count  screen changes  as shown in the left     4 Press the A or V key to select the desired restriction  method and then press the OK key     If you select  Counter Limit   enter the upper limit number  of pages in the next screen  and then press the OK key     Repeat step 3 to 4 to set items as necessary     Press the OK key again  A confirmation screen appears     7 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The restriction of use  is changed  Registered  is displayed and the screen  returns to Account  List        11 25       Management       Applying Limit of Restriction    This specifies how the machine behaves when the counter has reached the limit of restriction  The table below  describes the action taken     Immediately   Job stops when the counter reaches its limit        Subsequently Printing scanning of the job continues but the  subsequent job will be rejected           Alert Only Job continues while displaying an alert message          The next job will be prohibited in sending or in storing in the box     Use the procedure below to apply the restriction limit     1 Press the System Menu Counter k
227. ight Select key     Login Password      Login     2 The System menu appears    System    O    01  Network Setting    I F Block Set   Security Level    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting         4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears   Network Setting   gt       NetWare  AppleTalk    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  NetWare         8 131    Default Setting  System Menu           NetWare    O  lo Oft  On             6 Press the OK key  NetWare appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off         Frame Type    O  802 3  Ether II             AppleTalk Setup    If you select  On  and press the OK key  Frame Type  appears  Press the A or V key to select the desired  frame type     The available frame types are as follows     Auto  802 3  Ether ll  802 2  SNAP    Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Network Setting menu     For detailed information on restarting the system  refer to  Restarting the System on page 8 119     Select the Apple Talk network connection  The default setting is On     Use the procedure below to setup the AppleTalk setting   1       Sys  Menu Count        Report  Counter      Exit            Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login            System     oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit               In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key     A login screen will appear  The
228. ight contact with the paper                                                                                                                                                                 6 Place the paper in the paper cassette  Ensure the side to  be printed is facing down and the paper is not folded   curled  or damaged           2 43    Preparation before Use          NOTE  Do not load more paper than will fit under the load  limits on the paper width guides    The cassette holds up to 500 sheets of A4 or smaller plain  paper  80 g m                                                                                                                                                   7 Set the stack of paper so that it is under the clips as  shown                                                                                      8 Insert the cassette into the slot in the printer  Push it  straight in as far as it will go     There is a paper gauge on the right side of the front of  the paper cassette to indicate the remaining paper  supply  When paper is exhausted  the pointer will go  down to the level of LI  empty                                                                              2 44    Preparation before Use       Loading Paper in the Multi Purpose Tray    The multi purpose tray will hold up to 100 sheets of A4 or smaller plain paper  80 g m       The multi purpose tray accepts paper sizes from A4 to A6 and Hagaki and from Legal to Statement R  and 16K  Be  sure t
229. ime   Job Name   Job Type   User Name   Original Pages  number of pages of the original   Color B  amp  W  color mode of the original    Sender Info   destination information        7 6    Status   Job Cancel       When complete job name not displayed in detailed information    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Job Name to see the complete job name  Press the OK key to return to the    original screen     When complete destination information not displayed in detailed information    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  in Sender Info  to see the complete destination information  Press the OK key    to return to the original screen     The table below lists the items displayed in the Storing Jobs Status screen     Display   Key    Details    Acceptance No  of job       Icons that indicate the job type     Storing Job Scan 4    Storing Job FAX f  l   Storing Job Printer B       Job Name    Job name or file name is displayed        Status             Status of job  k   no icon  Storing Waiting    Storing Data          Status   Job Cancel       Checking Job History    Check the history of completed jobs        NOTE  Job history is also available by COMMAND CENTER or KMnet Viewer from the computer        Available Job History Screens    The job histories are displayed separately in three screens   Print Jobs  Send Jobs  Store Jobs  and Scheduled Jobs   The following job histories are available     Job histories to be displayed    Print Job Copy   Printer   FAX reception   
230. inations  individuals  you added to the Address Book     Use the procedure below to edit a destination           Sys  Menu Count       FAX  Document Box    U  Edit Destination      Exit            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Edit Destination         8 114    Default Setting  System Menu              2 Press the OK key  The Edit Destination menu appears   Edit Destination   gt        01  Addressbook    Print List                              Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Address Book    4 Press the OK key  The Address Book list screen  Addressbook    0m appears   Fiala   amp  Maury    Menu    5 Press the A or V key to select the destination you want  to edit   6 Press  Menu   the Right Select key   Menu appears   Menu   gt     Delete    Add Address          7 Press the A or V key to select  Detail Edit            8 Press the OK key  This displays the screen for editing                Detail      the selected destination   Contact name 1 7  The screen shown is the one when an individual s  Sally a  destination is selected     Edit    9 Edit items as necessary   For how to edit each item  refer to Adding an Individual  Destination on page 8 105 and Adding a Group on page  8 110   10 After completing editing  press the OK key  A  Overwrite  confirmation screen appears   Are you sure        MsSally      Yes I ok No            11 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   Registered  is  displayed and the screen returns to the Address Book list
231. indicates that the related section includes information on actions which must be performed  Specifics  of the required action are indicated inside the symbol     Q       Alert of required action    oA       Remove the power plug from the outlet        Always connect the machine to an outlet with a ground     7 connection     Please contact your service representative to order a replacement if the safety warnings in this Operation Guide are  illegible or if the guide itself is missing  fee required         NOTE  An original which resembles a bank note closely may not be copied properly in some rare cases because  this machine is equipped with a counterfeiting prevention function           Contents       Contents    QUICK G  lden scat go cadet cic aes take fad pele evan eed uN aea Sai tine  bene cach Maat aerate ee v  Men    Ma Diei a Sect ice el ad a ae ies Se a Made ee a E ee viii  EnvirOnment  jos 25 die Sorat ios ete aire a ed adios Raby Roe ee laa aed edd ned XV  Cautions when handling consumables              0 00 cette ete eee XV  SAFETY OF LASER  BEAM  USA   eresi esou akene VERRE Sea ee ee EEEE NDE a Meg Baw ata xvii  Safety Instructions Regarding the Disconnection of Power  USA                  200 ee xviii  Laser Safely  Europe     mra ved A a a Soe Mika eh BE A ek XX  Legal Restriction on Copying Scanning           0 00 eae XX  Legal and Safety Information          20 00    ce tees xxi  1 Part Names  Operation  Panel a sdecccs cued eit i ea ee ad es eae oh aa 1 2  M
232. ings    Copy      Exit               Copy    O  Paper Selection  AutoPaperSelect      Exit                  Auto   Priority   gt  m m  ol Off  On          1    In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Copy      Press the OK key  The Copy menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Auto   Priority       Press the OK key  AutoPaperSelect  appears     Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Copy menu        8 71    Default Setting  System Menu        Select Key Set    If you register a function to the Left Select key or Right Select key  you can quickly set the function when using copy  functions     You can register one of the following functions to each key     e None  e Paper Selection    e Collate   e Duplex     Zoom   e Combine   e Original Size    e Orig Orientation  e Original Image   e Density   e EcoPrint   e Continuous Scan  e File Name Entry  e JobFinish Notice  e Print Override    Use the procedure below to set Select Key Set          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  Copy      User Job Account  Common Settings  Copy      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Copy menu appears   Copy    O  Paper Selection  AutoPaperSelect      Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Select Key Set          4 Press the OK key  Select Key Set  appears        Select Key Set    gt  m    01  Left  Right      Ex
233. ings are registered to the selected  program key     Press and hold the one of the Program 1 to 4 keys  where the settings you want to change delete are  registered for 3 seconds  Menu appears     To replace the registered settings with the current  settings  press the A or V key to select  Overwrite  and  then press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears   Press  Yes   the Left Select key  to change the settings     To delete the registered settings  press the A or V key  to select  Delete  and then press the OK key  A  confirmation screen appears  Press  Yes   the Left  Select key  to delete the registered settings     Press the one of the Program 1 to 4 keys where the settings you want to recall are registered  The current settings  of various functions are replaced with the registered settings        3 4    Basic Operation       ID Card Copy  The procedure for using ID Card copying is explained below   1 Press the Copy key when the Copy key indicator is off     Copy  NOTE  If the Message Display is turned off  press the    Power key and wait for the machine to warm up              2 Place the original on the platen     Put the scanning side facedown in the center of  Statement or A5 size scanning area        NOTE  For loading instructions  refer to Loading  Originals on page 2 54           3 Press the Program 1   Recalled   The ID Card Copy function is recalled        Program 1             4 Press the Start key  Scanning begins     Turn over the original on the platen 
234. int on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead  refer to  Special Paper Action on page 8 21        NOTE  You can conveniently select in advance the size and type of paper that will be used often and set them as  default  refer to Paper Size and Media Type Setup for Multi Purpose Tray on page 8 14         Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type   1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  Smid OK    Collate O  Duplex o    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  Paper Selection         Copying Functions             Paper Selection  0m                4a4s R Plain  a5 P Plain  MP Tray Set   Kma OK      0I  Standard Size    Size Entry                Size Entry  Y   aa OK     5 83   14 02   I ISIP               Media Type  Sma OK    Transparency  Rough          10  11    Press the OK key  Paper Selection appears     Press the A or V key to select  MP Tray Set       Press the OK key  MP Tray Set  appears     Press the A or V key to select  Standard Size  or  Size  Entry  and press the OK key  select the desired paper  size  and then press the OK key     If you select  Size Entry   using the numeric keys to enter  the Y  vertical  size and press the OK key  and then enter  the X  horizontal  size and press the OK key     Press the A or V key to select the desired paper type  and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  ba
235. ion  FAX Resolution    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Orientation         6 Press the OK key  Orig Orientation appears   Orig Orientation  0m    itiTop Edge Top       op Edge Left             7 Press the A or V key to select    amp   Top Edge Top  or   3  Top Edge Left       8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu        8 48    Default Setting  System Menu        EcoPrint    Select the EcoPrint default  The table below shows the available settings        a e S    Off No EcoPrint performed        On EcoPrint performed        NOTE  Refer to page 4 8 for EcoPrint        Use the procedure below to set the default EcoPrint setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings     gt i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    0I  Color Selection  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit    Press the A or V key to select  EcoPrint    Press the OK key  EcoPrint appears   EcoPrint  paid OK      02  on             7 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Functi
236. ion performed  Select this item if  black streak remains after using On  Low    The reproduction of the image becomes  lower when using On  Low               NOTE  Using Correcting Fine Black Line can impair reproduction of fine characters  It is recommended to keep the  default   Off          Use the procedure below to specify the setting for correcting fine black lines          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  Adjust Maint       Document Box   i  Edit Destination   123  Adjust Maint       Exit                  8 100    Default Setting  System Menu           2 Press the OK key  The Adjust Maint  menu appears   Adjust Maint    gt  oK    Send Box Density  Correct  Bk Line    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Correct  Bk Line         4 Press the OK key  Correct  Bk Line appears   Correct  Bk Line   gt       On  Low   On  High              5 Press the A or V key to select  Off    On Low   or   On High       6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the GE    screen returns to the Adjust Maint  menu     New Developer    When the printing is too light or incomplete  even though there is enough toner  refresh the developer          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  Adjust Maint       Document Box  O Edit Destination  0  Adjust Maint       Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Adjust Maint  menu appears   Adjust Maint    gt  oK    Send Box Densit
237. is explained below        A 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  Document Box      Send  FAX  Document Box      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Document Box menu appears   Document Box   gt  m    Job Box  Select Key Set     Exit                  Press the A or V key to select  Job Box   8    Press the OK key  The Job Box screen appears        Job Box  Ka oK  Quick Copy Jobs    JobRet  Deletion                  Exit    Press the A or V key to select  JobRet  Deletion    Press the OK key  The Job Retention Deletion screen  JobRet  Deletion  M appears   ooff  1 hour  4 hours             7 Press the A or V key to select the period that jobs are  retained     8 Press the OK key  The screen returns to the Job Box  screen        8 89    Default Setting  System Menu        Select Key Set    If you register a function to the Left Select key or Right Select key  you can quickly set the function when printing  from or saving to a document box     You can register one of the following functions to each key for either of printing from and saving to a document box     Print     None    Collate    e Paper Selection  e Duplex   e File Name Entry  e JobFinish Notice  e Print Override   e Encrypted PDF     TIFF Print   e XPS FitTo Page     Del  afterPrint    Store   e None   e Color Selection   e Original Size   e Original Image     Scan Resolution  e Storing Size   e Zoom   e Orig Orientation   e Continuous Scan  e File Format   e File 
238. is off before turning off the main power switch     AL i    Print Send Receive Memory Attention                               Make sure that the    indicator is off                          In case of not using the machine for a extended period of time       CAUTION  If this machine will be left unused for an extended period  e g  overnight   turn it off at the main  power switch  If the machine will not be used for an even longer period of time  e g  vacation   remove the  power plug from the outlet as a safety precaution  If using the FS 3140MFP   note that turning the machine  off at the main power switch disables fax transmission and reception           CAUTION  Remove paper from the cassettes and seal it in the paper storage bag to protect it from humidity           2 7    Preparation before Use       Auto Low Power Mode    Auto Low Power Mode automatically switches the machine into Low Power Mode if left idle for 2 minutes     Sleep and Auto Sleep    Sleep    Power              Auto Sleep    To enter Sleep  press the Power key  Message Display and  all indicators on the operation panel will go out to save a  maximum amount of power except the Main Power indicator   This status is referred to as Sleep     If print data is received during Sleep  the print job is  performed while the Message Display remains unlit     If you are using the FS 3140MFP   received fax data is  printed out while the operation panel also remains unlit     To resume  press the Power key  The machi
239. isapplication of the Software and Typefaces     Massachusetts U S A  law governs this Agreement     You shall not sublicense  sell  lease  or otherwise transfer the Software and or Typefaces without the prior  written consent of Monotype Imaging     Use  duplication or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions as set forth in the Rights in Technical  Data and Computer Software clause at FAR 252 227 7013  subdivision  b  3  ii  or subparagraph  c  1  ii   as  appropriate  Further use  duplication or disclosure is subject to restrictions applicable to restricted rights  software as set forth in FAR 52 227 19  c  2      You acknowledge that you have read this Agreement  understand it  and agree to be bound by its terms and  conditions  Neither party shall be bound by any statement or representation not contained in this Agreement   No change in this Agreement is effective unless written and signed by properly authorized representatives of  each party  By opening this diskette package  you agree to accept the terms and conditions of this Agreement        XXV       Energy Saving Control Function  The device comes equipped with a Low Power Mode where energy consumption is reduced after a certain amount  of time elapses since the device was last used  as well as a Sleep Mode where printer and fax functions remain in a    waiting state but power consumption is still reduced to a minimum when there is no activity with the device within a  set amount of time     Low Power
240. istered   Use COMMAND CENTER and  register the sender address                    10 9    Troubleshooting       Error Message    Send error   HHHH    Check points    Corrective Actions    2101  2102  2103  2201  2202  2203   3101  The network cable is  disconnected or the hub that it is  connected to is not operating  properly  Check the cable and the  hub  Otherwise  the server name or  the host name of the SMTP server is  not set correctly  Use COMMAND  CENTER and register the SMTP  server name and the host name  correctly    2204  The E mail size exceeds the  acceptable send data capacity   Decrease the size or resolution of the  scanned data to be transmitted and  resend the E mail    5101  5102  5103  5104  7102  720f   Turn the main power switch off and  back on  If this error occurs several  times  make a note of the displayed  error code and contact your service  representative  Refer to the  corrective action for the error  message     An error has occurred        9181  The scanned original exceeds  the acceptable number of pages of  999  Send the excess pages  separately     Reference  Page       Error occurred   Turn the main power  switch off and on     System error has occurred  Turn the  main power switch off and on        Incorrect account ID     The Account ID does not match   Check the registered Account ID        The phone receiver is  off the hook   Hang Up     Put down the receiver        File is not found   Job is canceled     The specified file is not fou
241. it               5 Press the A or V key to select  Left  or  Right         8 72    Default Setting  System Menu              Left   lt  0m  Duplex    05  Z00m   Combine                This function is  already registered           6 Press the OK key  This displays the function selection  screen for the flexible key selected in step 5  The screen  shown is the one when  Left  is selected     7 Press the A or V key to select the function you want to  register to the flexible key     8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Copy menu        IMPORTANT  If you try to set the function that is registered  to the other flexible key  you cannot set it and This function is  already registered  is displayed           8 73       Default Setting  System Menu        Printer Settings    Printing from computers  settings are generally made on the application software screen  However  the following  settings are available for configuring the defaults to customize the machine     Emulation Set    8 74  EcoPrint    8 77   Override A4 LTR    8 78  Duplex    8 79   Copies    8 80   Orientation    8 81  FormFeed Timeout    8 82  LF Action    8 82   CR Action    8 83   Paper Feed Mode   8 84       NOTE  If user login administration is enabled  you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator  privileges        Emulation Set    Select the emulation for operating this machine by commands oriented to other types of printers     Selection of emulation 
242. k     A network environment which enables the machine to connect to a mail server is required  It is recommended that a  Local Area Network  LAN  be used to assist with transmission speed and security issues     At the same time as you send a scanned image  you can also print the image or send it to the Document Box   To use the Scanning Function perform the following steps     e Program the settings  including the E mail setting on the machine     e  Use COMMAND CENTER  the internal HTML web page  to register the IP address  the host name of the SMTP  server  and the recipient     e Register the destination in the Address Book or One touch keys     e When the PC Folder  SMB FTP  is selected  it is necessary to share the destination folder  For setting up the PC  Folder  contact your administrator        Detailed transmission settings  to select a Document Box as the destination or to print and send the image at the  same time     Follow the steps below for basic sending  The following four options are available       Send as E mail  Sends a scanned original image as an E mail attachment   page 3 19  e Send to Folder  SMB   Stores a scanned original image in a shared folder of any PC   page 3 21    Send to Folder  FTP   Stores a scanned original image in a folder of an FTP server   page 3 21    e Image Data Scanning with TWAIN   WIA  Scan the document using a TWAIN or WIA compatible application  program   page 5 25    NOTE  Different sending options can be specified in combin
243. k is a way of augmenting the network address section of an IP address  A subnet mask represents  all network address sections as 1 and all host address sections as 0  The number of bits in the prefix indicates the  length of the network address  The term  prefix  refers to something added to the beginning and  in this context   indicates the first section of the IP address  When an IP address is written  the length of the network address can  indicated by the prefix length after a forward slash      For example   24  in the address  133 210 2 0 24   In this way    133 210 2 0 24  denotes the IP address  133 210 2 0  with a 24 bit prefix  network section   This new network  address section  originally part of the host address  made possible by the subnet mask is referred to as the subnet  address When you enter the subnet mask  be sure to set the DHCP setting to Off     TCP IP  Transmission Control Protocol Internet Protocol     TCPIIP is a suite of protocols designed to define the way computers and other devices communicate with each other  over a network     TCP IP  IPv6     TCP IP  IPv6  is based on the current Internet protocol  TCP IP  IPv4   IPv6 is the next generation Internet protocol  and expands the available address space  which resolves the problem of the lack of addresses under IPv4  while also  introducing other improvements such as additional security functionality and the capacity to prioritize data  transmission     TWAIN  Technology Without Any Interested Nam
244. key to select  Time Zone         Preparation before Use             Time Zone    m  GMT Casablanca    B1  GMT Greenwich    EJ  01 00 Amsterdam             Date Setting  Km OK    Date Format  Time Zone    Summer Time               Exit    Summer Time  Sma ok   lo OfE    02  on             Date Setting  Said OK  Date Format  Time Zone               Exit    Date Time  bmg OK    Year Month Day  2011 01     Time Zone Greenwich           10    11    12    13    14    15    Press the OK key  Time Zone appears     Press the A or V key to select your region and then  press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Date Setting menu     Press the A or V key to select  Summer Time      Press the OK key  Summer Time appears     Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off  and then  press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Date Setting menu     Press the A or V key to select  Date Time      Press the OK key  Date Time appears     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to move the cursor position  press  the A or V key to enter year  month and day  and then  press the OK key        2 12    Preparation before Use             Date Time  bmg OK    Hour Min  Second  11  45      Time Zone Greenwich              Date Setting  Kad OK    Date Time    Date Format    Time Zone               Exit    Date Format  paid OK    Month Day Year  0    Day Month  Year  Year Month Day     Exit            16 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to move the cursor positio
245. l Address       Detail     MrE mail Address   C_MAULyYGHFHEHFHFEFHEE           4 7    Edit               Address Entry          appears     ABC  Text            1 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to display E mail Address     2 Press  Edit   the Right Select key   An entry screen    3 Enter the e mail address        NOTE  Destination can be specified using the Address  Book or the One touch keys  Refer to Specifying  Destination on page 3 26        4 Press the OK key  The e mail address is registered     Entering Folder  SMB FTP  Address    Folder  SMB  Address    The table below explains the items to be entered     Host Name     Description    Host name or IP address of the  sending computer    Max  No  of Characters    64 chars       Path    Path to the folder used to save  files  E g    User ScanData     128 chars       Login User Name    User name for folder access  For example   abcdnet Vames smith    64 chars       Login Password       Password for folder access       64 chars       5 If you specify a port number other than the default  139   use the  Host name   port number  format   E g  SMBhostname  140        8 107    Default Setting  System Menu        Folder  FTP  Address    The table below explains the items to be entered     Description    Max  No  of Characters       Host Name     Host name or IP address of the  sending computer    64 chars       Path    Path to the folder used to save  files  E g    User ScanData     128 chars       Login User Name    User name for 
246. l Detail menu appears     Press the A or V key to select the item for which you  want to make settings     Press the OK key  This displays the setting screen for  the item selected in step 9     The screen shown is the one when  FTP Client   is  selected     Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off      If you select  On  for each of  FTP Client   and  IPP  and  press the OK key  a port number entry screen appears     Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to set the port  number     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Protocol Detail menu        8 138    Default Setting  System Menu        Network Security    The network security functions can be set up to protect printer operation and the print data     The following network security settings are available     e IPSec Setting    8 139  e SSL Setting    8 140  e SNMPVv3 Setting    8 145    IPSec Setting    Make this setting when you use IPSec  The default setting is On and that of Rule Setting is also Off     Use the procedure below to make the setting        Sys  Menu Count    lt     Report  Counter      Exit            Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login            System     oK   I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit                  Network Setting   gt     WSD  SCAN  WSD PRINT  IPSec    Exit               1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  passw
247. l are displayed  no trouble should be found with operation  after installing the driver and software we have provided  Continue installation        3 Click the Settings tab and select Image Compression and the Compression Level  If user login administration  is invalid  go to Step 5     ee WIA Driver Propertie  General   Color Management   Settings   About    Image Compression Color   E Authentication    ves  No  Compression Level  3 y    Low    Image Compression Gray   Black  amp  White   Compression Level    3 g    El Account ID    Metric        Geet          NOTE  When the machine s IP address is unknown  contact Administrator        4 Select the checkbox beside Authentication  enter Login User Name  up to 64 characters  and Password  up to  64 characters  and then click OK        2 26    Preparation before Use       5 Click Close     The machine is registered to the PC        2 27    Preparation before Use       COMMAND CENTER  Settings for E mail     COMMAND CENTER is a tool used for tasks such as verifying the operating status of the machine and changing the  settings for security  network printing  E mail transmission and advanced networking        NOTE  Here  information on the FAX settings has been omitted  For more information on using the FAX  refer to the  FAX Operation Guide     FAX functions available only in FS 3140MFP         The procedure for accessing COMMAND CENTER is explained below     1  2    Launch your Web browser   In the Address or Location bar  ente
248. lation     Press the OK key  KPDL Error Rpt appears     Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the    screen returns to the Printer menu     In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Printer      Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  EcoPrint      Press the OK key  EcoPrint appears     Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On         8 77    Default Setting  System Menu        6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu     Override A4 LTR    Select whether to treat A4 size and Letter  which are similar in size  as the same size when printing  The table below  shows the available settings     Item Description    A4 and Letter are regarded as the same in  size  The machine will use whichever size  is in the paper source        A4 and Letter are not regarded as the  same in size           Use the procedure below to specify the override A4 Letter setting  The default setting is On        7 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  Printer      Common Settings  Copy  Printer      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears   Printer   gt  m    EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Override A4 LTR         4 Press the OK key  Override A4 LTR appears   Override A4 LTR  Wm    off             5 Press the A or V key to s
249. layed on the Driver Software Installation screen   the installation is completed     Procedure using this machine  1 Press the Send key     2 Place the originals in the document processor or on the  platen     Displays the screen for sending        NOTE  Depending on the settings  the address book screen  may appear  In this event  press  Cancel  to display the  screen for sending           3 Press the A or V key to select  WSD Scan    Send to  Sma OK       Folder  SMB    BFolder  FTP                 4 Press the OK key  WSD Scan appears   WSD Scan  Sma OK      From Computer    From Oper  Panel      Exit                  5 19       Sending Functions       5 Press the A or V key to select  From Oper  Panel            6 Select the destination computer from the computer list   Select Computer  0m    Press  Detail   the Right Select key  to see the  MJcomputer02 information of the selected computer   M computer03     Cancel     Detail                  7 Press the OK key to confirm the destination  and then  Press Start Key  press the Start key  Transmission starts        E    Computer01 NOTE  To change the destination computer  press the Back    key and then press  Yes   the Left Select key   This brings  you back to step 6                 NOTE  To use WSD Scan from your computer  press  From  Computer  in step 5 and then scan the original from the  computer           5 20    Sending Functions       Job Finish Notice    This feature sends an e mail providing notification that tran
250. lect key      2 The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Secure Protocol      6 Press the OK key  Secure Protocol appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  HTTP Security      8 Press the OK key  HTTP Security appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  HTTP HTTPS  or   HTTPS only      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu        8 143    Default Setting  System Menu        LDAP Security  Specify the protocol to be used for LDAP  The default setting is Off     Use the procedure below to make the setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit            A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and          Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and  TT press  Login   the Right Select key    Login Password     Login    2 The System menu appears   System     oK    I F Block Set   Security Level    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting         4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears   Network Setting   gt       Secure Protocol  Host Name  LAN Interface     Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Secure Protocol         6 Press the OK key  Secure Protocol appears   Secure Pr
251. lected as the original size  the originals are sent at normal size and zooming  cannot be used     Depending on the combination of original size and sending size  the image is placed at the edge        Use the procedure below to enlarge or reduce the original to match the transmission size   1 Press the Send key   Place the original     2  3 Select the transmission size   4       Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  pata OK      ol  Color Selection O  Original Size O  Original Image O                  Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Zoom    6 Press the OK key  Zoom appears   Zoom  bmg OK     0 1  100     Auto             7 Press the A or V key to select  100   or  Auto  and then  press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     8 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        5 5    Sending Functions          NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           Sending Functions       Duplex Sending    Select the type and binding of original depending on the original     The table below lists the binding directions for each original type     Original    1 sided Sheet Original    1 sided    Binding Binding       2 sided Sheet Original       Use the procedure below to select the original type and binding direction when sending scanned originals        2 sided          Function Menu   Original Size O  Original Image O  Exit J
252. ler              Appendix 15       Envelopes  Use the multi purpose tray for envelopes     Due to the structure of envelopes  printing evenly over the entire surface may not be possible in some cases  Thin  envelopes in particular may be wrinkled by the machine in some cases as they pass through  Before purchasing  envelopes in volume  try testing a sample to ensure the print quality     Storing envelopes for a long period may cause them to become wrinkled  Thus  keep the package sealed until you  are ready to use them     Keep the following points in mind     Do not use envelopes with exposed adhesive  In addition  do not use the type of envelope in which the adhesive is  exposed after the top layer is peeled off  Serious damage may be caused if the paper covering the adhesive comes  off in the machine     Do not use envelopes with certain special features  For example  do not use envelopes with a grommet for winding  a string to close the flap or envelopes with an open or film covered window     If paper jams occur  load fewer envelopes at once     To prevent paper jams when printing onto multiple envelopes  do not allow more than ten envelopes remain in the  inner tray at once     Thick Paper    Before loading thick paper in the multi purpose tray  fan it and align the edges  Some thick paper may still have rough  edges developed by a paper cutter on the back side  Remove any such rough edges just as with Hagaki by placing  the paper on a flat surface and rubbing the edges
253. low to print a Service Status   Network Status     1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Adjust Maint       2 Press the OK key  The Adjust Maint  menu appears        8 95    Default Setting  System Menu           Service Setting   gt  M  Network Status  New Developer     Exit                  Print   Are you sure   Network Status      Yes   I No               Press the A or V key to select  Service Setting      4 Press the OK key  Service Setting appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Service Status  or     Network Status      6 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears     The screen shown is the one when Network Status is  selected     7 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The selected report is    output  Accepted  is displayed and the screen returns to  the Service Setting menu        NOTE  When acceptance of jobs is prohibited  Print  storing functions are restricted now  is displayed and the    output is canceled        Send Result Report    Automatically print a report of transmission result when a transmission is complete  The table below shows the    available settings  The default setting is Error Only     Item Description    No result report printed        Result report automatically printed   Transmitted images can also be attached        Error Only       Result report printed only when a  transmission ends in an error  If two or  more destinations are registered  the  reports are printed only for the destinations  with the er
254. ly  than regular paper to cause printing problems  Before purchasing special paper in volume  try testing a sample to  ensure the print quality is satisfactory  General precautions when printing onto special paper are given below  Note  that we are not responsible for any harm to the user or damage to the machine caused by moisture or specifications  of special paper     Select a cassette or multi purpose tray for special paper        Appendix 14       Transparency  OHP film     Transparencies must be able to withstand the heat of printing  Transparencies must meet the following conditions                    Heat resistance Must withstand at least 190  C  Thickness 0 100 to 0 110 mm   Material Polyester   Dimensional accuracy  0 7 mm   Squareness of corners 90    0 2         To avoid problems  use the multi purpose tray for transparencies and load transparencies with the long side facing  the machine     If transparencies jam frequently at output  try pulling the leading edge of sheets gently as they are ejected     Cardstock    Before loading Hagaki into the multi purpose tray  fan them  and align the edges  If the Hagaki paper is curled  straighten  it before loading  Printing onto curled Hagaki may cause  jams     Use unfolded Oufuku Hagaki  available at post offices    Some Hagaki may still have rough edges developed by a  paper cutter on the back side  Remove any such rough edges  by placing the Hagaki on a flat surface and rubbing the edges  gently a few times with a ru
255. m         Continuous Copying    1 to 999 sheets  can be set in one sheet increments        Image Write System       Semiconductor laser  1 beam           Appendix 18       Item Description    Main Memory    Standard  256MB Maximum  768MB       Interface    USB Interface Connector  1  USB Hi Speed   USB Host  1  Network interface  1  10 BASE T 100 BASE TX        Resolution    600 x 600 dpi       Operating Temperature    10 to 32 5  C 50 to 90 5  F       Environment ait  Humidity    15 to 80         Altitude    8 200 feet 2 500 m or less          Brightness    1 500 lux or less       Dimension  W x D x H     11 1 2 x 19 9 16 x 21 1 2   494 x 497 1 x 545 5 mm       Weight FS 3040MFP     56 1 Ib 25 5 kg        without toner    container  FS 3140MFP        56 76  b 25 8 kg       Space Required  W x D     11 1 2 x 25 7 8   494 x 656 1 mm  when using MP tray        Power Requirement    120 V Specification Model 120 V  60 Hz  more than 9 5 A   230 V Specification Model  220 to 240V  50 60 Hz  more than 5 1 A        Power Consumption   Maximum     Standard  1032 W  U S A  Canada   1046 W  European countries   With options  1037 W  U S A  Canada   1063 W  European countries        Power FS 3040MFP     Consump     Standard  679 9 W  U S A  Canada   676 6 W  European countries   With options 713 3 W  U S A  Canada   688 2 W  European countries        tion  During    printing  FS 3140MFP     Standard  680 9 W  U S A  Canada   677 4 W  European countries   With options  719 0 W  U S A  Can
256. me   0 password with administrator privileges to log in  and    A press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            2 The System menu appears   System     oK    Network Setting  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit               Press the A or V key to select  I F Block Set          4 Press the OK key  The I F Block Set  menu appears   I F Block set         USB Host  USB Device  Option I F    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  USB Host         8 146    Default Setting  System Menu           6 Press the OK key  USB Host appears     USB Host    O  0  Unblock  Block             7 Press the A or V key to select  Unblock  or  Block      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the I F Block Set  menu     USB Device  USB interface setting   This locks and protects the USB interface connector  B1   USB Device   The default setting is Unblock     Use the procedure below to specify the USB Device setting        7 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  System   and press the OK key     Report  Counter    System            Exit      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name   0 password with administrator privileges to log in  and  TT press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            2 The System menu appears   System   gt  oK     Network Setting  Security Level    Exit               Press the A or V
257. me and password are correct   and press  Login   the Right Select key         NOTE  The following administrator is registered in the  machine at the factory    Login User Name  4000   Login Password  4000       Logout    To logout from the machine  press the Logout to return to the    login user name password entry screen   Logout       3 2    Basic Operation       One Touch Keys and Program Keys    The one touch keys and program keys on the operation panel are described below     One Touch Key    Register destinations to one touch keys  and you can enter the desired destination by pressing the applicable one   touch key  For registering a destination to a one touch key  refer to Adding a Destination on One touch Key on page  8 116     Entering Destination with One touch Key       1 In Address Entry  press the one touch key where the    Address Entry  i OK   desired destination is registered      Recalling from One touch Keys 1 to 11  ABC Press the one touch key where the destination is    Text      registered              Recalling from One touch Keys 12 to 22    Press the Shift Lock key to turn on the lamp next to the  keys  and then press the one touch key where the  destination is registered          2 The destination registered to the one touch key is  Address Entry  0 recalled and automatically entered on the screen     Sy GHHHHHHHHHHH co  jp       sca IMPORTANT  Any destination already entered is overwritten       Text                  Program Keys    Settings of vario
258. mple of Job Finish Notice                         To  h_pttr owl net net  Subject  1234 Job end report mail  Job No   000002   Result  OK   End Time  Wed 27 Apr 2005 14 56 08  File Name  doc27042005145608   Job Type  Copy   1234    00 cO ee d0 01 14                       Use the procedure below to enable job finish notification when making copies   1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Function Menu  paid OK    Collate O  Duplex o     Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  JobFinish Notice         Press the OK key  JobFinish Notice appears   JobFinish Notice   gt      lo O  L  On             6 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key        4 14    Copying Functions             Destination  bmg OK      0  xaddress Book    Address Entry             Address Book  pai OK    M Maury  M Morgan      Menu                  Address Entry  oa OK      k k  k abcdefg jp    ABC    Text            7 Press the A or V key to select  Address Book  or   Address Entry   and then press the OK key     8 Ifyou select  Address Book   select  Address Book  on  the next screen and press the OK key  and then select 4  the notice destination     Press  Menu   the Right Select key   select  Detail  on  the next screen and press the OK key to view the details  of the selected notice destination     If you select  Address Entry   enter the address of the  notice destination        NOTE  Refer to Cha
259. n  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      The System menu appears        8 132    Default Setting  System Menu        Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting         4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears   Network Setting  0m    TCP IP Settings                NetWare  AppleTalk    Exit     5 Press the A or V key to select  AppleTalk    6 Press the OK key  AppleTalk appears    AppleTalk  gt  0   off   02   On             7 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off  and then  press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Network Setting menu     WSD Scan Setup    Select whether or not to use WSD Scan  The default setting is On     Use the procedure below to setup the WSD SCAN setting  The machine must be restarted after the setting is  changed        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit              A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and    BBS GE Pe press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            2 The System menu appears   System     oK    I F Block Set   Security Level    Exit               3 Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting         8 133    Default Setting  System Menu              Network S
260. n  press  the A or V key to enter hours  minutes and seconds   and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the    Date Setting menu     17 Press the A or V key to select  Date Format      18 Press the OK key  Date Format appears     19 Press the A or V key to select the desired display  format and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Date Setting menu        2 13    Preparation before Use       Network Setup  LAN Cable Connection     The machine is equipped with network interface  which is compatible with network protocols such as TCP IP  IPv4    TCP IP  IPv6   IPX SPX  NetBEUI  IPSec  and AppleTalk  It enables network printing on the Windows  Macintosh   UNIX  NetWare and other platforms     The table below shows the items required for each of the settings     Configure the printer s network parameters as appropriate for your PC and your network environment     For details of the procedure  refer to the Network Setup on page 8 120 or Network Security on page 8 139        NOTE  When COMMAND CENTER is used  network parameters and security settings can be conveniently  changed and checked from your PC  For more information  refer to COMMAND CENTER  Settings for E mail  on    page 2 28        Network  Setting          TCP IP  Settings    Submenu    TCP IP    Setting  On Off       IPv4 Setting    DHCP    On Off       Bonjour    On Off       IP Address    IP address       Subnet Mask    IP address     
261. n Password       Login      1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit  operation panel  The Sys  Menu Count  menu appears     When you are performing user management and have  not logged in  a login screen will appear  Then  enter the  user ID and password to log in        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for a  details on entering characters           Sys  Menu Count    0    Report          Counter  System     Exit    Report  Kma OK      Result Rpt Set   Job Log History    Exit            Report  Kad OK    Admin Rpt Set   Result Rpt Set     Job Log History      Exit            Job Log History  0m  Send History  Destination     Exit               2 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    select  Report      3 Press the OK key  The Report menu appears     4 Press the A or V key to select  Job Log History      5 Press the OK key  The Job Log History menu appears        7 13    Status   Job Cancel       Setting the destination  Set the destination to which job log histories are sent     Use the procedure below to set the destination        7 1 Inthe Job Log History menu  press the A or V key to  Job Log History  0m select  Destination      Auto Sending  Send History  Destination      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Destination menu appears   Destination  paid OK      Confirmation    Register      Exit               Confirming Current Destination       1 Inthe Destination menu  press the A or V key to select  Destination   lt 
262. n example for scan operation using the TWAIN Driver  Operate the WIA Drivers in the    same manner   1 Connect your computer to the machine using a USB    cable     2 Place the originals in the document processor or on the  platen     3 Use the TWAIN compatible application to scan from your  computer        NOTE  When the login user name and password entry  screen appears  enter them and click the OK button        4 Choose the appropriate settings and click Scan  The  scanned data will be sent to your computer        5 25    Sending Functions          5 26    6 Document Box    This chapter explains the typical procedure for utilizing Document Box     e Printing Documents Stored in USB Memory                 6 2  e Saving Documents to USB Memory  Scan to USB       6 6  e Removing USB MeMo y             cccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeceeeeeees 6 8  e Printing from a Job  BOX  cescent boccediccoebsesecenc cee sence 6 9       6 1    Document Box       Printing Documents Stored in USB Memory    Plugging USB memory directly into the machine enables you to quickly and easily print the files stored in the USB  memory without having to use a computer     Limitations    The following file types can be printed    e PDF file  Version 1 5       TIFF file  TIFF V6 TTN2 format    e XPS file   The files you wish to print should have an extension   pdf   tif   xps     Files to be printed should be saved no further down than the top 3 folder levels     Plug the USB memory directly into the USB memory 
263. n place of      The possible error codes and their  descriptions are as follows    01  Format error  Try turning the  power off and on again    02  RAM disk mode is Off  Turn RAM  disk mode On from the operation  panel    04  No disk space  Purge  unnecessary files    05  Specified file is not on disk    06  Insufficient memory to support the  RAM disk system  Expand the  memory        Incorrect ID       Is the user ID entered for  private job correct        The user ID entered for a private job  is not correct  Check the user ID that  you specified on the printer driver              10 7    Troubleshooting       Error Message    Job Accounting  restriction exceeded   Job is canceled     Check points    Is the acceptable printing  count restricted by Job  Accounting exceeded     Corrective Actions    The printing count exceeded the  acceptable count restricted by Job  Accounting  Cannot print any more   This job is canceled  Press the OK  key     Reference  Page       Machine failure   Call service     Internal error has occurred  Make a  note of the error code displayed on  the Message Display  Turn off the  machine  unplug the power cord  and  contact your Service Representative        Is Error code  C4200   displayed     Internal condensation has occurred  as a result of a sudden change in  temperature  Turn off the machine  and let stand for 30 to 90 minutes   and then back on again  If this  message still remains  turn off the  machine  unplug the power cord  and  contac
264. n returns to the basic screen        8 118    Default Setting  System Menu        Restarting the System    Restart the printer without turning the main power switch off   Use this to deal with any unstable operation by the machine    Same as the computer restart      Use the procedure below to restart the system        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    M select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit                    A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name     password with administrator privileges to log in  and    Sa press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login   Gq    2 The System menu appears              System     oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Restart         Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears   Restart     Are you sure             Yes w  No         5 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The printer is  restarted     If you press  No   the Right Select key   the printer does  not restart and the screen returns to the System menu        8 119    Default Setting  System Menu        Network Setup    The following network settings are available     LAN Interface Setup    8 120  TCP IP  IPv4  Setup    8 121  TCP IP  IPv6  Setup    8 130  NetWare Setup    8 131  AppleTalk Setup    8 132  Protocol Detail    8 136    LAN Interface Setup    Specify the settings for the LAN int
265. n the cover of the optical unit        DANGER   GLASS 3B LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN   AVOID DIRECT EXPOSURE TO BEAM    ATTENTION   CLASE 3B RAYONNEMENT LASER EN CAS D OUVERTURE   EXPOSITION DANGEREUSE AU FAI  l    VORSICHT   KLASSE 3B LASERSTRAHLUNG  WENN ABDEGKUNG GE  FFNET   NICHT DEM STRAHL AUSSETZEN    ATTENZIONE   CLASSE 3B RADIAZIONE LASER IN CASO DI APERTURA   EVITARE L ESPOSIZIONE AL FASCIO    PRECAUCION   CLASSE 3B RADIACIONE LASER CUANDO SE ABRE   EVITAR EXPONERSE AL RAYO    VAROI   AVATTAESSA OLET ALTTIINA LUOKAN 3B LASERSATEILYLLE   ALA KATSO SATEESEEN     ME ARABARRA  FETERANEN   FOR    HS  BESARRES  HATO AMMA   METERES     AH CLASS 3B 7H AOS AH HRAL   MS cram  c7523BL   y cas   C ARRERED  MNT           4  Maintenance    For safety of the service personnel  follow the maintenance instructions in the other section of this manual        xvii       Safety Instructions Regarding the Disconnection of Power  USA     Caution  The power plug is the main isolation device  Other switches on the equipment are only functional switches  and are not suitable for isolating the equipment from the power source     Attention  Le d  branchement de la fiche secteur est le seul moyen de mettre l   appareil hors tension  Les  interrupteurs sur l appareil ne sont que des interrupteurs de fonctionnement  ils ne mettent pas l appareil hors tension     WARNING    This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device  pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC 
266. nce  including the GNU Public Licence         xxiv       Monotype Imaging License Agreement    1    2    11    12    Software shall mean the digitally encoded  machine readable  scalable outline data as encoded in a special  format as well as the UFST Software     You agree to accept a non exclusive license to use the Software to reproduce and display weights  styles and  versions of letters  numerals  characters and symbols  Typefaces  solely for your own customary business or  personal purposes at the address stated on the registration card you return to Monotype Imaging  Under the  terms of this License Agreement  you have the right to use the Fonts on up to three printers  If you need to have  access to the fonts on more than three printers  you need to acquire a multi user license agreement which can  be obtained from Monotype Imaging  Monotype Imaging retains all rights  title and interest to the Software and  Typefaces and no rights are granted to you other than a License to use the Software on the terms expressly set  forth in this Agreement     To protect proprietary rights of Monotype Imaging  you agree to maintain the Software and other proprietary  information concerning the Typefaces in strict confidence and to establish reasonable procedures regulating  access to and use of the Software and Typefaces     You agree not to duplicate or copy the Software or Typefaces  except that you may make one backup copy  You  agree that any such copy shall contain the same pro
267. ncel key   Print Job status     page 7 2  Send Job Status     page 7 2  Store Job Status    page 7 2  Scheduled Job     page 7 8  Print Job Log    page 7 8  Send Job Log     page 7 8  Store Job Log    page 7 8  Scanner    page 7 19  Printer    page 7 19  FAX   page 7 19  Toner Status    page 3 30  Paper Status    page 3 30  USB Memory    page 7 20   System Menu  Report Report Print Menu Map    Counter key     Continued on  next page           Status Page             Font List  Admin Rpt Set    Outgoing FAX Rpt  Incoming FAX Rpt          Result Rpt    Send Result       E mail Folder                         Set   FAX  CancelBeforeSe  nd  FAX RX Result  JobFinish Notice  Job Log Auto Sending  HLSEOrYyY       Send History       Destination    Confirmation          Register       Subject          SSFC Log Subject             page 8 93     page 8 93     page 8 93       Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide       Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide       page 8 96     page 8 96     page 8 96     Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide       Refer to the FAX  Operation Guide        page 7 13      page 7 13     page 7 13     page 7 13      page 7 13    page 7 13                System Menu   Counter key   Continued from  previous page      Continued on  next page                                                                                Counter  System Network TCP IP iss  Setting Settings  IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting  Protocol  Detail  NetWare  AppleTalk  WSD SCAN  WSD PRINT  IPSec  Secure Prot
268. nd  The  job is canceled  Press the OK key        KPDL error  Job is  canceled     The job is canceled  Press the OK  key        Print overrun  Job is  canceled     The job is canceled  Press the OK  key        Inner Tray is full of  Paper   Remove the paper     Remove paper from the inner tray   and press the OK key to resume the  job        Unknown toner  Installed        Is the installed toner  container our own brand        We will not be liable for any damage  caused by the use of third party  supplies in this machine              10 10    Troubleshooting       Error Message    Check points    Corrective Actions    Reference  Page                Unknown toner Does the installed toner Install the specified container  9 5  Installed  PC container s regional  specification match the  machines s   Insufficient memory    Further scanning cannot be      Cannot start the job performed due to insufficient memory   Press the OK key to print the  scanned pages  Press the Cancel  key to cancel the printing job   Match the paper type   Are envelopes printing using   Press the two envelope buttons to 2 47  and the envelope the envelpe mode  change the paper feed mode to  switch position  envelope mode   Match the position of   Is either of the envelope Press the both switches  2 47    envelope swiches     switches is pressed        The developer unit is  not installed     Is the developer unit  installed correctly     Contact your service technician        Replace Process Unit       
269. nd Media Type for the Cassettes on page 2 49      To fix the type of paper to be used in multi purpose tray  specify the paper size setting   Refer to Specifying Paper  Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2 51      Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Cassettes    To fix the type of paper to be used in cassette or the optional paper feeder  cassettes 2 to 4   specify the paper size   Also  you use a media type other than plain paper  specify the media type setting     Selection Item Selectable Size Type    Paper Size Select from the standard sizes  Selectable paper  sizes are as follows   Inch size  Letter  Legal  Statement  and Oficio II    Metric size  A4  A5  A6   B5  Folio  and 16K       Media Type Plain  Rough  Recycled  Preprinted  Bond  Color   Prepunched  Letterhead  High Quality and  Custom 1 8               Statement and A6 can only be used in cassette 1   To change to a media type other than Plain  refer to Paper  Weight on page 8 16     x     NOTE  If using the FS 3140MFP   the available media types for printing received faxes are as shown below   Plain  Recycled  Bond  Color  High Quality and Rough    When the paper size dial on a cassette is set to OTHER  a paper size can be set for the cassette        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2    Login User Name   W not logged in  a login screen will appear  Then  enter the          When you are performing user management and 
270. ne will be ready  to operate in about 15 seconds     Note that ambient environmental conditions  such as  ventilation  may cause the machine to respond more slowly     Auto Sleep automatically switches the machine into Sleep Mode if left idle for 15 minutes        2 8    Preparation before Use       Switching the Language for Display  Language     Select the language displayed on the Message Display     Use the procedure below to select the language     1 Turn on the main power switch              2 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2    Login User Name   O not logged in  a login screen will appear  Then  enter the          When you are performing user management and have       user ID and password to log in   Login Password        NOTE  The following administrator is registered in the    Login   machine at the factory    Login User Name 4000   Login Password 4000             Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details  on entering characters           3 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings          4 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   gt m    Language  Default Screen  Sound            Exit         5 Press the A or V key to select  Language         2 9    Preparation before Use             Language  bmg OK    lo  English  Deutsch    Francais       
271. nfiguration Protocol     Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol  DHCP  that automatically resolves IP addresses  subnet masks  and gateway  addresses on a TCP IP network  DHCP minimizes the load of network management employing a large number of  client computers because it relieves individual clients including printers from the IP address being assigned     dpi  dots per inch    A unit for resolution  representing the number of dots printed per inch  25 4 mm     EcoPrint Mode   A printing mode that helps save toner  Copies made in this mode are thus lighter than normal   Emulation    The function to interpret and execute other printers  page description languages  The machine emulates operation of  PCL6  KC GL  KPDL  and KPDL  automatic         Appendix 22       FTP  File Transfer Protocol     A protocol to transfer files on the TCP IP network  whether the Internet or an intranet  Along with HTTP and SMTP   POP  FTP is now frequently used on the Internet     Grayscale    A computer color expression  Displayed images of this sort are typically composed of shades of gray  varying from  black at the weakest intensity to white at the strongest  without any other colors  Gray levels are displayed in  numerical levels  that is  white and black only for 1 bit  256 gray levels  including white and black  for 8 bits  and 65 536  gray levels for 16 bits     IP Address    An Internet protocol address is a unique number that represents a specific computer or related device on the network   
272. nu     To reset the counter  press the A or V key to select   Counter Reset      Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears        11 32    Management       12 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   The counter is reset   Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Total Accounting menu     Each Job Accounting Resetting the Counter  This counts the number of pages for each account and resets the counts by account   Use the procedure below to display and reset the counter     1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2    Sys  Menu Count    0          2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account      04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name   m password with administrator privileges to log in  and  E ea A   press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password        l NOTE  The User Job Account menu appears Refer to    Login   Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on    entering characters     3 The User Job Account menu appears                    4 Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set     User Job Account         User Login Set   Unknown ID Job    Exit            5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears   Job Account Set    lt  m    Account List  Default Setting    Exit               6 Press the A or V key to select  Each Job Account         11 33    Manag
273. nu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  MP Tray Set       7 Press the OK key  The MP Tray Set  menu appears     8 Press the A or V key to select  MP Tray Size         2 52    Preparation before Use             9 Press the OK key  MP Tray Size appears   MP Tray Size  Sma OK      lol Letter l    Legal P  Statement P          10 Press the A or V key to select the desired paper size  and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  MP Tray Set  menu        11 Press the A or V key to select  MP Tray Type    MP Tray Set    lt 0    MP Tray Size    MP Tray Type      Exit               12 Press the OK key  MP Tray Type appears   MP Tray Type  Kad OK      Transparency  Rough          13 Press the A or V key to select the desired paper type  and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  MP Tray Set  menu        2 53    Preparation before Use       Loading Originals    Follow the steps below to load originals for copying  sending or storing     Placing Originals on the Platen    You may place books or magazines on the platen in addition to ordinary sheet originals        1 Open the document processor        NOTE  Before opening the document processor  be sure  that there are no originals left on the original table or on the  original eject table  Originals left on the original table or on  the original eject table may fall off when the document  processor is opened     Keep the document processor open if 
274. nvalid  go to Step 7     6 Select the checkbox beside Authentication  enter Login User Name  up to 64 characters  and Password  up to    64 characters  and then click OK     7 Click OK     T Authentication    Login user name    administrator    Password    I Account ID          8 The machine is registered to the PC and the machine name and model name are displayed in the Scanner List    field     Scanner List       Name         Model               About    Help    Delete             NOTE  Click Delete to delete the added machine  Click Edit to change names and other settings           2 25    Preparation before Use       Setting the WIA Driver  Windows Vista     Windows   Server 2008 and Windows 7     Register this machine to the WIA Driver        NOTE  The following is not necessary to register when using the machine possesses an IP address or host name  that you have specified during installation of WIA Driver        1 Click Start  Control Panel and then Scanners and Cameras  For Windows 7  in the search box  type scanners  and cameras  and then click Scanners and Cameras     2 Select the same name as this machine from WIA Drivers  and press Properties     If you do not see your device in the list  make sure it is connected to the computer and turned  on  then choose Refresh     Scanners and Cameras          Refresh       AddDevice      Scan Profiles    Do I need to use this to install my scanner or camera                    NOTE  If Windows Security and User Account Contro
275. o switch the display to other  information items  The items displayed are as follows     Status  status of job    Accepted Time   Job Name   Job Type   User Name   Page and Copy    number of pages and copies to be printed     Original Page  number of pages of the original  7  Sender Info     When complete job name not displayed in detailed information    When the job name in Job Name is displayed in a short form  press  Detail   the Right Select key  to see the complete  job name  Press the OK key to return to the original screen     The table below lists the items displayed in the Printing Jobs Status screen     Item   Key Detail    Acceptance No  of job       Icons that indicate the job type    Copy job    mPrinter job D    FAX reception  4   E mail reception   BJob from Document Box  Report   List A    mData from Removable Memory         Job Name Job Name or file name       Status Status of job   EB Printing   Il  Print Waiting   no icon  Pausing print job or error  Preferential print job is  running  Suspended because  preferential print job is  running                7 3    Status   Job Cancel       Send Job Status screen       Status  Sma OK    Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause                  Send Job Status   0                00101 E   0011   X  0017    E0324256345   Cancel     Menu   1 2 3 4  0011 Detail   0  Status  1 8  Processing             1 Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  appears     2 Press the A or V key to select  Send Job Status 
276. o use the multi purpose tray when you print on any special paper        IMPORTANT  When using media types other than plain paper  such as recycled or colored paper   always specify  the media type setting   Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2 51   If  you are using a paper weight of 106 g m  or more  set the media type to Thick        The capacity of the multi purpose tray is as follows     e A4 or smaller plain paper  80 g m    recycled paper or color paper  100 sheets  e Hagaki  1 sheet      OHP film  1 sheet   e Envelope  5 sheets       NOTE  When you load custom size paper  enter the paper size by referring to Specifying Paper Size and Media  Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2 51     When you use special paper such as transparencies or thick paper  select the media type by referring to Specifying  Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2 51        1 Pull the MP tray towards you until it stops                                               2 Pull out the extension                                                           3 Adjust the position of the paper width guides on the MP  ES tray  Standard paper sizes are marked on the MP tray    For standard paper sizes  slide the paper width guides to  the position marked correspondingly                                            2 45    Preparation before Use                         A 2 UL             Toit tT TT                                             
277. ocol  Host Name  LAN Interface  L7f Block  Set   Security Level  Restart  Op Functions  User Job User Login User Login  Account Serr  Local User List  IC Card Setting  Group Auth   NW User Property  Job Job Accounting    ACCOUN Sets       Account  Report       Total Accounting       Each Job Account       Account  List Detail Edit       Delete       Add Account             Default Apply Limit  Setting  Copy Print  Count       Counter Limit             Unknown ID Job             page 11 37     page 8 121     page 8 121     page 8 130     page 8 136       page 8 131     page 8 132      page 8 133     page 8 134     page 8 139     page 8 139     page 8 120     page 8 146     page 8 150     page 8 119     page 8 150     page 11 2      page 11 6      page 11 11     page 11 12     page 11 15      page 11 35     page 11 31      page 11 31     page 11 19     page 11 19     page 11 18     page 11 26     page 11 22        page 11 28    page 11 13       xi             System Menu   Counter key   Continued from  previous page      Continued on  next page     User Property          Common  Settings     Continued on  next page     Language       Default Screen       Sound    Buzzer       FAX Speaker       FAX Monitor       Display Bright        Orig  Paper  Set     Custom Orig Size       Def  Orig  Size       Custom PaperSize       Cassette 1 Set        Cassette 2 Set        Cassette 3 Set        Cassette 4 Set        MP Tray Set        Media Type Set        Media for Auto       Def  Paper
278. ode    For copying two originals onto a single sheet  This mode can be used with Duplex mode to copy four originals onto  one sheet        The following 2 in 1 options and output orientations are available     Original Orientation of Original    Platen Document processor                                                                                                                                                                                                                                           NOTE  When placing the original on the platen  be sure to copy the originals in page order           4 9    Copying Functions       4 in 1 Mode    For copying four originals onto a single sheet  This mode can be used with Duplex mode to copy eight originals onto  one sheet     The following 4 in 1 options and output orientations are available     Original Orientation of Original    Platen Document processor                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   NOTE  When placing the original on the platen  be sure to copy the originals in page order           4 10    Copying Functions       Types of Page Boundary Lines    The following types of the boundary lines are available                                                                                                         
279. ok  Wm Book key  The Select Addr Book menu appears     LHaddress Book    MlExt Address Book               Exit    A 2 Pressthe A or V key to select  Address Book  and then  Address Book   lt 0 press the OK key  Address Book appears     To use an address book on the LDAP server  select  Ext                      Fiala  Address Book     amp  Maury    Menu    NOTE  If extended address book is not registered   Select  Addr Book  is not displayed   3 Press the A or V key to select the desired user or group   and then press the OK key   If you select a user  the list of destinations registered to   amp  Fiala  pata OK   the user appears   Mfiala    HHHHHHee   If you select a group  proceed to step 5    BSMB PC    Menu               4 Press the A or V key to select the desired destination  and then press the OK key     5 Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen     Destination Search  Destinations registered in the Address Book can be searched     The procedures for using the different search modes are explained below        3 26    Basic Operation       Search in Address Book       1 In Address Book  press  Menu   the Right Select key    Address Book  Kad OK Menu appears    amp  Fiala     amp  Maury      Menu            R 2 Pressthe A or V key to select  Search Name   and then  Menu   lt 0 press the OK key  A search screen appears   Detail    Search  Name           Search  Name         Sit OK    mall    3 Enter the characters you want to search       Text 
280. oles or perforations will  be scanned last  not first            2 56    3 Basic Operation    This chapter explains the following operations     MOGI LOGOUT acecee os cet aaah ie dee alak ee oes ae 3 2  One Touch Keys and Program Keys    3 3  Message Display   tan idee tiie ete 3 6  CODY ING aie E thc A E E E ene aesenereoxe 3 7  Printing   Printing from Applications              cece 3 16  Sendinga em eaae e aE a E aaa 3 18  Confirm Destination Screen    n    3 25  Specifying Destination                  ccccceecteeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeees 3 26  Canceling JODS             cc ccccccisceecccccceteseeeseneeeteeteeeeeentens 3 29  Checking Remaining Toner and Papet                  6 3 30       3 1    Basic Operation       Login Logout    If user login administration is enabled  it is necessary to enter the login user name and password to use the machine        NOTE  You will be unable to log in if you forget your login user name or login password  In this event  log in with  administrator privileges and change your login user name or login password        Login       NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters             1 Ifthe screen shown appears during operations  enter the  Login User Name   0 login user name     Login Password       Login               2 Press the V key  The input cursor moves to Login  Password     3 Enter the login password     Press the A key to move the input cursor to Login User  Name     4 Check the login user na
281. on         Press the OK key  Scan Resolution appears   Scan Resolution   m    200x400dpi S Fin   04  300x300dpi  400x400dpi U Fin             7 Press the A or V key to select  200x100dpi Norm      200x200dpi Fine    200x400dpi S Fin    300x300dpi     400x400dpi U Fin  or  600x600dpi      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu        8 43    Default Setting  System Menu        Original Image    Set the default original document type  The available default settings are shown below     Item Description    Text Photo Text and photos together        Photo For photos taken with a camera        Text Only text  no photos        for OCR Image quality suitable for OCR software           Use the procedure below to select the default quality setting for originals        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default   gt m    01I  Color Selection  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Original Image    6 Press the OK key  Original Image appears   Original Image  Km OK    Photo  Text             7 Press 
282. on  A function to automatically select paper in the same size as original at printing  Auto Sleep Mode    A mode designed for electrical power saving  activated when the machine is left unused or data transfer for a specific  period  In Sleep mode  power consumption is kept to a minimum     Bonjour    Bonjour  also known as zero configuration networking  is a service that automatically detects computers  devices and  services on an IP network  Bonjour  because an industry standard IP protocol is used  allows devices to automatically  recognize each other without an IP address being specified or DNS server being set  Bonjour also sends and  receives network packets by UDP port 5353  If a firewall is enabled  the user must check that UDP port 5353 is left  open so that Bonjour will run correctly  Some firewalls are set up so as to reject only certain Bonjour packets  If  Bonjour does not run stably  check the firewall settings and ensure that Bonjour is registered on the exceptions list  and that Bonjour packets are accepted  If you install Bonjour on Windows XP Service Pack 2 or later  the Windows  firewall will be set up correctly for Bonjour     Default Gateway    This indicates the device  such as a computer or router  that serves as the entrance exit  gateway  for accessing  computers outside the network that you are on  When no specific gateway is designated for a destination IP address   data is sent to the host designated as the Default Gateway     DHCP  Dynamic Host Co
283. on Default menu        8 49    Default Setting  System Menu        File Name Entry    Set an automatically entered name  default  for jobs  Additional information such as Date and Time and Job No  can  also be set     The table below lists the additional information available     Item Description    None No additional information available        Date Adds date and time        Job No  Adds the job number        Job No    Date Adds the job number plus date and time        Date   Job No  Adds date and time plus the job number              NOTE   e Refer to page 4 16 and page 5 17 for name entry   e Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        Use the procedure below to set the default file name        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings     gt i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  File Name Entry         8 50    Default Setting  System Menu        Subject Body          File name Entry   0  doc iff    ABC    Text                  Additional Info    gt m  Job No    04   Job No  Date  Date Job No     
284. on is to the other flexible key  you cannot set it and This function is  already registered  already registered  is displayed              8 92    Default Setting  System Menu        Printing Reports Sending Notice    Print reports to check the machine settings and status  Default settings for printing the result reports can also be  configured        NOTE  If user login administration is enabled  you can only print by logging in with administrator privileges        Printing Reports    Printable reports are as follows     Menu map    Outputs a menu map of this machine               Menu Map  MFP    Firmware Version                Status Page  Check the information including current settings  available memory space  and optional equipment installed     Status Page  MFP    Firmware Version             8 93    Default Setting  System Menu        Font List    Check the font samples installed in the machine              Scalable Bitmap Selection  FSET  Font                                  PT CTT onl TTT nnn  onan  ann  onan  onan   Font Name Scalable Bitmap Passwort d Selection  FSET  Font ID LLLI  TTT TTT anal TTT TTT nan  TTL TTL anal PTET CELD ann  PTTL LL PTTL onal LEEDI au  ED CELLED LELI LELLI n  on PTT anal LELLI  TLE TTT anal TT  TTT OnnnnaE anal ELD  PULL Onnn0nE aul PTT TE  PTC PT anal PTTL LLL ED  ELL PELL anal                Use the procedure below to print a Menu Map   Status Page   Font List        A 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu 
285. ons  The default setting is Auto     Item Description    Sets the paper feed direction automatically        Sets the paper feed direction the same as  in the previous printing operation           Use the procedure below to set Paper Feed Mode        A 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  Printer      Common Settings  Copy  Printer      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Printer menu appears   Printer   lt  gt  m    EcoPrint  Override A4 LTR    Exit               3 Press the A or V key to select  Paper Feed Mode         8 84    Default Setting  System Menu              4 Press the OK key  Paper Feed Mode appears   Paper Feed Mode   lt       Fixed          5 Press the A or V key to select  Auto  or  Fixed      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Printer menu           8 85    Default Setting  System Menu        Sending Settings  The sending settings allow you to specify the following sending function options     e Select Key Set    8 86  e Document Box Settings    8 88       NOTE  If user login administration is enabled  you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator  privileges        Select Key Set    If you register a function to the Left Select key or Right Select key  you can quickly set the function when using  sending functions     You can register one of the following functions to each key     e None   e Color Selection   e Original Size   e Original Image    
286. ontent 9        Grain direction Long grain  paper supply direction           Pulp content 80  or more          NOTE  Some recycled paper does not meet requirements for use with this machine as listed in the Basic Paper eS  Specifications shown below  such as moisture or pulp content  For this reason  we recommend purchasing a small   amount of recycled paper as a sample for testing prior to use  Choose recycled paper that gives the best printing   results and contains low levels of paper dust        We are not responsible for the problems occurred from the use of paper that does not conform to our specifications        Appendix 11       Choosing the Appropriate Paper  This section describes guidelines for choosing paper     Condition    Avoid using paper with bent corners or that is curled  dirty  or torn  Do not use paper that has a rough surface or paper  fiber lint  or that is especially delicate  Use of paper in any of these conditions will not only deliver poor copies but may  also cause jams and shorten the useful life of the machine  Choose paper with a smooth and even surface  however   avoid coated paper or paper with a treated surface as it may damage the drum or fusing unit     Ingredient    Do not use paper such as paper that has been coated or surface treated or paper that contains plastic or carbon   These paper may produce harmful fumes from the heat of printing and may damage the drum     Be sure to use the standard paper that contains at least 80  pulp  i e  
287. opying    Produce two sided copies  The following duplex options are available     You can also create single sided copies from two sided originals or originals with facing pages such as books  The    following modes are available     One sided to Two sided                                                             Two sided to Two sided                            Original       Produces two sided copies from one sided originals  In case  of an odd number of originals  the back side of the last copy  will be blank     The following binding options are available     A Binding Left Right  Images on the second sides are not  rotated     B Binding Top  Images on the second sides are rotated  180    Copies can be bound on the top edge  facing the  same orientation when turning the pages     Copies each side of a two sided original onto two individual  sheets     The following binding options are available     e Binding Left Right  Images on the second sides are not  rotated      Binding Top  Images on the second sides are rotated  180       Produces two sided copies from two sided originals        NOTE  The paper sizes supported in Two sided to Two   sided are Legal  Letter  Oficio Il  Executive  A4  B5  A5 and  Folio           3 12    Basic Operation       The procedure for using two sided duplex copying is explained below        1 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  pata OK      Paper Selection DO    Collate O    Duplex o    Exit      2 Press the
288. or V key to select   HA Left Right  or      Top      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Detail Setting menu     Select the default value for image quality when File Format is selected  Select the default value in the range from  1  Low High Comp    high compression  to  5 High Low Comp    low compression      Use the procedure below to select the default value for image quality        Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account      Exit               Common Settings  i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit            1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         8 63    Default Setting  System Menu           4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Detail Setting         6 Press the OK key  The Detail Setting menu appears   Detail Setting   m    ol  2 in 1 layout  4 in 1 Layout  Border Line                  Exit    7 Press the A or V key to select  Image Quality    8 Press the OK key  Image Quality appears   Image Quality  Sma OK    01  1 Low High Comp   2  3             9 Press the A or V key to select from  1 Low High Comp    to  5 High Low Comp       10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Detail Setting menu     Color TIF
289. or V key to select the user you want to  delete  and then press  Menu   the Right Select key      2 Press the A or V key to select  Delete  and then press  the OK key        11 10    Management       3 Inthe delete confirmation screen  press  Yes   the Left  Select key   The user is deleted and the screen returns  to Local User List     Enabling Disabling Group Authentication    This enables group authentication using the LDAP server  This menu can be used only when  Netwk Authentic   is  selected as the user authentication method  For details of LDAP server settings  refer to the Operation Guide of the  LDAP server     Use the procedure below to enable group authentication        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2          2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account    Sys  Menu Count   9    04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and 1 1  ri  press  Login   the Right Select key         Login Password       Login               The User Job Account menu appears        Press the A or V key to select  User Login Set     User Job Account  0m    Job Account  Set   Unknown ID Job    Exit            5 Press the OK key  The User Login Set  menu appears   User
290. or copy   print  transmission and document box        Clears entered numbers and characters     Resets settings and displays the  basic screen     Selects the chosen item or finalizes the entered    Puts the machine to sleep or  wakes it up     Lit when the machine s  main power is on               Function Menu    a Back    Memory Attention          Clear Reset Program    Power      3  a I  ID Card Copy                            Symbols  gt    4                          Numeric keys  Enter  numbers and symbols     Returns the Message Display to the    previous screen     Lights or blinks when an error occurs     Blinks while the machine is accessing the memory        Ends operation   logs out  on the  Administration screen     Used to register or recall  programs     Cancels the printing job in progress     Starts copying and scanning operations and processing for  setting operations        Part Names       Machine    1  2  3  4  5  6  7  8    9                                                                                                                                                 Platen   Slit Glass   Operation Panel   Top Cover   Front Cover   Toner Container Lock Lever  Toner Container   Developer Unit   USB Memory Slot    10 Paper Guage    11 Duplexer Front Cover                                                    Part Names                                                                      jp  19  _     19                          H I     Ca ql  x ee ES a A J  a
291. ord with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      2 The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  IPSec         8 139    Default Setting  System Menu           6 Press the OK key  IPSec appears                 IPSec   gt     On  7 Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off    7 If you select  On  and press the OK key  Rule Setting  Rule Setting   gt  0 appears  Press the A or V key to select  On  or  Off    On             8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Network Setting menu     SSL Setting    This allows you to use SSL network security for communication  You can use SSL Setup to select whether or not SSL  is used and to specify the IPP port and HTTP port security settings     SSL  Make this setting Make this setting when you use SSL  The default setting is Off     Use the procedure below to make the setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    M select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit              A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name     password with administrator privileges to log in  and    be ee ee EL lei press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            2 The System menu appears   System   gt  oK    I F Block Set   
292. orming user management and have       user ID and password to log in   Login Password        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for    Login   details on entering characters              2 The Sys  Menu Count  menu appears   Sys  Menu Count    gt 00    Counter  System    Exit                  8 2    Default Setting  System Menu        Switching the Language for Display  Language     You can select the language of the message display by following the procedure given below  You can optionally  download messages in other languages  Contact your service technician for information        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   gt i                   3 Press the A or V key to select  Language    Default Screen  Sound    Exit    4 Press the OK key  The Language menu appears  Gq   Language  bmg OK    The available languages are as follows   DALACH English  Fran  ais Deutsch   Fran  ais   Espa  ol   Italiano   Nederlands   Pycckn     Portugu  s    The optional languages are as follows     Optional language Message display    Turkish T  rk  e       Greek EAAnvika       Polish Polski       Czech Cesky       Hungarian Magyar       Finnish Suomi       Hebrew       Arabic       Swedish Svensk       Danish Dansk       Norwegian Norsk       Romanian Roman             8 3
293. otocol   lt    m    IPP Security  HTTP Security    LDAP Security      Exit               7 Press the A or V key to select  LDAP Security         8 144    Default Setting  System Menu           8 Press the OK key  LDAP Security appears     LDAP Security    O  lol O  L    LDAPv3 TLS  LDAP over SSL                9 Press the A or V key to select  Off    LDAPv3 TLS  or   LDAP over SSL      10 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Secure Protocol menu     SNMPvVv3 Setting  Sets up SNMPv3  The default setting is Off  Use the procedure below     Refer to Protocol Detail on page 8 136 about the procedures           8 145    Default Setting  System Menu        Interface Block Setting    This allows you to protect this machine by blocking the interface with external devices such as USB hosts or optional  interfaces     The following interface block settings are available     e USB Host  USB memory slot setting   e USB Device  USB interface setting   e Optional interface  Optional interface card setting     USB Host  USB memory slot setting   This locks and protects the USB memory slot  A1  or USB port  A2   USB host   The default setting is Unblock     Use the procedure below to specify the USB Host setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit              A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Na
294. ough Windows Firewall       System  View amount of RAM and processor speed   Check the Windows Experience Index    Allow remote access   See the name of this computer     Device Manager    Windows Update    Turn automatic updating on or off   Check for updates   View installed updates    Power Options  Require a password when the computer wakes  Change when the computer sleeps    Change what the power buttons       Backup and Restore    Back up your computer   Restore files from backup    Ritl arkar Driva Fnenmtinn    1 From the Start menu  select Control Panel  System  and Security  and Allow a program through Windows  Firewall           NOTE  If the User Account Control dialog box appears  click the Continue button                 eid        Windows Firewall    Allowed Programs    Search Con       Allow programs to communicate through Windows Firewall    To add  change  or remove allowed programs and ports  click Change settings     What are the risks of allowing a program to communicate     Allowed programs and features     Name    C BranchCache   Content Retrieval  Uses HTTP     O BranchCache   Hosted Cache Client  Uses HTTPS   O BranchCache   Hosted Cache Server  Uses HTTPS    O BranchCache   Peer Discovery  Uses WSD     O Connect to a Network Projector       ore Networking          Public      o o  o o  o o     o  o o    Home Work  Private     m          le and Printer Sharing         OISCSI Service   O Media Center Extenders  C Netlogon Service    Adding a port    o  o
295. owing the procedure used to install the printer driver  click Remove Software  The Kyocera Uninstaller wizard    appears     4 Select the software package to remove        2 23    Preparation before Use       5 Click Uninstall        NOTE  When KMnet Viewer is installed  separate uninstallers are launched for this application  Proceed with the  uninstallation steps for this application as directed by the on screen instructions        The uninstaller starts   6 When Uninstall complete screen appears  click Finish     7 If Restart Your System screen appears  select whether you restart your computer or not  and click Finish        NOTE  The software can be uninstalled from the Start menu     Start the uninstaller by clicking start  gt  All Programs  gt  Kyocera  gt  Uninstall Kyocera Product Library  and uninstall  the software        Setting TWAIN Driver  Register this machine to the TWAIN Driver   1 Start the TWAIN Driver by clicking start  gt  All Programs  gt  Kyocera  gt  TWAIN Driver Setting     2 Click Add     Scanner List          Name                   Scanner Address       Image Compression Color     Yes C No  Compression Level    re    Low    Image Compression Gray   Monochrome   Compression Level    E    Low      Inch C Metric    User Authentication Settings    Help Cancel                2 24    Preparation before Use       4 Click W next to the Model field and select this machine from the list     Click User Authentication Settings  If user login administration is i
296. p     Leave the main power switch on and to remove the jammed paper refer to the following information below     Jam Location Indicators    If a paper jam occurs  the error message displays the location of the jam     Paper Jam Location Reference Page    Document processor       Inside the machine       MP Tray       Cassettes       Duplexer       Rear unit          Precautions with Paper Jams    If a paper jam occurs  a message will be displayed about the jam and copying or printing will stop          Do not reuse jammed papers  1 0     Ifthe paper tears during removal  be sure to remove any loose scraps of paper from inside the machine  Scraps  of paper left in the machine could cause subsequent jamming       A page affected by a paper jam will be printed again        CAUTION  The fixing unit is extremely hot  Take sufficient care when working in this area  as there is a danger of  getting burned        Online Help Messages  When Paper Jam is displayed  press  Help  the Left Select key  to display the procedure to clear the jam   Press V to display the next step or press A to display the previous step     Press the OK key to exit the online help message display        10 13    Troubleshooting       MP Tray    Follow the steps below to clear paper jams in the MP tray        1 Remove the paper jammed at the MP tray                                   2 Openand close the top cover and front cover to clear the  error     Cassette Paper Feeder  Follow the steps below to clear pape
297. page by page  and send the files     Use the procedure below to split scanned original data into separate files when sending scanned originals        Function Menu  paid OK    Original Size Oo  Original Image O     Exit                  File Separation  0m  lol OfE    Each Page             1  2    Press the Send key     Place the originals in the document processor or on the  platen     Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  File Separation      Press the OK key  File Separation appears     Press the A or V key to select  Each Page  and then  press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending  The scanned original is sent after being divided  into files of one page each        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 24    Sending Functions       Scanning Image using Application    Be sure that you connect your PC with the machine using the USB cable and install the Kyocera TWAIN or WIA  Driver  The scan can be carried out from any TWAIN or WIA compatible application program  For details of installation  for TWAIN or WIA driver  refer to Quick Installation Guide        IMPORTANT  When scanning a document from a TWAIN or WIA compatible application  set Auto Sleep to  Off   For  this setting  refer to Auto Sleep ON OFF on page 8 34        The following procedure is a
298. pendix 4       Character Entry Method    In character entry screens  use the procedure below to enter characters     Keys Used    Use the following keys to enter characters     1 2 6       DEF Clear refer       ABC  Function Menu            2  3   4     GHI JKL MNO     4   5   6    PQRS TUV WXYZ  a A                                    7 3 4  1  OK Key Press this key to finalize the entered character s    2  Clear Key Press this key to delete the character at the cursor position  If the cursor is at the end of the    line  the character to the left of it is deleted   3  Back Key Press this key to return to the screen from which you invoked the character entry screen   4  Cursor Keys Use these to select the entry position  or select a character from the character list     5  Numeric Keys Use these keys to select the character you want to enter   6  Reset Key Press this key to cancel the character entry procedure and return to the standby screen     7  Right Select Key Press this key to select the type of characters you want to enter   When  Text  is displayed        Appendix 5       Selecting Type of Characters  To enter characters  the following three types are available     ABC To enter alphabets   123 To enter numerals   Symbols To enter symbols        In a character entry screen  press  Text   the Right  File name input  Select key  to select the type of characters you want to  Report3f enter    123                Current character type       Each time you press  Text   the
299. per Weight    Front Cassette    60 to 120 g m   Duplex  60 to 120 g m         MP Tray    60 to 220 g m        Paper Type    Front Cassette    Plain  Rough  Recycled  Preprinted  Bond  Color  Colour   Prepunched   Letterhead  High Quality  Custom 1 to 8  Duplex  Same as Simplex        MP Tray    Plain  Transparency  OHP film   Rough  Vellum  Labels  Recycled   Preprinted  Bond  Cardstock  Color  Colour   Prepunched  Letterhead  Thick   Envelope  High Quality  Custom 1 to 8       Paper Size    Front Cassette    Maximum  8 1 2 x 14  A4  Duplex  8 1 2 x 14  A4   Minimum  5 1 2 x 8 1 2  A6  Duplex  7 1 4 x 10 1 2  A5           MP Tray    Maximum  8 1 2 x 14  A4  Minimum  3 5 8 x 6 1 2  A6       Zoom Level    Manual mode  25 to 400   1  increments  Fixed magnifications   400   200   141   129   115   90   86   78   70   64   50   25        Printing  Speed    Simplex    A4R LetterR  40 42 sheets min  B5R  33 sheets min    Legal  33 sheets min  A5R A6R  22 sheets min          Duplex    A4R LetterR  24 5 26 sheets min Legal  16 5 sheets min  BSR  24 sheets min ASR  21 sheets min       First Print Time     A4  feed from Cassette     9 5 seconds or less       Warm up    Power on    22 seconds or less       Time   22  C     Low Power    10 seconds or less       71 6  F 60      Sleep    15 seconds or less       Paper    Front Cassette    500 sheets  80 g m         Capacity       MP Tray    100 sheets  80 g m   plain paper  A4 Letter or less        Output Tray Capacity    500 sheets  80 g 
300. permission from the network administrator        Use the procedure below to setup the TCP IP  IPv4  setting         1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count       select  System   and press the OK key    Report  Counter    System      Exit              A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name  0m password with administrator privileges to log in  and    a press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            2 The System menu appears   System   gt  oK    I F Block Set   Security Level    Exit                  8 121    Default Setting  System Menu              Network Setting  0m  NetWare  AppleTalk     Exit                  TCP IP Settings  0m  IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting                  Exit    TCP IP    m  Off  023    On             TCP IP Settings  i  TCP IP  IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting    Exit               IPv4 Setting  Kma ox    Bonjour  IP Address     Exit            Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP Settings      6 Press the OK key  The TCP IP Settings menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP      8 Press the OK key  TCP IP appears     9 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  TCP IP Settings menu     10 Press the A or V key to select  IPv4 Setting      11 Press the OK ke
301. plex  50 to 110 g m        Loading Capacity 50 sheets  50 to 80 g m   maximum          Environmental Specifications                      Time to Low Power mode  default 2 minutes   setting    Time to Sleep mode  default setting  15 minutes   Recovery time from Low Power mode 10 seconds or less   Recovery time from Sleep mode 15 seconds or less   Duplexing Standard   Paper supply capability 100  recycled paper may be used              NOTE  Consult your dealer or service representative for recommended paper types        EN ISO 7779    Der h  chste Schalldruckpegel betr  gt 70 dB  A  oder weniger gem     EN ISO 7779     EK1 ITB 2000    Das Ger  t ist nicht fur die Benutzung im unmittelbaren Gesichtsfeld am Bildschirmarbeitsplatz vorgesehen  Um  st  rende Reflexionen am Bildschirmarbeitsplatz zu vermeiden  darf dieses Produkt nicht im unmittelbaren  Gesichtsfeld platziert werden        Appendix 21       Glossary    AppleTalk    AppleTalk  which comes with Apple Computer s Mac OS  is a network protocol  AppleTalk enables file printer sharing  and also enables you to utilize application software that is on another computer on the same AppleTalk network     Auto Form Feed Timeout    During data transmission  the machine may sometimes have to wait until receiving the next data  This is the auto form  feed timeout  When the preset timeout passes  the machine automatically put paper out  However  no output is  performed if the last page has no data to be printed     Auto Paper Selecti
302. plication  page 8 150  is running  the  f you change Date   Time setting  trial functions will be unavailable  Are you  sure  message is displayed  To change the date time  press   Yes  the Left Select key            8 28    Default Setting  System Menu        Date Format  Select the display format of year  month  and date  The year is displayed in Western notation     Use the procedure below to select the date format        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings  M     o1  Language    Default Screen                Sound    Exit    3 Press the A or V key to select  Date Setting   and press GE  the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and  EEEE FEL press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            4 The Date Settings menu appears   Date Setting   gt  0m    Date Time  Date Format  Time Zone                  Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Date Format   Press the OK key  Date Format appears   Date Format  paid OK    Month Day Year  0    Day Month  Year  Year  Month Day    Exit               7 Press the A or V key to select  Month Day Year    Day   Month Year  or  Year Month Day      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen
303. prietary notices as those appearing on the original     This License shall continue until the last use of the Software and Typefaces  unless sooner terminated  This  License may be terminated by Monotype Imaging if you fail to comply with the terms of this License and such  failure is not remedied within thirty  30  days after notice from Monotype Imaging  When this License expires or  is terminated  you shall either return to Monotype Imaging or destroy all copies of the Software and Typefaces  and documentation as requested     You agree that you will not modify  alter  disassemble  decrypt  reverse engineer or decompile the Software     Monotype Imaging warrants that for ninety  90  days after delivery  the Software will perform in accordance with  Monotype Imaging published specifications  and the diskette will be free from defects in material and  workmanship  Monotype Imaging does not warrant that the Software is free from all bugs  errors and  omissions     The parties agree that all other warranties  expressed or implied  including warranties of fitness for a particular  purpose and merchantability  are excluded     Your exclusive remedy and the sole liability of Monotype Imaging in connection with the Software and  Typefaces is repair or replacement of defective parts  upon their return to Monotype Imaging     In no event will Monotype Imaging be liable for lost profits  lost data  or any other incidental or consequential  damages  or any damages caused by abuse or m
304. ption 7 18  Sending the Job Log History 7 13  Job Accounting 11 15  Managing the Copier Printer Counts 11 22  Restricting the Use of the Machine 11 23  Job Box 8 88  Job Retention Deletion 8 89  Quick Copy Jobs 8 88  Job Finish Notice 5 21  Copy 4 14  Send 5 21    K       KPDL Appendix 23    L       Label Appendix 16   LAN Cable  Connecting 2 5   Left cover 1 6   Legal Information xxii   LINE connector 1 6   Login 3 2  11 5   Logout 3 2  11 5   Low Power Mode 2 8   Low Power Timer 8 39       Main power switch 1 6  Management 11 1  Job Accounting 11 15  User Login Administration 11 2  Monotype Imaging License Agreement xxv  Multi Purpose  MP  Tray Appendix 23  Paper Size and Media 2 51  8 14  Multi purpose tray  MP tray  1 5  Multi Sending  Sending to Different Types of    NetBEUI Appendix 23  NetWare 8 131  Appendix 23  Setup 8 131  Network  Setup 2 14  Network Cable 2 4  Connecting 2 5  Network Interface 2 4  Network interface connector indicators 1 6  Network Security 8 139  Network Setup  FTP  Reception  8 136  HTTP 8 136  HTTPS 8 136  IPP over SSL 8 137  LAN Interface 8 120  LDAP 8 136  LPD 8 136  NetBEUI 8 136  NetWare 8 131  POP3  E mail RX  8 136  Raw Port 8 136  SMTP  E mail TX  8 136  SNMP 8 136  TCP IP  IPv4  8 121  TCP IP  IPv6  8 130  8 133  8 134    O       Open SSLeay xxiii  Operation Panel 1 2  Operation panel 1 4  Option  Expansion Memory Appendix 2  Overview Appendix 2  Paper Feeder Appendix 2  Optional Functions 8 150  Original  Loading in the Document  Proc
305. queue of  0008  amp Copy lI the selected job type is displayed     0009   maury s data H  0010   Microsoftwor   Il    Resume     Menu            3 Press the A or V key to select the job you want to stop     Menu   lt 0 and then press  Menu   the Right Select key   Menu  appears     Cancel Job          4 Press the A or V key to select  Cancel Job  and then  Job will be canceled  press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears    Are you sure      0008 copy      Yes   I No               5 Press  Yes   the Right Select key   The screen displays  Canceling     and returns to the output queue of the  selected job type after the job is canceled     To cancel other jobs  repeat steps 3 to 5        3 29    Basic Operation       Checking Remaining Toner and Paper    You can check the remaining amount of toner and that of paper in each feeder cassette     Checking Remaining Toner          Status  Sma OK    Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause                  Toner Status  OK     os PRETQOUUU0 1002          Checking Remaining Paper          Status  Sma OK    Send Job Status  Store Job Status    Pause                  Paper Status   0  Cassette 1  1  4  Letter F Empty  Plain          Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  appears     Press the A or V key to select  Toner Status    Press the OK key  Toner Status appears     The remaining amount of toner is displayed in one of 10  levels     Press the Status Job Cancel key  The Status menu  appears     Press the A or V ke
306. r     Detail    Limits the number of sheets used for copying        Print Restriction     Printer     Limits the number of sheets used for printing        Scan Restriction     Others     Limits the number of sheets scanned  excludes  copying and sending fax         Fax TX  Restriction          Limits the number of sheets sent by fax   For FS   3140MFP  only        Total  selected for Copier Printer Count    Print Restriction    Detail    Limits the total number of sheets used for copying  and printing        Scan Restriction     Others     Limits the number of sheets scanned  excludes  copying         Fax TX  Restriction    Applying Restriction       Limits the number of sheets sent by fax   For FS   3140MFP  only        Restriction can be applied in two modes as follows     Off    Description    No restriction given       Counter Limit    Restricts the print counter in one page increments  up to 9 999 999 copies        Reject Usage       Restriction is applied        Use the procedure below to select a restriction method     1 Follow steps 1 to 7 of Managing Accounts on page 11   18         eRD Center       Account  List   SUI R amp D DEP      amp eCUI Design         Menu        2 In Account  List  press the A or V key to select the   gt  0 account to which you want to set restriction of use  and  then press the OK key              11 24    Management                      Detail   lt      Print Restrict   4 6  Total  Off     Edit    Detail   lt      Print Restrict   4 7  Cop
307. r jams in cassette or paper feeder   1 Pull out the cassette or optional paper feeder     2 Remove any partially fed paper        NOTE  Check to see if paper is loaded correctly  If not   reload the paper           3 Push the cassette back in securely  The printer warms  up and resumes printing        10 14    Troubleshooting       Duplexer  Paper is jammed in the duplexer  Remove the jammed paper using the procedure given below       CAUTION  Do not touch parts in this area  because    _ a1   Ce A it may result in burn injury   SSS                                                                1 Pull the cassette all the way out of the printer     o    2 Open the duplexer s cover and remove any jammed       paper     AD  WL                                                                   3 Push the cassette back in securely  The machine warms  up and resumes printing     Inside the Machine    Follow the steps below to clear paper jams inside the machine  1 Open the top cover and front cover                             10 15    Troubleshooting                                                                                                                                     2 Lift the developer unit together with the toner container  out of the machine     3 Open the feed cover     4 Remove the paper from the machine    If the jammed paper appears to be pinched by rollers   pull it along the normal running direction of the paper                                                
308. r login administration        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter    2    Sys  Menu Count    gt 00          2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account      04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit    A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name    password with administrator privileges to log in  and  ET press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login               The User Job Account menu appears        Press the A or V key to select  User Login Set      User Job Account  0   User Login Set  1 1  Job Account  Set     Unknown ID Job    Exit            5 Press the OK key  The User Login Set  menu appears   User Login Set    gt m    Local User List  Group Auth     Exit               6 Press the A or V key to select  User Login         7 Press the OK key  User Login appears   User Login   gt  oK    o ofFf  Local Authentic   Netwk Authentic              8 Press the A or V key to select  Local Authentic   or   Netwk Authentic    and then press the OK key        Management             Server Type   NTLM  0J  Kerberos  03 Ext      lt  gt  wi                Host Name          ABC  Text               Select  Off  to disable user login administration     When  Network Authentication  is selected  select   NTLM    Kerberos   or  Ext   for the server
309. r the machine   s IP address   E g   http   192 168 48 21     The web page displays basic information about the machine and COMMAND CENTER as well as their current  status        kyocera COMMAND CENTE       Start Basic Printer Scanner    Select a category from the navigation bar on the left of the screen  The values for each category must be set  separately     Enter the correct password to access pages other than the startup page  The default setting is adminOO  The  password can be changed     For details  refer to the KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation Guide        2 28    Preparation before Use       Sending E mail  Specifying the SMTP settings allows you to send images loaded onto this machine as E mail attachments     To use this function  this machine must be connected to a mail server using the SMTP protocol     Before sending images loaded onto this machine as E mail attachments  check the following        The network environment used to connect this machine to the mail server  A full time connection via a LAN is recommended   e SMTP Settings  Use COMMAND CENTER to register the IP address or host name of the SMTP server      If limits have been set on the size of E mail messages  it may not be possible to send very large E mails     Sender address    The procedure for specifying the SMTP settings is explained below     1 Click Advanced   gt  SMTP   gt  General     kyocera COMMAND CENTER    Start Basic Printer Scanner FAX j i FAX Jobs Document Box    Ez ae    gt   e    
310. racter Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        9 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     10 Press the Start key to start copying  Upon completion of  the job  an E mail notice is sent to the selected  destination        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 15    Copying Functions       File Name Entry    Names a copy job  Add other information such as date and time or job number as necessary  You can check a job  history or job status using the job name  date and time  or job number specified here     Use the procedure below to assign a name to your copy job   1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     Function Menu  paid OK    Collate m  Duplex o     Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  File Name Entry           5 Press the OK key  File Name Entry appears   File Name Entry   0    do cil    ABC    Text               6 Enter the file name  press the OK key  Additional Info   appears        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        7 Enter the date  job number  etc  on the screen  and then  press the OK key        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     8 Press the 
311. ray  Select size and media type for multi purpose tray  Set up frequently used size and media type before use     The available paper sizes and media types are shown in the table below     Item Description    Letter  Legal  Statement  Executive  Oficio Il  A4  A5  A6   B5  B6  Folio  16K  ISO B5  Envelope  10  Envelope  9   Envelope  6  Envelope Monarch  Envelope DL  Envelope  C5  Hagaki  Oufuku Hagaki  Youkei 4  Youkei 2  Custom        Plain  105 g m  or less   Transparency  Rough  Vellum   64 g m  or less   Labels  Recycled  Preprinted    Bond   Cardstock  Color  Prepunched    Letterhead    Envelope   Thick  106 g m  and more   High Quality  Custom 1 8              Refer to Adding a Custom Size and Media Type for Paper to Print on  page 8 10 for selecting Custom Paper Size    ne Refer to Paper Weight on page 8 16 for selecting Custom 1  8 from  Media Type   To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead  refer to  Special Paper Action on page 8 21        NOTE  To change to a media type other than Plain  refer to Paper Weight on page 8 16       Use the procedure below to select the paper size and media type for manual paper feed        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   S0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings     gt i    01  Language  Default Screen  Sound            Exit         Press the A or
312. reen returns to the Document Box menu        6 8    Document Box       Printing from a Job Box    When optional memory is installed and RAM Disk Mode is enabled  you can use a Job Box to print    Job Box is a function that stores print data on the set RAM disk in the machine  enabling the data to be printed as  needed from the operation panel of the machine   If an ID  4 digit number  is set when printing is executed from the computer  the data can be kept more confidential   When an ID is set  the ID must be entered in order to print the stored data from the machine  For the RAM disk  settings  see RAM Disk Mode on page 8 67     Private Print    Private Print is used to allow printing only after the same 4 digit ID that was entered in the printer driver at the time of  printing is entered at the operation panel  The data is erased after printing     For information on Private Print  see Help in the printer driver     The procedure for printing stored data is explained below           Document Box  bmg OK    Sub Address Box  Polling Box    Job Box                Job Box  Sma ok     Quick Copy                            Private   gt  0   amp  Maury    amp  Fiala  Said OK    fAData02 oO  fAData03 o    Menu     Select            1 Press the Document Box key  The Document Box menu  appears     2 Pressthe A or V key to select  Job Box      3 Press the OK key  The Job Box menu appears     4 Press the A or V key to select  Private      Press the OK key  The user selection menu appea
313. remaining paper after loading in the multi   purpose tray or cassettes back in the paper storage bag     If the machine will not be used for a prolonged period   protect all paper from humidity by removing it from the    cassettes and sealing it in the paper storage bag        NOTE  If you use special paper such as letterhead  paper    with holes or paper with pre prints like logo or company  name  refer to Paper on Appendix 9           2 41    Preparation before Use       Loading Paper in the Cassettes    The standard cassette will each hold plain paper  recycled paper or color paper   The standard cassette holds up to 500 sheets of A4 or smaller plain paper  80 g m      The following paper sizes are supported  Legal  Oficio Il  Letter  Executive  Statement  A4  B5  A5  A6  Folio  and 16K        IMPORTANT     e You should not use inkjet printer paper or any paper with a special surface coating   Such papers may cause  paper jams or other faults     e When using media types other than plain paper  such as recycled or colored paper   always specify the media  type setting   Refer to Specifying Paper Size and Media Type for the Cassettes on page 2 49   The cassettes can hold paper with weights up to 120 g m     e Do not load thick paper that is heavier than 120 g m  in the cassettes  Use the multi purpose tray for paper that is  heavier than 120 g m            NOTE  Statement and A6 can only be used in cassette 1        1 Pull the cassette all the way out of the printer        
314. reparation before Use          NOTE  If the Found New Hardware Wizard appears  click Cancel  If a hardware installation warning message  appear  click Continue        3       Installer    Discover Printing System  Choose the printing system you would like to install                 Device Type Details     m A    IPv6          Finished    Information  I Use host name for port name    KYOCERA  lt Back    Net  gt                                   You can customize the print system name in the installation settings window  This will be the name displayed in  the Printer window and in the printer lists displayed in applications  Specify whether to share the print system  name or set the print system as an existing printer and then click Next        IMPORTANT  Step 3 only appears if the print system is connected via a network  It does not appear if the print system  is connected via a USB at the time of the first installation        4       Installer   Printer Settings      Type a name for your printer  Some programs do not support printer and server name combinations longer  than 31 characters     Printing system name             Share your printer with other users  To share this printer  type a share name                       oRKYOLERA       A window appears in which you can check the settings  Check the settings carefully and then click Install        NOTE  If the Windows security window appears  click Install this driver software anyway        5    A message appears saying tha
315. rom the server in which the mail is stored on the Internet or an intranet   PostScript    A page description language developed by Adobe Systems  It enables flexible font functions and highly functional  graphics  allowing higher quality printing  The first version called Level 1 was launched in 1985  followed by Level 2  that enabled color printing and two byte languages  e g  Japanese  in 1990  In 1996  Level 3 was released as an  update for the Internet access and PDF format as well as gradual improvements in implementation technologies     PPM  prints per minute     This indicates the number of A4 size printouts made in one minute        Appendix 23       Printer Driver    The software to enable you to print data created on any application software  The printer driver for the machine is  contained in the DVD ROM enclosed in the package  Install the printer driver on the computer connected to the  machine     Send as E mail    A function to send the image data stored in the machine as an E mail attachment  E mail addresses can be selected  from the list or entered at each time     SMTP  Simple Mail Transfer Protocol     A protocol for E mail transmission over the Internet or an intranet  It is used for transferring mail between mail servers  as well as for sending mail from clients to their servers     Status Page    The page lists machine conditions  such as the memory capacity  total number of prints and scans  and paper source  settings     Subnet Mask    The subnet mas
316. rors  Transmitted images can  also be attached        Use the procedure below to send a Result Report        Sys  Menu Count       Counter  System     Exit               1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Report         8 96    Default Setting  System Menu              Report    O  Admin Rpt Set   Result Rpt Set      Exit                  Result Rpt Set    gt  M  FAX RX Result  JobFinish Notice     Exit               Send Result    O    01  E mail Folder  FAX    CancelBeforeSend                  Exit    E mail Folder    O  Off  On    03  Error Only          2 Press the OK key  The Report menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Result Rpt Set       4 Press the OK key  The Result Rpt Set  menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Send Result   The Send  Result menu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  E mail Folder    FAX  or   CancelBeforeSend   Selected menu appears     NOTE  Selecting  CancelBeforeSend  can be specified  whether the machine prints the report when canceling the  operation before sending    When selecting  Off  in both E mail Folder and FAX menu    CancelBeforeSend  is not displayed        7 Press the A or V key to select  Off    On  or  Error Only    When selecting  CancelBeforeSend   press the A or V  key to select  Off  or  On     8 Press the OK key  A Result Report is sent  Completed   is displayed and the screen returns to the Send Result  menu        8 97    Default Setting  System Menu        Adjus
317. rs     6 Press the A or V key to select the user     7 Press the OK key  The print file selection menu appears        6 9    Document Box          Menu  Smid OK    Clear All  Detail             Fiala  pata OK    Print  Delete                H  UO       12164                Copies  aes OK     1   999         oo ices          Quick Copy mode    8 Press the A or V key to select the file to be printed  and  then press  Select   the Right Select key   The selected  file will be marked     If you need to add another file  repeat this procedure to  select the file        NOTE  To select all files  press Menu  the Left Select key   and select  Select All   To deselect all files  select  Clear All    To show file details  select  Detail         9 Press the OK key  The file print and delete selection  menu appears     10 Press the A or V key to select  Print  and press the OK  key        NOTE  To delete the selected file without printing it  select   Delete  and press the OK key  The file deletion confirmation  screen appears  Press  Yes   the Left Select key    Completed  appears and the file is deleted        11 The ID entry screen appears  Enter the ID and press the  OK key     12 The number of copies screen appears  Set the number  of copies and press the OK key     13 The file print confirmation screen appears  Press  Yes    the Left Select key   Accepted appears and printing  begins     This mode is used to print an additional copy of a document that has already been printed  If 
318. rs in copies when using the document processor  clean the slit glass with the supplied  cleaning cloth  The message Clean the slit glass  may be displayed if the slit glass requires cleaning        NOTE  Wipe the slit glasses with the dry cloth  Do not use water  soap or solvents for cleaning        1 Open the document processor and wipe the slit glass  a      2 Wipe the white guide  b  on the document processor                                                        3 Close the document processor        9 2    Maintenance       Cleaning the Machine    To avoid print quality problems  the interior of the machine must be cleaned with every toner container and waste  toner box replacement     1 Open the top cover and front cover                    d    PS a  P     2 Lift the developer unit together with the toner container  out of the machine                       3 Use a lint free cloth to clean dust and dirt away from the qe    registration roller  metal                                                                                                               4 Insert the developer unit together with the toner  container  back into the machine        5 Close the top cover and front cover        9 3    Maintenance          Open the left cover  Use a lint free cloth to clean dust and  dirt away from the vents     Close the left cover     Use a lint free cloth to clean dust and dirt away from the  vent on the right side of the machine        9 4    Maintenance       Toner Cont
319. rt number different from the default  21   enter using    the format    host name  port number     e g   FTPhostname  140         Dest      60667741234          Confirm    MMorgan  tHtH FHFFH         40667640000    om    Exit            12 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   This makes a  connection with the entered destination        3 23    Basic Operation             Dest      ERD Center     BEIS    IAPT10          If the connection is successful  Connected  is displayed  on the screen  Press  OK   the Right Select key    Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen     If the connection failed  Cannot connect  is displayed   Press  OK   the Right Select key   The screen shown in  step 3 reappears  Check and re enter the destination     13 If there are additional destinations  press the Add  Destination key  Repeat steps 2 to 12 to enter additional  destinations  Up to 100 destinations can be specified     14 Press the Confirm Destination key to confirm the  registered destinations     Press the A or V key to select a destination and press  the OK key  Then  you can edit or delete the destination     Press  Exit   the Right Select key  to return to the basic  screen     15 Press the Start key  Transmission starts        NOTE  If the screen for confirming the destination before  transmission  page 8 88  is set to  On   the Confirm  Destination screen appears when the Start key is pressed   For more information  refer to Confirm Destination Screen  on p
320. s on page 4   1     10 Press the Start key  Printing of the selected file begins        IMPORTANT  When removing the USB memory  ensure that  you use the correct removal procedure  as described in  Removing USB Memory on page 6 8        Sets the print mode for TIFF files  The default setting is Paper Size           Function Menu  pata ox   Paper Selection O  Duplex o     Exit            1 Follow steps 1 to 9 of Printing on page 6 2     2 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears     3 Press the A or V key to select  TIFF Print         6 3    Document Box          4 Press the OK key  TIFF Print appears   TIFF Print  Said OK    0i   Paper Size  Image Resolution  Print Resolution             5 Press the A or V key to select the the desire print mode     The print modes are as follows    Paper Size  scaled to fit the paper size    Image Resolution  matched to the image resolution   Print Resolution  matched to the print resolution        6 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu        XPS FitTo Page    If you select On in this setting  XPS data is scaled to fit the paper size during printing  If you select of     the data is  printed at its original size     1 Follow steps 1 to 8 of Printing on page 6 2        2 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears                 Function Menu  paid OK     Paper Selection O   Duplex o     Exit
321. s or a computer screen     Example    Press the Start key         Regular     Indicates a selection item on the  Message Display     Select  System         Italic    Indicates a message displayed  on the Message Display     Ready to copy is displayed        Used to emphasize a key word   phrase or references to  additional information     For more information refer to Sleep and  Auto Sleep on page 2 8        Indicates supplemental  information or operations for  reference           Important    Indicates items that are required  or prohibited so as to avoid  problems        IMPORTANT           Caution       Indicates what must be  observed to prevent injury or  machine breakdown and how to  deal with it           CAUTION              xxviii    1 Part Names    This chapter identifies the machine parts and operation panel keys     e Operation Pane                ccccccccsssssseceeeeceeeseeeeeeeseeeeeeesees 1 2   gt  NMACKING sinistral ee a aca 1 4       1 1    Part Names       Operation Panel    Displays the Address Book screen  where you can add  edit and delete destinations     Calls the previous destination  Also used to enter a    Displays the System Menu Counter menu screen  pause when entering a FAX number    where you can check the system settings and  counters  Displays the Confirm Destination screen  where you can edit and    delete destinations              Displays the Status screen  where you Displays the Add Destination screen  where you can add  can check the stat
322. sending is completed  the finish notice is sent  to the specified E mail address        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 22    Sending Functions       FTP Encrypted TX    This allows you to encrypt documents when you send them  If you select  On  in this option  you can then select the  encryption method in the basic send screen     Use the procedure below to scan and send originals as encrypted files   1 Press the Send key     2 Place the originals in the document processor or on the       platen   3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  pata OK   5  0  Color Selection O    Original Size O  Original Image O    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  FTP Encrypted TX         Press the OK key  FTP Encrypted TX appears   FTP Encrypted Tx   gt m    lol O  L  On             6 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           NOTE  Click Advanced   gt  Secure Protocols in the  COMMAND CENTER  Be sure that SSL of Secure  Protocol Settings is On and more than two effective  encryptions are selected in Clientside Settings  For details   refer to the KYOCERA COMMAND CENTER Operation  Guide           5 23    Sending Functions       File Separation    Create several files by dividing scanned original data 
323. set the limit on the number of copies        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i    Language    Default Screen                Sound    Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Preset Limit   GE  4 Press the OK key  The Preset Limit menu appears   Preset Limit        1   999    1 999             5 Press the A or V key to enter the number of copies     6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Common Settings menu        8 23    Default Setting  System Menu        Switching Unit of Measurement  Select inch or metric for the unit for paper dimensions     Use the procedure below to change the input units        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i    Language    Default Screen                Sound    Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Measurement    4 Press the OK key  The Measurement menu appears   Measurement  pata OK    fol  inch  mm             5 Press the A or V key to select  inch  or  mm      6 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Common Settings menu        8 24    Default Se
324. sic screen for copying     Place paper in the multi purpose tray   Press the Start key to start copying   If Add paper in MP tray  is displayed during the copying    process  add paper in the multi purpose tray  and then  press the OK key  Copying then resumes        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 5    Copying Functions       Original Orientation    Select the original orientation to use the following functions     e Duplex    Combine mode    When placing originals on the platen                                                                                               Top Edge Top   Top Edge Left        When placing originals on the document processor                                                                O                             Top Edge Top   Top Edge Left           NOTE  To change the default setting for the original orientation  refer to Orig  Orientation on page 8 48           4 6    Copying Functions       Use the procedure below to select the orientation when placing the originals on the platen   1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid OK      01  Paper Selection O    Collate Oo 4  Duplex o      Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Orientation         Press the OK key  Orig Orientation appears   Orig Orientation  0m    fai Top Edge Top       iTop Edge Left             6 Press the A or V key
325. slot  If connected via a USB hub  the machine may not  operate correctly     Printing    Print documents stored in the removable USB memory     1 Plug the USB memory into the USB memory slot                    2 Press the Document Box key  The Document Box menu  appears        3 Press the A or V key to select  USB Memory    Document Box  pata OK      Sub Address Box  Polling Box    USB Memor          4 Press the OK key  USB Memory appears     USB Memory  Sma OK      Folder 1  fAFile 1 oO      Menu     Select               5 Press the A or V key to select the the file you want to  print     Select a folder and press the OK key to view the files in  the folder  Documents in the top 3 folder levels including  the root directory can be viewed        6 2    Document Box       TIFF Print       USB Memory  Sma OK    store File    Folder 1   ER File 1 Z      Menu     Select                  USB Memory  Sma ok   Delete                   Ready to print   Copies  1   a4 a Ra a4 p   1 Sided    Duplex     Paper            6 Press  Select   the Right Select key   The selected file  name is indicated by a checkmark next to it     When you want to print additional files  repeat steps 5 to  6 to select them     7 Press the OK key  A menu appears     8 Press the A or V key to select  Print      9 Press the OK key  The basic screen appears  Change  the number of copies  1 sided 2 sided printing  etc   as  necessary  For changing print settings  refer to  Copying on page 3 7 and Copying Function
326. smission has been completed   Use the procedure below to specify the Job Finish Notice settings   1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  pata OK      Original Size O  Original Image O    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  JobFinish Notice         Press the OK key  JobFinish Notice appears   JobFinish Notice   gt      lo O  L  On             6 Press the A or V key to select  On  and then press the  OK key        7 7 Press the A or V key to select  Address Book  or  Destination   lt 0  Address Entry   and then press the OK key     0 xaddress Book    Address Entry          8 Ifyou select  Address Book   select  Address Book  on    Address Book   lt 0 the next screen and press the OK key  and then select  the notice destination   MMaury    Press  Menu   the Right Select key   select  Detail  on  the next screen and press the OK key to view the details  of the selected notice destination     MMorgan    Menu            If you select  Address Entry   enter the address of the  Address Entry   0 notice destination             abcdefg  jp       NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for    ABC details on entering characters       Text                  9 Press the OK key        5 21    Sending Functions       Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     10 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending     When the 
327. ss  Login   the Right Select key      The User Job Account menu appears     4 Press the A or V key to select  User Login Set       5 Press the OK key  The User Login Set  menu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  Local User List      7 Press the OK key  Local User List appears     8 Press  Menu   the Right Select key   press the A or V    key to select  Add User   and then press the OK key     9 Enter the user name and press the OK key  enter the    login user name in the next screen  and then press the  OK key        Management             s User01  Sma OK      Detail                                     10    Press the A or V key to select  Exit  and then press the  OK key     Select  Detail  and press the OK key to see information  of the registered users                      11 In Local User List  press the A or V key to select the  Local User List      added user and then press the OK key    amp  DeviceAdmin     Admin    Menu      12 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to select  Login Password    press  Details  lt  OK   Edit   the Right Select key   enter the login password   Login Password  3 6 and then press the OK key   SSC CER RR ES    Edit    13 Enter the same login password to confirm and press the  OK key   14 Press the  gt  key to select  E mailAddress    press  Edit   Detail   lt  OK   the Right Select key   enter the e mail address  and  MrE mailAddress  4 6 then press the OK key   xxxx xx xx abcdef jp    Edit     l   15 Press the  gt  key to select  Access Le
328. ss the A or V key to select  Err  Clear Timer      Press the OK key  Err  Clear Timer appears     Press the A or V key to set the Error Clear Timer  Set  the amount of time before clearing errors in seconds   You cannot use the numeric keys to enter this value     Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Timer Settings menu     If no job runs for a certain period of time  automatically enter Sleep Mode  Refer to Sleep and Auto Sleep on page 2   8 for Sleep Mode     e Auto Sleep ON OFF    Select whether to use Auto Sleep or not  The default setting is On        NOTE  Time remaining before Auto Sleep can be modified as necessary        Use the procedure below to specify the auto sleep setting           Sys  Menu Count    gt 00  System  User Job Account      Exit            1    In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Common Settings         8 34    Default Setting  System Menu           2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings  M    01  Language    Default Screen                Sound    Exit    3 Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key   f A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name  W password with administrator privileges to log in  and  EES Ue es ae ach press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login            4 The Timer Settings menu appears   Timer Setting     oK    0  Err  Clear Timer  Sleep Timer  PanelReset
329. st name and path name appear  Enter the same  host name and path name again and press the OK key on  their respective screens           NOTE  You will be unable to send the data if you forget your login user name or login password of the destination  PC  Contact your administrator and check your login user name or login password           3 22    Basic Operation       For send to folder  SMB     Host Name   SMB      Data to be entered    Host name or IP address of the PC to  receive the data     Max   characters    Up to 64  characters       Path    Path to the receiving folder such as  follows   For example  User Sharename     Up to 128  characters       Login User  Name    User name to access the PC  For example  abcdnet james smith    Up to 64  characters       Login  Password            Password to access the PC          Up to 64  characters    To specify a port number different from the default  139   enter using    the format    host name  port number     e g   SMBhostname  140      For send to folder  FTP     Host Name   FTP      Data to be entered    Host name or IP address of FTP server    Max   characters    Up to 64  characters       Path    Path to the receiving folder    For example  User ScanData   Otherwise the data will be saved in the  home directory     Up to 128  characters       Login User  Name    FTP server log in user name    Up to 64  characters       Login  Password            FTP server log in password          Up to 64  characters    To specify a po
330. sure                         Yes     No    NOTE  If the screen for confirming the entry of a new  destination  page 8 88  is set to  On   screens to confirm the  entered host name and path name appear  Enter the same  host name and path name again and press the OK key on  their respective screens   11 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   This makes a   Dest  Confirm    gt  0m connection with the entered destination    MMorgan HHttt tt tt tH H       40667741234     Exit            If the connection is successful  Connected  is displayed  on the screen  Press  OK   the Right Select key    Completed  is displayed and the folder  SMB FTP   address is registered     If the connection failed  Cannot connect  is displayed   Press  OK   the Right Select key   The screen shown in  step 2 reappears  Check and re enter the destination        8 109    Default Setting  System Menu        Address Number    Address Number is an ID for a destination  When creating a new destination  the smallest unused address number  is automatically allocated  You can select any available number out of 100 numbers for individuals and 20 numbers  for groups        1 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to display Address Number           Detail   lt  0  address Number  6 6  053    Edit    2 Press  Edit   the Right Select key   An entry screen  Address Number      appears    001   120              3 Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to enter the  address number     4 Press the OK key  The address number is regist
331. t   the Right Select key   This displays the list  Group Member   lt    of destinations registered to the group    Morgan   Morgan    Menu    7 3 Press  Menu   the Right Select key   The group editing  Menu   lt    menu appears   Delete  Add Member             4 Press the A or V key to select  Add Member         8 112    Default Setting  System Menu           5 Press the OK key  This displays the list of destinations    Contacts    OK   registered in the Address Book    amp  Maury       NOTE  If 100 members have already been registered in the                 amp  Morgan group  the screen will display Registered numbers    Menu   exceeded  and return to the Group Member   6 Press the A or V key to select the destination you want  to add to the group   7 Press the OK key  This displays the sending address   amp  Sally    OK   registered to the selected destination    40667643277  Msally G tttttt tt tt    BNtid7004    Menu               Press the A or V key to select the sending address     Press the OK key  The selected destination is added to  the group and the screen returns to Group Member           NOTE  If you select an individual destination that has  already been registered to the group  the screen will display  This address is already registered  and return to the screen  of step 7        Deleting member from group    To delete a member registered to the group  follow the procedure below        1 While Group Member is displayed  press  Edit   the    Group Member   gt  0
332. t  Adj  menu     Adjust scan density when sending or storing the data in Document Box  Adjustment can be made in 7 levels both in    auto and manual density modes        Sys  Menu Count        Document Box  O  Edit Destination      Exit               Adjust Maint     O  Send Box Density  Correct  Bk Line     Exit                  Send Box Density          Manual      Exit                  Manual  Sma OK     1   1          1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Adjust Maint       2 Press the OK key  The Adjust Maint  menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Send Box Density      4 Press the OK key  Send Box Density appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  Auto  or  Manual      6 Press the OK key  This displays the density selection  screen for the mode selected in step 5  The screen  shown is the one when  Manual  is selected     7 Press the A or V key to select the density from   3  Lighter  to   3 Darker         8 99    Default Setting  System Menu        8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Send Box Density menu     Correct  Bk Line    Correct fine black lines  black streaks caused by contamination   which may appear on the copies  when the  document processor used     Paper feed  direction    _          The table below shows the available settings     Item Description    No correction performed        Correction performed  The reproduction of    the image becomes lower when using Off        Correct
333. t ID  Job is canceled    Job Accounting restriction exceeded  Cannot print   Job Accounting restriction exceeded  Cannot scan   Job not stored  Press  OK     Job Accounting restriction exceeded  Job is canceled   Polling box limit exceeded  Job is canceled    Memory is full  Print job cannot be processed completely   Maximum Number of scanned pages  Job is canceled   Print overrun  Job is paused    KPDL error  Job is canceled    USB memory error  Job is canceled    No multi copies  Press  OK      e Auto Error Clear ON OFF  Select whether to use Auto Error Clear or not     Use the procedure below to specify the auto error clear setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings  M    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               3 Press the A or V key to select  Timer Setting   and press  the OK key        7 A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name   m password with administrator privileges to log in  and    BEES Ee press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login                  8 32    Default Setting  System Menu           4 The Timer Settings menu appears   Timer Setting     oK    PanelReset Timer  Low Power Timer    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Auto Err  Clear         6 Press the OK key  Auto 
334. t appropriate image quality        Printouts are dirty     Is the platen or the document  processor dirty     Clean the platen or the document  processor        Refresh drum        Printouts are fuzzy     Is the machine being used in  very humid conditions     Use in a location that has suitable  humidity        Refresh drum        Images are skewed     Are the originals placed  correctly     When placing originals on the  platen  align them with the slit  glass        When placing originals in the  document processor  align the  original width guides securely  before placing the originals        Is the paper loaded  correctly     Check the position of the paper  width guides        Cannot feed originals     Are the originals placed  correctly     When placing originals in the  document processor  align the  original width guides securely  before placing the originals        Is the paper feed roller or the  separation pad dirty     Wipe the paper feed roller or the  separation pad with a moistened  cloth    If the problem is not solved   contact your Service  Representative  Replace the paper  feed roller and separation pad        Paper often jams     Is the paper loaded  correctly     Load the paper correctly        Is the paper of the supported  type  Is it in good condition     Remove the paper  turn it over  and  reload it        Is the paper curled  folded or  wrinkled     Replace the paper with new paper        Are there any loose scraps or  jammed paper in the  machine
335. t the original size   1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears                 Function Menu  bmg OK    Collate Oo  Duplex o     Exit     4 Press the A or V key to select  Original Size    Press the OK key  Original Size appears    Original Size  Km OK    0  Letter     Legal       Statement 4             6 Press the A or V key to select the desired original size  and then press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for copying     7 Press the Start key to start copying        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           4 2    Copying Functions       Paper Selection    Select the paper source that contains the required paper size        NOTE  Specify in advance the size and type of the paper loaded in the cassette  refer to Original Paper Settings on  page 8 7      Selecting the Cassette    Use the procedure below to select the paper supply cassette        1 Press the Copy key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  Sma OK    Collate O  Duplex o    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  Paper Selection         Press the OK key  Paper Selection appears   Paper Selection  0m    0i   Auto  Letter P Plain  Custom     Plain             6 Press the A or V key to select the desired paper size     If  Auto  is selected  the paper matching the size of the  origin
336. t the printer has been installed successfully  Click Finish to exit the printer  installation wizard and return the DVD ROM main menu     If the device setup dialog box appears after you click Finish  you can specify the settings for items such as  optional features installed in the print system  You can also specify the device settings after you exit the  installation  For details  refer to Device Settings in the printer driver operation manual on the DVD ROM     This completes the printer driver installation procedure  Follow the on screen instructions to restart the system   if required        2 18    Preparation before Use       Custom Mode    Use Custom Mode if you want to specify the printer port and select the software to be installed     For example  if you do not want fonts installed on your computer to be replaced  select Custom Mode and deselect    the Fonts checkbox in the utility tab     1 Select Custom Mode        Installer    Installation Method    Choose how to install the software     Install the recommended printing software  The printing system must be connected          L  Custom Mode  Create a custom installation     oRKYOCERA          Utilities  Install printing system utilities only           2 Following the instructions in the install wizard window  select the software packages to be installed and the    specify the port  etc     For details  refer to Custom Installation in the printer driver operation manual on the DVD ROM        Installer    Discover
337. t touch it with your hands as it may result in  burn injury              2 47    Preparation before Use       3 Close the rear cover     4 Follow the steps of Loading Paper in the Multi Purpose  Tray on page 2 45        NOTE  When printing on plain paper  press the two  envelope switches  green  again to change the paper feed  mode to plain paper mode           When you load envelopes or cardstock in the multi purpose tray  Load envelope with the print side facing up                                                  Return postcard Cardstock Portrait form Landscape form   Oufuku Hagaki   Hagaki  envelopes envelopes       NOTE  Use unfolded return postcard  Oufuku Hagaki               IMPORTANT  How to load envelopes  orientation and  facing  will differ depending on the type of envelope  Be sure  to load it in correctly  otherwise printing may be done in the  wrong direction or on the wrong face           NOTE  When you load envelopes in the multi purpose tray   select the envelope type by referring to Specifying Paper  Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray on page 2   57           2 48    Preparation before Use       Specifying Paper Size and Media    The default paper size setting for cassette  for multi purpose tray and for the optional paper feeder  cassettes 2 to 4   is  Letter   and the default media type setting is  Plain   2       To fix the type of paper to be used in cassettes  specify the paper size and media type setting   Refer to Specifying  Paper Size a
338. t your Service Representative        Memory is full   Print job cannot be  processed  completely     Unable to continue the job as the  memory is used up    Press the OK key to print the  scanned pages  The print job cannot  be processed completely    Press the Stop key to cancel the job        Memory is full  Job is  canceled     The job is canceled  Press the OK  key        USB memory error   Job is canceled     This job is canceled  Press the OK  key        Removable memory is  full  Job is canceled     This job is canceled  Press the OK  key        Cannot feed paper set  cassette 1     Is any of the paper feeders  or the printer cassette upper  than the selected one  properly closed when one or  more optional feeders are  installed     Close the paper feeder properly        Place original  and press Start key     Remove originals from the document  processor  put them back in their  original order  and place them again   Press the Start key to resume  printing    Press the Stop key to cancel the job        Paper jammed           If a paper jam occurs  the machine  will stop and the location of the jam  will be indicated on the Message  Display  Leave the machine on and  follow the instruction to remove the  jammed paper              10 8    Troubleshooting       Error Message Check points Corrective Actions pres  Job not stored  Press Press the OK key to store the job    OK         Remove original from   Are there any originals left in   Remove originals from the document
339. tale NOTE  If the destinations are not registered  there is no list     amp  Maury in the Address Book     Menu                     5 Press  Menu   the Right Select key   Menu appears     Menu    O  Detail Edit  Delete    Add Address                8 105    Default Setting  System Menu        6 Press the A or V key to select  Add Address         7 Press the OK key  Add Address appears                    Add Address   lt  0  Group  8 Press the A or V key to select  Contact      9 Press the OK key  This displays the screen for editing   Detail  a OK destinations   Contact Name 1 7  ay NOTE  If the maximum number of destinations has already     been registered  the screen will display Registered numbers     Edit   exceeded  and return to the Address Book                 10 Enter each item and then press the OK key  Registered   is displayed and the screen returns to the Address Book  list screen     Refer to the descriptions below for how to enter each  item     Entering Contact Name       1 Press the  lt  or  gt  key to select  Contact Name                  Detail       Contact Name 1 7  Sally     Edit     2 Press  Edit   the Right Select key   An entry screen   Contact Name      0 appears   sallyii        ABC    Text               3 Enter the contact name     If creating a new contact name  the address number  allocated to the destination is already entered     4 Press the OK key  The contact name is registered        8 106    Default Setting  System Menu        Entering E mai
340. ted     Are the originals loaded  correctly     When placing originals on the  platen  place them face down and  align them with the slit glass        When placing originals in the  document processor  place them  face up        Printouts are too light     Is the machine in Manual  Density mode     Select the correct density level        When changing the default density  level  adjust the density manually  and choose the desired level        Is the toner distributed evenly  within the toner container     Shake the toner container from  side to side about several times        Is there a message indicating  the addition of toner     Replace the toner container        Is the paper damp     Replace the paper with new paper        Is EcoPrint mode enabled     Disable EcoPrint mode        Make sure the paper type setting is  correct the paper being used        Refresh drum        Printouts are too dark     Is the machine in Auto  Density mode     Set the correct density level for  auto density        Is the machine in Manual  Density mode     Select the correct density level              Refresh drum              10 2    Troubleshooting       Symptom    Copies have a moire  pattern  dots grouped  together in patterns  and not aligned  uniformly      Checkpoints    Is the original a printed  photograph     Corrective Actions    Set the image quality to  Photo      Reference  Page       Printouts are not  clear     Did you choose appropriate  image quality for the original     Selec
341. the A or V key to  select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu    appears     Press the A or V key to select  RAM Disk Mode      Press the OK key  RAM Disk Mode appears     Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      If  On  is selected and the OK key is pressed  the RAM  disk size screen appears     If  Off  is selected and the OK key is pressed  proceed to  step 8     7 Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to enter the  size of the RAM disk     8 A confirmation screen appears  Press  Yes   the Left  Select key   The machine is restarted        8 67    Default Setting  System Menu        Copy Settings    The following settings are available for copying functions     Photo Processing    8 68  Paper Selection    8 69  Auto Paper Selection    8 70  Auto   Priority    8 71  Select Key Set    8 72       NOTE  If user login administration is enabled  you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator    privileges        Photo Processing    Set the resolution for copying a photo      ea    Dithering Normal  Sets the resolution to standard           Dithering Rough  Sets the resolution to low     Use the procedure below to set Photo Processing        Sys  Menu Count        User Job Account  Common Settings    Copy      Exit               Copy    O  Paper Selection  AutoPaperSelect      Exit                  Photo Processing   gt      0  Dithering  Normal   Dithering  Rough           1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or 
342. the A or V key to select  Text Photo    Photo     Text  or  for OCR      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu        8 44    Default Setting  System Menu        Density    Set the default density  The available default settings are shown below        een    Manual  Normal 0  Set to  Normal 0  in the Manual density        Auto Set to Auto density     Use the procedure below to select the default zoom setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   gt i    01  Language  Default Screen  Sound         Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default   gt     01I  Color Selection  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  Density    6 Press the OK key  Density appears   Density  bmg OK    Auto             7 Press the A or V key to select  Auto  or  Manual      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu        8 45    Default Setting  System Menu        Select the enlarged reduced default when paper size sending size changed after the originals set  The available  default settings are shown below        Item D
343. the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears  qe  Common Settings   gt i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default      er Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    01I  Color Selection  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit    Press the A or V key to select  Collate    Press the OK key  Collate appears   Collate  Sma OK    Off             7 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  On      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu        8 47    Default Setting  System Menu        Orig Orientation    Set the original orientation defaults  The available default settings are shown below     a a a    fH  Top Edge Top Select the original s top edge at the top        iz  Top Edge Left Select the original s top edge at the left        Refer to page 4 6 for Original Orientation     Use the procedure below to select the default orientation when originals are placed on the platen        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings  i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    Scan Resolut
344. the default value        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu  Common Settings  Wm appears     Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set    3    Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears        Orig   Paper Set   i  Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize     Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Def  Orig  Size         Press the OK key  Def  Orig  Size appears   Def  Orig  Size   gt m    0    Letter     Legal     Statement 4             7 Press the A or V key to select the paper size to be used  as the default value     8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Orig  Paper Set  menu        8 9    Default Setting  System Menu        Adding a Custom Size and Media Type for Paper to Print    Set up a frequently used custom paper size  The custom size options are displayed on the screen to select paper     The table below lists the sizes that can be registered     Input units Dimensions       Inch models Cassette     Paper Feeder   Option      MP Tray     X  4 13 to 8 50   in 0 01  increments   Y  5 83 to 14 02   in 0 01  increments       5 83 to 8 50   in 0 01  increments     8 27 to 14 02   in 0 01  increments       2 75 to 8 50   in 0 01  increments     5 83 to 14 02   in 0 01  increments        Me
345. the original is 40 mm  or thicker        2 Place the original  Put the scanning side facedown and  align it flush against the original size indicator plate with  the back left corner as the reference point     3 Close the document processor        IMPORTANT  Do not push the original cover forcefully when  you close it  Excessive pressure may crack the platen glass   Do not close the document processor when the original is  40 mm or thicker           NOTE  Shadows may be produced around the edges and in  the middle of open faced originals           CAUTION  Do not leave the document processor open as  there is a danger of personal injury           2 54    Preparation before Use       Loading Originals in the Document Processor    The document processor automatically scans each sheet of multiple originals  Both sides of two sided originals are  scanned     Originals Supported by the Document Processor    The document processor supports the following types of originals     Weight 50 to 120 g m   duplex  50 to 110 g m         Size Maximum A4 to Minimum A5  Maximum Legal to Minimum Statement       Capacity   Plain paper  Colored paper  Recycled paper   High quality paper  50 sheets   Thick paper  110 g m    36 sheets   Thick paper  120 g m    33 sheets   Art paper  1 sheet          Originals Not Supported by the Document Processor  Do not use the document processor for the following types of originals     e Soft originals such as vinyl sheets   e Transparencies such as OHP film   
346. ting setting     1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    System Menu  operation panel     Counter           Sys  Menu Count    gt 00          2 Pressthe A or V key to select  User Job Account      04  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings               Exit      A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  Login User Name     password with administrator privileges to log in  and  TE ee press  Login   the Right Select key      Login Password       Login                  11 15    Management             User Job Account       User Login Set   Unknown ID Job     Exit            Job Account Set    gt  m  Account  Report  Total Accounting     Exit               Job Accounting  bmg OK    lo OfE  On             NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        The User Job Account menu appears     4 Press the A or V key to select  Job Account  Set       5 Press the OK key  The Job Account  Set  menu appears     6 Press the A or V key to select  Job Accounting      7 Press the OK key  Job Accounting appears     8 Press the A or V key to select  On   To disable job  accounting  select  Off      9 Press the OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  Job Account  Set  menu        NOTE  When the display returns to the System Menu  default screen  logout is automatically executed and the  screen to enter the Account ID appears  To continue the  operation  enter the Account ID         
347. tment Maintenance    Adjust printing quality and conduct machine maintenance     Copy Denst  Adj     8 98  Send Box Density    8 99  Correct  Bk Line    8 100  New Developer   8 101  Auto Drum Refresh   8 102  Drum Refresh   8 103       NOTE  If user login administration is enabled  you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator  privileges        Copy Denst  Adj     Adjust copy density  Adjustment can be made in 7 levels both in auto and manual density modes     Use the procedure below to adjust the copy density        Sys  Menu Count        Document Box  O  Edit Destination      Exit            Adjust Maint     O  Send Box Density  Correct  Bk Line     Exit                  Copy Denst  Adj         Manual      Exit               In the Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  Adjust Maint       Press the OK key  The Adjust Maint  menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Copy Denst  Adj       Press the OK key  Copy Denst  Adj  appears     Press the A or V key to select  Auto  or  Manual         8 98    Default Setting  System Menu           Manual   03  1    05  1       om    o4  0 Normal          Send Box Density    6 Press the OK key  This displays the density selection  screen for the mode selected in step 5  The screen  shown is the one when  Manual  is selected     7 Press the A or V key to select the density from   3  Lighter  to   3 Darker      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Copy Dens
348. to the FS C2026MFP   C2126MFP  C2526MFP C2626MFP   3040MFP  3140MFP  3540MFP 3640MFP Installer    You will be guided through the steps necessary to  install this software     GoBack     Continue            7 Choose Select Destination  Installation Type and then install the printer driver as directed by the instructions    in the installation software        2 20    Preparation before Use          NOTE  In addition to Easy Install  the Installation Type options include Custom Install  which allows you to  specify the components to be installed           IMPORTANT  In the Authenticate screen  enter the name and password used to log in to the operating system        This completes the printer driver installation  Next  specify the print settings     If an IP  AppleTalk or Bonjour connection is used  the settings below are required  If a USB connection is used   the printer is automatically recognized and connected     8 Open System Preferences and click Print  amp  Fax                      7  ee System Preferences  CL Cronai       Personal   cE  amp  e B    9  Appearance Desktop  amp  Dock Expos    amp  Language  amp  Security Spotlight  Screen Saver Spaces Text  Hardware  fA    amp   E gt    g   i  CDs  amp DVDs Displays Energy Keyboard Mouse Print  amp  Fax Sound    Internet  amp  Wireless  N   0      MobileMe Network Bluetooth Sharing    System       u    CQ O O k  2 Oo     Accounts Date amp Time Parental Software Speech Startup Disk Time Machine Universal  Controls Update Ac
349. to use    IPP over SSL        SSL must be set to  On  in  SSL Setting on page 8 140        Default Setting       i    The machine must be restarted after the setting is changed   x  The machine does not need to be restarted after the setting is changed     Use the procedure below        Sys  Menu Count    lt     Report  Counter    System      Exit            Login User Name  0    Login Password       Login            System   gt  oK  I F Block Set   Security Level     Exit                  Network Setting   gt     NetWare  AppleTalk     Exit                  TCP IP Settings      IPv4 Setting  IPv6 Setting    Protocol Detail      Exit                  Restarting the  System     1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  select  System   and press the OK key     A login screen will appear  Then  enter the user ID and  password with administrator privileges to log in  and  press  Login   the Right Select key      2 The System menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Network Setting      4 Press the OK key  The Network Setting menu appears     5 Press the A or V key to select  TCP IP Settings      6 Press the OK key  The TCP IP Settings menu appears     7 Press the A or V key to select  Protocol Detail         8 137    Default Setting  System Menu              Protocol Detail   gt       01  NetBEUI  SNMPv3  FTP  Server                             FTP  Client    lt  m   On   Port Number        1   65535           10    11    12    Press the OK key  The Protoco
350. tric models   Cassette        Paper Feeder   Option      MP Tray       105 to 216  in 1 mm increments    148 to 356  in 1 mm increments      148 to 216  in 1 mm increments    210 to 356  in 1 mm increments      70 to 216  in 1 mm increments     148 to 356  in 1 mm increments      lt L lt X KX X  XK xX       NOTE  When the paper size dial on a cassette is set to OTHER  a paper size can be set for the cassette        Custom paper sizes can be added for each paper source     Use the procedure below to select a custom paper size        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to    Sys  Menu Count    0  System  User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit            Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Orig  Paper Set   i  Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize     Exit               select  Common Settings      2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set     4 Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears        8 10    Default Setting  System Menu              Custom PaperSize 0m  Cassette 2 Size  Cassette 3 Size                Size Entry Y   aca OK     5 83   14 02   t 14 02                   Size Entry  X   EEE OK     4 13   8 50   e850            10  11    Press the A or V key to select  Custom PaperSize      Press the OK key  The Custom PaperSize menu    appears     Select the paper source in which you want to set the  custom size and press the OK key  Size Entry Y
351. tting  System Menu        Error Handling    Select whether to cancel or continue the job when error has occurred  The possible errors and what to do for the errors  are as follows     Duplexing Error    Select what to do when duplex printing is not possible for the selected paper size and media type     Description    1 sided Printed in 1 sided       Display Error Error message to cancel printing is  displayed           Paper Mismatch Error    Select the method to handle if the selected paper size or paper type does not match the paper size or paper type set  in the paper source when printing from your computer           Description  Ignore Printing continues   Display Error Error message to cancel printing is  displayed        Use the procedure below to specify the settings for error handling        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings  i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Error Handling         4 Press the OK key  The Error Handling menu appears   Error Handling  bmg OK      01  DuplexPaperError    PaperMismatchErr      Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  DuplexPaperError         8 25    Default Setting  System Menu              DuplexPaperError   m    lo   1 sided    Display Error                Pm OK    
352. ttings      Exit                  8 54    Default Setting  System Menu           2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   gt i     01  Language  Default Screen  Sound            Exit         Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  File Separation         6 Press the OK key  File Separation appears   File Separation  0m    Each Page                7 Press the A or V key to select  Off  or  Each Page      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu     TIFF Print    Select the TIFF Print default  The table below shows the available settings     Item Description    Paper Size Scaled to fit the paper size        Image Resolution Matched to the image resolution        Print Resolution Matched to the print resolution              NOTE  Refer to page 6 3 for TIFF Print        Use the procedure below to set the default TIFF Print setting        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit                  8 55    Default Setting  System Menu              Common Settings   gt i  Default Screen  Sound     Exit                  Function Default   lt 0  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit
353. ty the acter ta he taken whan a connaction mahea the condeans species r the nie    What action sho      fue Te  a heaton    gt    s    d be taken when connection matches the snectied condbons        Tha maudes Connections that me protected wan IPsec as wel at mose are nat  Aiow the connection if it is secure    Tha includes only connections that have been authenticated by using IPsec Connections  vel be secured uang the wengi n Pane papate and ties n mha Connection San rty  Ride node    Leam more about acions                   New Inbound Rule Wizard e  Profie  Scecty ma peoties tor whch the sie accbes  Sepa      Tile Tos When does the nde apoly     gt       7 Domain   a Prite Aches when a computer a connected to ts coporste doman     Nme T Private   Apohes when a computer a connected to a private network locator  Lan 7  tie  ce CG  cno  L   IP New Inbound Rute Wizard etaj   Name    Specty the name and desengton of the nie       am Ge  ee    7 Select Allow the connection and click Next     8 Make sure all checkboxes are selected and click Next     9 Enter  Scan to SMB  in  Name  and click Finish        NOTE  In Windows XP or Windows Vista  follow the procedure below to set the port     1 From the Start menu  select Control Panel  System and Security  or Security Center   and then Check Firewall    Status   or Windows Firewall      If the User Account Control dialog box appears  click the Continue button        2 39       Preparation before Use       2 Click the Exceptions tab
354. u how to connect your printer to a Windows Vista PC        NOTE  In Windows operating systems  you must be logged in with administrator rights to install the printer driver        You can use either Express Mode or Custom Mode to install the software  Express Mode automatically detects  connected printers and installs the required software  Use Custom Mode if you want to specify the printer port and  select the software to be installed     1 Turnon the computer and start up Windows   If the Welcome to the Found New Hardware Wizard dialog box displays  select Cancel     2 Insert the DVD ROM supplied with the printer into the optical drive of the PC  In Windows 7  Windows Server  2008 and Windows Vista  the user account control window may appear  Click Allow     The installation program launches        NOTE  If the software install wizard does not launch automatically  open the DVD ROM window in Windows  Explorer and double click Setup exe        3 Click View License Agreement and read the License Agreement  Click Accept           Kyocera Product bray     KYOCERA THE NEW VALUE FRONTIER    Notice    By using or installing the device drivers  and Software included on this DVD ROM   you agree to become bound by the terms  and conditions of this License Agreement   Please open and read     View License Agreement  Exit       4 Click Install software        2 16    Preparation before Use       The software install wizard starts up     KYOCERA THE NEW VALUE FRONTIER    Install Softwar
355. ult Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Orig  Paper Set          4 Press the OK key  The Orig  Paper Set  menu appears   Orig  Paper Set   i    Def  Orig  Size  Custom PaperSize    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  Cassette 1 Set      Cassette 2 Set     Cassette 3 Set   or  Cassette 4 Set       Follow the steps below when you select the main unit  cassette   Cassette 1    Operate in a similar fashion       8 12    Default Setting  System Menu              Cassette 1 Set   0m    Cassette 1 Size    Cassette 1 Type      Exit                  Cassette 1 Size  0m  02  ISO B5  13  Envelope C5                14  Custom  Cassette 1 Set    gt m    Cassette 1 Size    Cassette 1 Type      Exit                  Cassette 1 Type  0m   o  Plain   Rough   Recycled          11 Press the A or V key to select  Cassette 1 Type      12 Press the OK key  Cassette 1 Type appears     13 Press the A or V key to select the paper type     14 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Cassette 1 Set  menu     when you select an optional cassette   Cassette 2  3 or    4      The Cassette 1 Set  menu appears     Press the A or V key to select  Cassette 1 Size      Press the OK key  Cassette 1 Size appears     Press the A or V key to select the paper size     Press the OK key  The screen returns to the Cassette 1    Set  menu        8 13    Default Setting  System Menu        Paper Size and Media Type Setup for Multi Purpose T
356. us  print a status destinations   report  and pause or cancel the job in  process  Swi  witches between on hook and off hook when    Displays the Copy manually sending a FAX      screen  where you can    make settings required Message Display  Check what is  for copying  shown here while operating the  machine     Selects the menu displayed  at the lower right in the  Message Display           Address  System Menuf Status  Copy Addres  Recall    Confirm   Add  0 ob Cance Book Pause   Destination Destination  On Hook                                  fe   Document Send  Eae     se  fa                                                                                            Print Send Receive                                     Displays the FAX screen  where Blinks while data   you can send a FAX   is transmitted   Displays the Send screen  where you can send an e mail  Blinks during printing  folder  SMB FTP  or FAX   operation     Displays the Document Box screen  where you can  gt e aa ne menu ees    operate the document box and USB memory  Message Display     Used to register  call and delete  destinations to the one touch key  numbers  1 to 22      Shifts to switch the one touch key numbers   1 to 11 and 12 to 22    Lamp is lit while shifted  12 to 22        FAX functions available only in FS 3140MFP         1 2    Part Names       Used to select a menu item  move the cursor when  entering characters  change a value  etc         value           Displays the function menu f
357. us functions frequently used for copying and sending can be collectively registered as a program   Then  you can change the current settings of various functions to the registered settings by just pressing one of the  Program 1 to 4 keys        NOTE  The following functions are already registerd in Program 1 key  This function allows you to copy the front and  back sides of ID card or other document that is smaller than Stetement or A5 size onto a single page  Although the  functions are deleted by overwriting Program 1 key  you can register the same settings using the Function Menu  key    Combine  2 in 1   Continuous Scan  On   Original Size  Statement  Inch models  A5  Metric models    Paper Selection  Cassette 1   Zoom Options  Auto Zoom          3 3    Basic Operation       Program    I  ID Card Copy    Registering Settings    Power           Logout          Registered        Program 1             Changing and Deleting Settings             Are you sure     Program 1         Menu  Sma OK    Overwrite   Delete   Overwrite                Yes J  IE No    Delete   Are you sure      Program 1     Yes J if No            Recalling Settings    ID Card Copy is printed on the Program 1 key  When the  functions are deleted by overwriting Program 1 key  seal  the label supplied with the machine and write the function  name in it     After making settings  press and hold the one of the Program    1 to    4 keys where you want to register the settings for 3    seconds  The current sett
358. us sparks may cause burns  S  Keep the toner container and the waste toner box out of the reach of children  S    If toner happens to spill from the toner container or the waste toner box  avoid inhalation and ingestion  as S  well as contact with your eyes and skin     e If you do happen to inhale toner  move to a place with fresh air and gargle thoroughly with a large amount of  water  If coughing develops  contact a physician     e If you do happen to ingest toner  rinse your mouth with water and drink 1 or 2 cups of water to dilute the contents  of your stomach  If necessary  contact a physician     e If you do happen to get toner in your eyes  flush them thoroughly with water  If there is any remaining tenderness   contact a physician        If toner does happen to get on your skin  wash with soap and water     Do not attempt to force open or destroy the toner container or the waste toner box  S       XV       Other precautions    Return the exhausted toner container and waste toner box to your dealer or service representative  The collected  toner container and waste toner box will be recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant regulations     Store the machine while avoiding exposure to direct sunlight     Store the machine in a place where the temperature stays below 40  C while avoiding sharp changes of temperature  and humidity     If the machine will not be used for an extended period of time  remove the paper from the cassette and the Multi  Purpose  MP  
359. vel    press  Detail   lt  OK    Change   the Right Select key   select the user access  Access Level  5 6 privilege  and then press the OK key   Administrator   NOTE  If the user list is for device administrator   Change     Change   is not displayed   16 Press the  gt  key to select  Account Name    press  Detail   lt  0  Change   the Right Select key   select the account  and  Account Name  6 6 then press the OK key    e RD Center  NOTE  If the user list is for device administrator and the    Change   device administrator does not log in   Change  is not          displayed        17    After entering the user information  press the OK key  again     Registered  is displayed and the screen returns to Local  User List        Management       Changing User Properties    User information can be changed  It can be changed only by a user with administrator privileges     Use the procedure below to change the user properties     NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        System Menu   Counter             Sys  Menu Count    gt 00    4  User Job Account  User Property  Common Settings     Exit                  Login User Name   0    Login Password       Login               User Job Account  0m  Job Account  Set   Unknown ID Job     Exit               User Login Set    lt     User Login  Group Auth      Exit               1 Press the System Menu Counter key on the main unit    operation panel     2 Press the A or V key to select  Us
360. ving Malfunctions 10 2  Specifications  Document Processor Appendix 21    Environmental Specifications Appendix     21  Machine Appendix 18    Subnet Mask Appendix 24    Support tray section of the multi purpose tray    1 5    Switching the Language 2 9  8 3  Switching Unit of Measurement 8 24  Symbols i   System Menu 8 1    T       TCP IP Appendix 24   TEL connector 1 6   Toner container 1 4   Toner container lock lever 1 4  Top cover 1 4  1 6   Trade Names xxii   TWAIN Appendix 24    U       Unusable Time 8 40  USB Appendix 24  USB Cable    Connecting 2 9    USB Interface 2 4  USB interface connector 1 6  USB Memory    Printing Documents 6 2  Removing 6 8   Saving Documents 6 6  TIFF Print 6 3   XPS FitTo Page 6 4    USB memory slot 1 4  User Login Administration 11 2    Adding 11 6   Changing Properties 11 9   Displaying Network User Propertiy 11 12   Enabling Disabling 11 2   Enabling Disabling Group Authentication  11 11   Login 11 5   Logout 11 5   Unknown login user name Job 11 13       Index 5    Index                W Z  Waste Toner Box 1 6 Zoom Copying  WIA Appendix 25 Auto Zoom 3 10  WSD Scan 5 19 Manual Zoom 3 10  Preset Zoom 3 10  X Zoom Mode  Copy 3 10  5 5  XPS Send 5 5    File formats 5 10  8 53  Saving documents to Removable USB  Memory 6 6       Index 6       QUALITY  CERTIFICATE       Tais machine has passed  all quality controls and  final insoection    me wee          PASSIONATE PEOPLE  FROM ALL OVER THE WORLD     Ea                   KYOCERA MITA EUROPE 
361. y  Correct  Bk Line    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Service Setting         4 Press the OK key  The Service Setting menu appears   Service Setting   gt  M    Network Status  New Developer    Exit               5 Press the A or V key to select  New Developer         8 101    Default Setting  System Menu           6 Press the OK key  A confirmation screen appears   New Developer     Are you sure             Yes 1  No         7 Press  Yes   the Left Select key   Completed  is  displayed and the screen returns to the Service Setting  menu     Auto Drum Refresh    When the machine is turned on or is woken up from Low Power mode or Sleep mode  the drum is sometimes  automatically refreshed  Automatic drum refreshing is carried out to maintain printing quality and allows for the  ambient temperature and humidity     Use this setting to specify the duration of automatic drum refreshing        Item Description    Off Disables automatic drum refreshing        Standard Sets the standard duration for automatic  drum refreshing        Long Sets a longer time for automatic drum  refreshing  If the printed image is faint due  to moisture  set  Long            7 1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    gt    select  Adjust Maint       Document Box  O Edit Destination  12  Adjust Maint       Exit            2 Press the OK key  The Adjust Maint  menu appears   Adjust Maint    gt  oK    Send Box Density  Correct  Bk Line    Exit           
362. y  The IPv4 Setting menu appears     12 Press the A or V key to select  DHCP         8 122    Default Setting  System Menu                                                  DHCP   lt   0m  Off  023    On  IPv4 Setting  Kad OK    DHCP  Bonjour  IP Address     Exit    Bonjour  Kad OK    lol OfE  On  IPv4 Setting  bmg OK    DHCP  Bonjour  IP Address     Exit    IP Address  Kad OK     M  000 000 000          13    14    15    16    17    18    19    20    Press the OK key  DHCP appears     Press the A or V key to select  Off  and then press the    OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the    IPv4 Setting menu     Press the A or V key to select  Bonjour      Press the OK key  Bonjour appears     Press the A or V key to select  Off  and then press the    OK key     Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the    IPv4 Setting menu     Press the A or V key to select  IP Address      Press the OK key  IP Address appears     Use the arrow keys to enter the IP address     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to move the cursor position    horizontally        8 123    Default Setting  System Menu              IP Address  OK     123 145 167 189             IPv4 Setting  bmg OK    IP Address  Subnet Mask    Default Gateway    Exit               Subnet Mask  bmg OK      M  000 000 000                IPv4 Setting  Kma OK    IP Address  Subnet Mask    Default Gateway      Exit            Press the A or V key or the numeric keys to enter the  IP Address  Each 3 digits can 
363. y to select  Paper Status    Press the OK key  Paper Status appears     Press the  lt  or  gt  key to switch the display of remaining  paper amount among the main unit cassette  optional  cassette  if installed  and MP tray        3 30    4 Copying Functions    This chapter explains the functions available for copying      lt  Orginal SIZE sarees  asses cei ae Sees es emcee ae ieeea 4 2  e gt  PADEM SE lECHOM orere aansenacendaenypone sPitece smi tenap ene Ee ea a eaten 4 3       Original Onentarion seese a adie eis 4 6  e  ECO GIL V eve ghch st vtec usd e a ahd e aac eee 4 8      COMPING ModE e tinea ioe ericson encase ati nents eer 4 9     CS OMEMMIOUS   sell tcc ea vast we e aa a ee asd Ee eE Eaa EEE Eae eE eE ays 4 13     JOD FiniSANOICS 26 oe ae eae a a a 4 14  e rN AUN Enty  ieee eee eee a a eaer ai eie 4 16   amp  nPoNCOVemIde serengo e a a a a aa E ited 4 17       4 1    Copying Functions       Original Size  Specify the size of originals being scanned  Be sure to select the original size before starting the copying process     The following options are available     Original Letter  Legal  Statement  Executive  Officio Il  A4  A5     Sizes A6  B5  B6  Folio  16K  ISO B5  Envelope  10  Envelope   9  Envelope  6  Envelope Monarch  Envelope DL   Envelope C5  Hagaki  Oufuku Hagaki  Youkei 4  Youkei  2 and Custom                For instructions on how to specify the custom original size   refer to Custom Original Size Setup on page 8 7     Use the procedure below to selec
364. yoceramita de    ITALY   KYOCERA MITA Italia S P A    Via Verdi  89 91   I 20063 Cernusco sul Naviglio  MI   Phone   39 02 921 791   Fax   39 02 921 796 00  www kyoceramita it    THE NETHERLANDS   KYOCERA MITA Nederland B V   Beechavenue 25   1119 RA Schiphol Rijk   Phone   31 20 587 7200   Fax   31 20 587 7260  www kyoceramita nl    NORWAY   KYOCERA MITA Norge   Olaf Helsetsvei 6   NO 0694 Oslo   Phone   47 22 627 300  Fax   47 22 627 200  www kyoceramitanorge no    PORTUGAL   KYOCERA MITA Portugal LDA   Rua do Centro Cultural 41  PT 1700 106 Lisboa   Phone   351 21 843 6780  Fax   351 21 849 3312  www kyoceramita pt    SOUTH AFRICA   KYOCERA MITA South Africa  Pty  Ltd   527 Kyalami Boulevard  Kyalami  Business Park   ZA 1685 Midrand  Phone   27 11 540 2600   Fax   27 11 466 3050  www kyoceramita co za    SPAIN   KYOCERA MITA Espana S A   Avda  Manacor No  2  ES 28290 Las Matas  Madrid   Phone   34 91 631 83 92  Fax   34 91 631 82 19  www kyoceramita es                                  SWEDEN   KYOCERA MITA Svenska AB  Esbogatan 16B   SE 164 75 Kista   Phone   46 8 546 550 00  Fax   46 8 546 550 10  www kyoceramita se    UNITED KINGDOM   KYOCERA MITA UK Ltd    8 Beacontree Plaza  Gillette Way   Reading  Berkshire RG2 OBS  Phone   44 1189 311 500   Fax   44 1189 311 108  www kyoceramita co uk    KYOCERA MITA WORLDWIDE    JAPAN   KYOCERA MITA Corporation    Head Office    2 28  1 Chome  Tamatsukuri  Chuo ku   Osaka 540 8585  Japan   Phone   81 6 6764 3555   Fax   81 6 6764 39
365. ype to send the scanned originals  The available default settings are shown below     File Format Description    Send files in PDF format        Send files in TIFF format        Send files in XPS format           Send files in JPEG format           NOTE  Refer to page 5 10 for file formats        Use the procedure below to select the default file format        8 53    Default Setting  System Menu           1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count   0m select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Settings      Exit               2 Press the OK key  The Common Settings menu appears   Common Settings   lt i    Default Screen  Sound    Exit               Press the A or V key to select  Function Default         4 Press the OK key  The Function Default menu appears   Function Default  0m    01I  Color Selection  Scan Resolution  FAX Resolution                  Exit    5 Press the A or V key to select  File Format    6 Press the OK key  File Format appears   File Format  pata OK    TIFF  XPS             7 Press the A or V key to select  PDF    TIFF    XPS  or   JPEG      8 Press the OK key  Completed  is displayed and the  screen returns to the Function Default menu     File Separation    Select the default file separation setting  The available default settings are shown below        1 Inthe Sys  Menu Count  menu  press the A or V key to  Sys  Menu Count    0 select  Common Settings     System   User Job Account    05  Common Se
366. ze  m    Original Image O    Exit               4 Press the A or V key to select  File Name Entry         f 5 Press the OK key  File Name Entry appears   File Name Entry       do cil       NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        ABC    Text               6 Enter the file name  press the OK key  Additional Info   appears        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        7 Enter the date and time  job number  etc  on the screen   and then press the OK key        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for  details on entering characters        Completed  is displayed and the screen returns to the  basic screen for sending     8 Specify the destination  and press the Start key to start  sending        NOTE  Press the Reset key to reset the settings selected in  Function Menu           5 17    Sending Functions       Subject and Body Entry    When sending E mail  enter the subject and body of the E mail     Use the procedure below to enter the subject and body for an E mail message and then send the E mail        NOTE  Refer to Character Entry Method on Appendix 5 for details on entering characters        1 Press the Send key     2 Place the original        3 Press the Function Menu key  Function Menu appears   Function Menu  paid OK      ol  Color Selection O  Original Size O  Original Image O                                          Exit    4 Press the A or V k
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
取扱説明書 - 自転車  HP Z 820  HCV-TS - GALI spol. s ro  集塵機情報ダウンロード(PDF)  7405 Tri Lang manual.cdr - Taylor Precision Products  openFT V8.1 for UNIX - Fujitsu manual server    HP LaserJet 9000mfp Software Technical Reference External EN    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file